CVP 208

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 180

DIC 99

CVP-210/208
OWNER’S MANUAL
CVP-210/208
OWNER’S
OWNER’S MANUAL
MANUAL

Clavinova Web site (English only)


http://www.yamahaclavinova.com/

Yamaha Manual Library


http://www2.yamaha.co.jp/manual/english/

M.D.G., Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division, Yamaha Corporation
© 2003 Yamaha Corporation
WA48350 ???AP?????.?-01A0 Printed in Indonesia
Introduction
SPECIAL MESSAGE SECTION
PRODUCT SAFETY MARKINGS: Yamaha electronic Battery Notice: This product MAY contain a small non-
products may have either labels similar to the graphics rechargable battery which (if applicable) is soldered in
shown below or molded/stamped facsimiles of these place. The average life span of this type of battery is
graphics on the enclosure. The explanation of these approximately five years. When replacement becomes
graphics appears on this page. Please observe all cautions necessary, contact a qualified service representative to
indicated on this page and those indicated in the safety perform the replacement.
instruction section.
Warning: Do not attempt to recharge, disassemble, or
incinerate this type of battery. Keep all batteries away
CAUTION from children. Dispose of used batteries promptly and as
RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK regulated by applicable laws. Note: In some areas, the
DO NOT OPEN
servicer is required by law to return the defective parts.
However, you do have the option of having the servicer
CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK. dispose of these parts for you.
DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK).
NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. Disposal Notice: Should this product become damaged
REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.
beyond repair, or for some reason its useful life is consid-
ered to be at an end, please observe all local, state, and
federal regulations that relate to the disposal of products
See bottom of Keyboard enclosure for graphic symbol markings.
that contain lead, batteries, plastics, etc.
The exclamation point within the
NOTICE: Service charges incurred due to lack of knowl-
equilateral triangle is intended to alert
edge relating to how a function or effect works (when the
the user to the presence of important
unit is operating as designed) are not covered by the man-
operating and maintenance (servic-
ufacturer’s warranty, and are therefore the owners respon-
ing) instructions in the literature
sibility. Please study this manual carefully and consult
accompanying the product.
your dealer before requesting service.
The lightning flash with arrowhead
NAME PLATE LOCATION: The graphic below indi-
symbol, within the equilateral trian-
cates the location of the name plate. The model number,
gle, is intended to alert the user to the
serial number, power requirements, etc., are located on
presence of uninsulated “dangerous
this plate. You should record the model number, serial
voltage” within the product’s enclo-
number, and the date of purchase in the spaces provided
sure that may be of sufficient magni-
below and retain this manual as a permanent record of
tude to constitute a risk of electrical
your purchase.
shock.
IMPORTANT NOTICE: All Yamaha electronic products
are tested and approved by an independent safety testing
laboratory in order that you may be sure that when it is
properly installed and used in its normal and customary
manner, all foreseeable risks have been eliminated. DO
NOT modify this unit or commission others to do so
unless specifically authorized by Yamaha. Product perfor-
mance and/or safety standards may be diminished.
Claims filed under the expressed warranty may be denied
CVP-210 CVP-208
if the unit is/has been modified. Implied warranties may
also be affected.
SPECIFICATIONS SUBJECT TO CHANGE: The
information contained in this manual is believed to be
Model
correct at the time of printing. However, Yamaha reserves
the right to change or modify any of the specifications
without notice or obligation to update existing units. Serial No.

ENVIRONMENTAL ISSUES: Yamaha strives to pro-


Purchase Date
duce products that are both user safe and environmentally
friendly. We sincerely believe that our products and the
production methods used to produce them, meet these
goals. In keeping with both the letter and the spirit of the
law, we want you to be aware of the following:

92-469 1 (bottom)
PRECAUTIONS
PLEASE READ CAREFULLY BEFORE PROCEEDING
* Please keep this manual in a safe place for future reference.

WARNING
Always follow the basic precautions listed below to avoid the possibility of serious injury or even
death from electrical shock, short-circuiting, damages, fire or other hazards. These precautions
include, but are not limited to, the following:
Power supply/Power cord Water warning
• Only use the voltage specified as correct for the instrument. The • Do not expose the instrument to rain, use it near water or in
required voltage is printed on the name plate of the instrument. damp or wet conditions, or place containers on it containing liq-
• Check the electric plug periodically and remove any dirt or dust uids which might spill into any openings.
which may have accumulated on it. • Never insert or remove an electric plug with wet hands.
• Use only the supplied power cord/plug.
• Do not place the power cord near heat sources such as heaters Fire warning
or radiators, and do not excessively bend or otherwise damage • Do not put burning items, such as candles, on the unit.
the cord, place heavy objects on it, or place it in a position where A burning item may fall over and cause a fire.
anyone could walk on, trip over, or roll anything over it.
If you notice any abnormality
Do not open
• If the power cord or plug becomes frayed or damaged, or if there
• Do not open the instrument or attempt to disassemble the inter- is a sudden loss of sound during use of the instrument, or if any
nal parts or modify them in any way. The instrument contains no unusual smells or smoke should appear to be caused by it,
user-serviceable parts. If it should appear to be malfunctioning, immediately turn off the power switch, disconnect the electric
discontinue use immediately and have it inspected by qualified plug from the outlet, and have the instrument inspected by quali-
Yamaha service personnel. fied Yamaha service personnel.

CAUTION
Always follow the basic precautions listed below to avoid the possibility of physical injury to you or
others, or damage to the instrument or other property. These precautions include, but are not limited
to, the following:
Power supply/Power cord Location
• When removing the electric plug from the instrument or an outlet, • Do not expose the instrument to excessive dust or vibrations, or
always hold the plug itself and not the cord. Pulling by the cord extreme cold or heat (such as in direct sunlight, near a heater, or
can damage it. in a car during the day) to prevent the possibility of panel disfigu-
• Remove the electric plug from the outlet when the instrument is ration or damage to the internal components.
not to be used for extended periods of time, or during electrical • Do not use the instrument in the vicinity of a TV, radio, stereo
storms. equipment, mobile phone, or other electric devices. Otherwise,
• Do not connect the instrument to an electrical outlet using a mul- the instrument, TV, or radio may generate noise.
tiple-connector. • Do not place the instrument in an unstable position where it
Doing so can result in lower sound quality, or possibly cause might accidentally fall over.
overheating in the outlet. • Before moving the instrument, remove all connected cables. Also
check that all screws are tight and have not been loosened by
Assembly moving the instrument.
• Read carefully the attached documentation explaining the • Do not place the instrument against a wall (allow at least 3 cm/
assembly process. one-inch from the wall), since this can cause inadequate air cir-
Failure to assemble the instrument in the proper sequence might culation, and possibly result in the instrument overheating.
result in damage to the instrument or even injury.

(1)B-7 1/2

CVP-210/208 3
Connections Using the bench (If included)
• Before connecting the instrument to other electronic compo- • Do not place the bench in an unstable position where it might
nents, turn off the power for all components. Before turning the accidentally fall over.
power on or off for all components, set all volume levels to mini- • Do not play carelessly with or stand on the bench. Using it as a
mum. Also, be sure to set the volumes of all components at their tool or step-ladder or for any other purpose might result in acci-
minimum levels and gradually raise the volume controls while dent or injury.
playing the instrument to set the desired listening level. • Only one person should sit on the bench at a time, in order to
prevent the possibility of accident or injury.
Maintenance • On the CVP-210 bench, do not attempt to adjust the bench
height while sitting on the bench, since this can cause excessive
• On the CVP-210, gently remove dust and dirt with a soft cloth. force to be imposed on the adjustment mechanism, possibly
Do not wipe too hard since small particles of dirt can scratch the resulting in damage to the mechanism or even injury.
instrument's finish.
• If the bench screws become loose due to extensive long-term
• When cleaning the instrument, use a soft, dry or slightly damp use, tighten them periodically using the included tool.
cloth. Do not use paint thinners, solvents, cleaning fluids, or
chemical-impregnated wiping cloths.
Saving data
Handling caution Saving and backing up your data
• Take care that the key cover does not pinch your fingers, and do • Some of the current memory data (see page 43) is lost when you
not insert a finger or hand in any gaps on the key cover or instru- turn off the power to the instrument. Save the data to a floppy
ment. disk/the User Drive (see page 40, 48).
• Never insert or drop paper, metallic, or other objects into the Saved data may be lost due to malfunction or incorrect opera-
gaps on the key cover, panel or keyboard. If this happens, turn tion. Save important data to a floppy disk.
off the power immediately and unplug the power cord from the
AC outlet. Then have the instrument inspected by qualified When you change settings in a display page and then exit
Yamaha service personnel. from that page, System Setup data (listed in the Parameter
• Do not place vinyl, plastic or rubber objects on the instrument, Chart of the separate Data List booklet) is automatically
since this might discolor the panel or keyboard. stored. However, this edited data is lost if you turn off the
power without properly exiting from the relevant display.
• On the CVP-210, bumping the surface of the instrument with
metal, porcelain, or other hard objects can cause the finish to
crack or peel. Use caution.
• Do not rest your weight on, or place heavy objects on the instru- Backing up the floppy disk
ment, and do not use excessive force on the buttons, switches or • To protect against data loss through media damage, we recom-
connectors. mend that you save your important data onto two floppy disks.
• Do not operate the instrument for a long period of time at a high
or uncomfortable volume level, since this can cause permanent
hearing loss. If you experience any hearing loss or ringing in the
ears, consult a physician.

Caution for data operations


Make sure NEVER to turn the CVP-210/208’s power off during any kind of data operation involving the USER/FLOPPY DISK drives — such
as saving, deleting, or copying/pasting — until the operation is completely finished. (Make sure to wait until the alert message disappears.)
Turning the power off during the operation results in the loss of the data being saved or pasted to the respective drive.
Keeping the power on during such operations is particularly important in regard to the USER drive. Turning off the power while performing
a save/delete/paste operation with the USER drive may result in loss of ALL data on the USER drive (upon the next power on) — and not
just the data in question. In other words, if you are performing a save/delete/paste operation on only the song data of the USER drive and
you turn off the power before the operation is completed, you risk losing ALL your USER drive data — including all voices, styles, and Reg-
istration Memory presets you’ve saved to the USER drive.
This caution also applies to creating a new folder on the USER drive or using the factory reset operation (page 154).

Yamaha cannot be held responsible for damage caused by improper use or modifications to the instrument, or data that is lost or destroyed.

Always turn the power off when the instrument is not in use.

(1)B-7 2/2

4 CVP-210/208
Thank you for purchasing the Yamaha Clavinova!
We recommend that you read this manual carefully
so that you can fully take advantage of the advanced
and convenient functions of the Clavinova.
We also recommend that you keep this manual
in a safe and handy place for future reference.

About this Owner’s Manual and Data List


This manual consists of four main sections: Introduction, Quick Guide, Basic Operation, and Reference.
Also, a separate Data List is provided.

Introduction (page 2): Please read this section first.


Quick Guide (page 20): This section explains how to use the basic functions.
Basic Operation (page 39): This section explains how to use the basic operations including display-based controls.
Reference (page 56): This section explains how to make detailed settings for the Clavinova’s various functions.

Data List : Voice List, MIDI Data Format, etc.


* The models CVP-210/208 will be referred to as the CVP/Clavinova in this Owner’s Manual.
* The illustrations and LCD screens as shown in this owner’s manual are for instructional purposes only, and may appear
somewhat different from those on your instrument.
* The example Operation Guide displays shown in this Manual are taken from the CVP-210, and in English.
* Copying of the commercially available software is strictly prohibited except for your personal use.

This product incorporates and bundles computer programs and contents in which Yamaha owns copyrights or with respect to
which it has license to use others’ copyrights. Such copyrighted materials include, without limitation, all computer software,
styles files, MIDI files, WAVE data and sound recordings. Any unauthorized use of such programs and contents outside of
personal use is not permitted under relevant laws. Any violation of copyright has legal consequences. DON’T MAKE,
DISTRIBUTE OR USE ILLEGAL COPIES.

Trademarks:
• Apple and Macintosh are trademarks of Apple Computer, Inc.
• IBM-PC/AT is a trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
• Windows is the registered trademark of Microsoft® Corporation.
• All other trademarks are the property of their respective holders.

* The photos of the harpsichord, bandoneon, hackbrett, music box, dulcimer and cimbalom, shown in the displays of the CVP-
210/208, are courtesy of the Gakkigaku Shiryokan (Collection for Organolgy), Kunitachi College of Music.
* The following instruments, shown in the displays of the CVP-210/208, are on display at the Hamamatsu Museum of Musical
Instruments: balafon, gender, kalimba, kanoon, santur, gamelan gong, harp, hand bell, bagpipe, banjo, carillon, mandolin, oud,
pan flute, pungi, rabab. shanai, sitar, steel drum, tambra.
* This product is manufactured under license of U.S. Patents No.5231671, No.5301259, No.5428708, and No.5567901 from IVL
Technologies Ltd.
* The bitmap fonts used in this instrument have been provided by and are the property of Ricoh Co., Ltd.

CVP-210/208 5
Accessories
■ “50 greats for the Piano” Disk (and Music Book)
■ Recording disk
Use this blank disk to save your performance.
■ Owner’s Manual
This manual contains complete instructions for operating your Clavinova.
■ Data List
This manual contains lists of voices, styles and parameters, etc.
■ Bench
A bench may be included or optional, depending on your locale.

Handling the Floppy Disk Drive (FDD) and


Floppy Disk
Precautions
Be sure to handle floppy disks and treat the disk drive with care. Follow the important precautions below.

To eject a floppy disk:


Compatible Disk Type Before ejecting the disk, be sure to confirm that data
is not being written to the floppy disk.
• 3.5" 2DD and 2HD type floppy disks can be used.
If data is currently being written to the floppy disk in
the following operations, the messages “Now
executing,” “Now copying,” and “Now formatting”
Inserting/Ejecting Floppy Disks appears in the display.
• Moving, copying, pasting, saving, or deleting data
To insert a floppy disk into the disk drive: (page 46 - 48).
• Hold the disk so that the label of the disk is facing • Naming files and folders (page 45); creating a new
upward and the sliding shutter is facing forward, folder (page 48).
towards the disk slot. Carefully insert the disk into the • Copying a disk to an another disk (page 153);
slot, slowly pushing it all the way in until it clicks into formatting the disk (page 153).
place and the eject button pops out. Eject button

Drive lamp
When the power is turned on, the drive lamp (at
the bottom left of the drive) lights to indicate the
drive can be used.

6 CVP-210/208
• Never attempt to remove the disk or turn the power off • Never use a floppy disk with a deformed shutter or
when the data is being written to the floppy disk. housing.
Doing so can damage the disk and possibly the disk • Do not attach anything other than the provided labels
drive. Press the eject button slowly as far as it will go; to a floppy disk. Also make sure that labels are
the disk will automatically pop out. When the disk is attached in the proper location.
fully ejected, carefully remove it by hand.
• If the eject button is pressed too quickly, or if it is not
pressed in as far as it will go, the disk may not eject
To protect your data (Write-protect Tab):
properly. The eject button may become stuck in a half-
• To prevent accidental erasure of important data, slide
pressed position with the disk extending from the
the disk’s write-protect tab to the “protect” position
drive slot by only a few millimeters. If this happens, do
(tab open).
not attempt to pull out the partially ejected disk, since
using force in this situation can damage the disk drive
mechanism or the floppy disk. To remove a partially
ejected disk, try pressing the eject button once again,
or push the disk back into the slot and then repeat the
eject procedure.
• Be sure to remove the floppy disk from the disk drive write-protect tab open
(protect position)
before turning off the power. A floppy disk left in the
drive for extended periods can easily pick up dust and
dirt that can cause data read and write errors.

Data backup
Cleaning the Disk Drive Read/Write Head • For maximum data security Yamaha recommends that
you keep two copies of important data on separate
• Clean the read/write head regularly. This instrument floppy disks. This gives you a backup if one disk is lost
employs a precision magnetic read/write head which, or damaged. To make a backup disk use the Disk to
after an extended period of use, will pick up a layer of Disk function on page 153.
magnetic particles from the disks used that will
eventually cause read and write errors.
• To maintain the disk drive in optimum working order
Yamaha recommends that you use a commercially-
available dry-type head cleaning disk to clean the
head about once a month. Ask your Yamaha dealer
about the availability of proper head-cleaning disks.
• Never insert anything but floppy disks into the disk
drive. Other objects may cause damage to the disk
drive or floppy disks.

About the Floppy Disks

To handle floppy disks with care:


• Do not place heavy objects on a disk or bend or apply
pressure to the disk in any way. Always keep floppy
disks in their protective cases when they are not in
use.
• Do not expose the disk to direct sunlight, extremely
high or low temperatures, or excessive humidity, dust
or liquids.
• Do not open the sliding shutter and touch the exposed
surface of the floppy disk inside.
• Do not expose the disk to magnetic fields, such as
those produced by televisions, speakers, motors, etc.,
since magnetic fields can partially or completely erase
data on the disk, rendering it unreadable.

CVP-210/208 7
About the Display Messages
A message (information or confirmation dialog) sometimes appears on the screen to
facilitate operation. You can select the desired
When such messages appear, simply follow the instructions as shown by pressing the language from the Help dis-
corresponding button. play (page 53).

G For this example, press the


[G] (YES) button to
H
execute formatting.
I

“The Clavinova-Computer Connection” is a supplementary guidebook that describes, for beginners, what you can
do with your Clavinova and a personal computer and how to set up a Clavinova-Computer system (the manual is
not written for any specific models). The document is available as a PDF file (in English) at the following Internet
address:

Clavinova Home Page .......................... http://www.yamahaclavinova.com/


Yamaha Manual Library
(Electronic Musical Instruments) ......... http://www2.yamaha.co.jp/manual/english/

Maintenance
Clean the instrument using a dry, soft cloth or slightly damp, soft cloth (wring well).

CAUTION
Do not use benzine, thinner, detergent, or chemical cloth for cleaning. Do not place vinyl, plastic, or rubber
products on the instrument.
Otherwise, the panel or keys may be discolored or degraded.

CAUTION
Before using the Clavinova, be sure to read “Precautions” on pages 3 - 4.

■ Tuning
Unlike an acoustic piano, the Clavinova does not need to be tuned. It always stays perfectly in tune.

■ Transporting
If you move to another location, you can transport the Clavinova along with other belongings. You can move the unit
as it is (assembled) or you can disassemble the unit down to the condition it was in when you first took it out of the
box. Transport the keyboard horizontally. Do not lean it up against a wall or stand it up on its side.
Do not subject the instrument to excessive vibration or shock.
When transporting the assembled Clavinova, make sure all screws are properly tightened and have not been
loosened by moving the instrument.

8 CVP-210/208
Table of Contents
Introduction ............................ 2 Using the Metronome............................................ 54
Adjusting the Tempo ............................................. 54
SPECIAL MESSAGE SECTION ................................... 2 Tap Tempo ............................................................. 55
PRECAUTIONS .......................................................... 3
About this Owner’s Manual and Data List .............. 5
Accessories ............................................................... 6 Reference
Handling the Floppy Disk Drive (FDD)
and Floppy Disk..................................................... 6 Playing the Demos .................56
About the Display Messages.................................... 8
Maintenance ............................................................ 8
Application Index ................................................... 12 Voices.....................................58
What can you do with the Clavinova?................... 14 Selecting a Voice .................................................... 58
Setting Up the Clavinova ....................................... 16 One-touch Piano Play.............................................. 59
Panel Controls and Terminals................................ 18 Layer/Left — Playing Several Sounds
Simultaneously .................................................... 60
Layer — Layering Two Different Voices ................... 60
Quick Guide ........................... 20 Left — Setting Separate Voices for the Left and Right
Playing the Demos ................................................. 20 Sections of the Keyboard ..................................... 61
Song Playback ........................................................ 21 Applying Voice Effects ........................................... 61
Playback of Songs ....................................................21 Using the Pedals..................................................... 62
Playing Voices ........................................................ 25
Playing a Voice ........................................................25
Playing Two Voices Simultaneously ..........................26 Styles......................................63
Playing Different Voices with the Left Playing a style ........................................................ 63
and Right Hands ...................................................27 Playing a Style’s Rhythm Channels Only.................. 65
Playing Styles ......................................................... 28 Adjusting the Volume Balance/Channel Muting ...... 65
Playing a style ..........................................................28 Chord Fingerings.................................................... 66
Style Sections...........................................................30 Arranging the Style Pattern (SECTIONS:
One Touch Setting...................................................32
MAIN A/B/C/D, INTRO, ENDING, BREAK) ......... 68
Music Finder........................................................... 33
Stopping the Style Playback While Releasing Keys
Using the Music Finder ............................................33
(SYNC. STOP) ...................................................... 69
Searching the Music Finder Records.........................34
Selecting Intro and Ending Types
Playing and Practicing with the Songs.................. 36 (INTRO/ENDING) ................................................ 70
Playing Along with the Clavinova.............................36 Playing Fill-in patterns automatically when changing
Recording ................................................................37 accompaniment sections — Auto Fill In................ 70
Mastering Your Favorite Songs.................................38 Appropriate Panel Setting for the Selected Style
(ONE TOUCH SETTING) ...................................... 71
Automatically Changing One Touch Settings with the
Basic Operations Sections — OTS Link............................................ 72
— Organizing Your Data ....... 39 Registering the Panel Controls in One Touch Setting
(ONE TOUCH SETTING) ...................................... 72
Contents shown in the Main Display .................... 39 Calling Up Ideal Setups for Your Music
Open/Save Display................................................. 40 — Music Finder.................................................... 73
Selecting Files and Folders..................................... 44 Searching the Ideal Setups — Music Finder Search.. 74
File/Folder-related Operations .............................. 45 Editing Records — Music Finder Record Edit ........... 75
Naming Files/Folders ...............................................45
Moving Files/Folders ................................................46
Copying Files/Folders...............................................47 Song Playback........................77
Deleting Files/Folders...............................................47
Saving Files ..............................................................48 Compatible Song Types ......................................... 77
Organizing Files by Creating a New Folder ..............48 Song Playback ........................................................ 78
Displaying Upper Level pages ..................................48 Playing the Internal Songs....................................... 78
Entering Characters and Changing Icons .................48 Playing Back Songs on Disk ..................................... 80
Using the [DATA ENTRY] Dial................................ 50 Other Playback-related Operations.......................... 80
Direct Access — Instant Selection of Displays....... 51 Muting Specific Parts
Help Messages ....................................................... 53 — Track1/Track2/Extra Tracks ............................ 81

CVP-210/208 9
Repeat Playback of a Specific Range ..................... 81 Step Recording..................................................... 116
Using the Practice Functions — Guide .................. 82 Assembling an Accompaniment Style
Practice Functions ....................................................82 —Assembly ........................................................ 117
Practicing Music with the Guide Functions...............83 Edit the Created Accompaniment Style .............. 118
Displaying Music Notation — Score ...................... 84 Change the Rhythmic Feel
Displaying the Lyrics .............................................. 87 — Groove and Dynamics ................................... 118
Editing the Channel Data ...................................... 120
Making Style File Format Settings — Parameter .... 121
Saving and Recalling Custom
Panel Setups Adjust the Volume Balance and
— Registration Memory ........ 88 Changing Voices
Registering Panel Setups — Mixing Console ................123
— Registration Memory...................................... 88
Saving Your Registration Memory Setups .................89 Operation ............................................................. 123
Recalling a Registration Memory Setup ................ 90 Setting the Level Balance and Voice
— Volume/Voice ............................................... 124
Changing the Tone of the Voice — Filter............ 125
Editing Voices Changing Pitch-related Settings — Tune ............ 125
— Sound Creator ................... 91 Adjusting the Effects ............................................ 126
Adjusting the Sound to Match the Performance
Operation ............................................................... 91 Environment — EQ............................................ 128
SOUND CREATOR Parameters (Natural/Regular Effect Structure ..................................................... 129
Voices) ................................................................. 92
Organ Flutes........................................................... 96
Operation ............................................................... 96 Using a Microphone — MIC. 131
Selecting a Vocal Harmony Type ......................... 131
Recording Your Performances Operation ............................................................. 133
Adjusting the Vocal Harmony Settings and Microphone
and Creating Songs Effects — OVERALL SETTING.............................. 133
— Song Creator ..................... 97 Making Settings for the Vocal Harmony and
Microphone — MICROPHONE SETTING .......... 133
About Song Recording........................................... 97 Setting the Microphone Volume and Related Effects
Quick Recording..................................................... 98 — TALK SETTING............................................... 135
Multi Recording ..................................................... 99
Recording Individual Notes — Step Record ........ 101
Operation ..............................................................101 Making Global and Other
Recording Melodies — Step Record (Note) ............103
Recording Chord Changes for the Auto Important Settings
Accompaniment — Step Record (Chord) ............104 — Function...........................136
Select the Recording Options: Starting, Stopping,
Punching In/Out — Rec Mode.......................... 106 Operation ............................................................. 136
Editing a Recorded Song ..................................... 107 Fine Tuning the Pitch/Selecting a Scale
Editing Channel-related Parameters — Channel .....107 — Master Tune/Scale Tune............................... 138
Editing Note Events — 1 - 16.................................110 Tuning the Overall Pitch — Master Tune............... 138
Editing Chord Events — CHD.................................111 Selecting a Scale — Scale Tune ............................. 138
Editing System Events Setting Song-related Parameters
— SYS/EX. (System Exclusive) .............................111 — Song Settings................................................ 140
Inputting and Editing Lyrics ...................................112 Setting Auto Accompaniment-related Parameters
Customizing the Event List — Filter........................112 — Style Setting, Split Point,
and Chord Fingering......................................... 141
Setting Auto Accompaniment-related Parameters
Creating Accompaniment Styles — Style Setting and Split Point .......................... 141
— Style Creator ................... 113 Setting the Fingering Method — Chord Fingering 142
Making Settings for the Pedals and Keyboard
About Creating Accompaniment Styles .............. 113 — Controller...................................................... 142
Style File Format .................................................. 114 Making Settings for the Pedals .............................. 142
Operation ............................................................. 114 Changing the Touch Sensitivity and Transpose
Realtime Recording — Basic ................................ 115 — Keyboard/Panel ............................................. 144

10 CVP-210/208
Setting the Registration Sequence, Freeze, and
Voice Set............................................................ 145
Specifying the Order for Calling Up Registration
Memory Presets — Registration Sequence ..........145
Maintaining Panel Settings — Freeze .....................145
Changing the Automatically Selected Voice Settings
— Voice Set ........................................................146 Introduction
Setting Harmony and Echo.................................. 146
Showing the Clavinova Display on a TV
— Video Out...................................................... 147
Quick Guide
Setting the MIDI Parameters ............................... 148
Making Overall System Settings (Local Control, Clock,
etc.) — System ...................................................148
Transmitting MIDI Data — Transmit ......................149 Basic Operations - Organizing Your Data
Receiving MIDI Data — Receive .............................150
Setting Root Note Channels — Root ......................150
Setting Chord Channels — Chord Detect ..............150 Playing the Demos
Other Settings — Utility ...................................... 151
Making Settings for Fade In/Out, Metronome,
Parameter Lock, and Tap — CONFIG 1...............151
Making Settings for the Display, Speaker System, and Voices
Voice Number Indication — CONFIG 2 ..............152
Copying and Formatting Disks — Disk ...................153
Entering Your Name and Language Preference Styles
— Owner............................................................154
Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings of the
CVP-210/208 — System Reset ............................154
Song Playback

Using Your Clavinova with


Other Devices ...................... 155 Saving and Recalling Custom
Panel Setups - Registration Memory
Using the Headphones (PHONES jacks)..................155
Connecting the Microphone or Guitar
(MIC./LINE IN jack).............................................155 Editing Voices - Sound Creator
Connecting Audio & Video Devices .......................156
Using the Pedal (footswitch) or Foot Controller
(AUX PEDAL jack) ...............................................157 Recording Your Performances
Connecting external MIDI devices and Creating Songs - Song Creator
(MIDI terminals) .................................................157
Connecting a computer
(USB terminal, MIDI terminal).............................157 Creating Accompaniment Styles
- Style Creator
What’s MIDI? .........................................................159
What You Can Do With MIDI .................................161
MIDI Data Compatibility...................................... 162 Adjust the Volume Balance
Disk format ............................................................162 and Changing Voices - Mixing Console
Sequence Format...................................................162
Voice Allocation Format .........................................163
Using a Microphone - MIC.

CVP-210/208: Keyboard Stand


Assembly ............................. 164 Making Global and Other Important
Settings - Function

Troubleshooting.................. 166
Using Your Clavinova with Other Devices

Specifications ...................... 168


Appendix

Index ................................... 170


CVP-210/208 11
Application Index
Use this index to find reference pages that may be helpful for your particular
application and situation.

Listening
Listening to the internal songs ................................................................................................................ page 78
Listening to disk songs ....................................................................... “Playing Back Songs on Disk” on page 80
Listening to demo songs......................................................................................................................... page 56
Listening to the demo of the selected voices .......................................................................................... page 58
Listening to songs with the special voices of the Clavinova .................................................................. page 124

Playing
Calling up the piano setting ................................................................................................................... page 59
Using the three performance control pedals........................................................................................... page 62
Playing an accompaniment that matches pitch.............................................................“Transpose ”on page 144
Combining two voices ...................................................... “Layer — Layering Two Different Voices” on page 60
Playing separate voices with the right and left hands
...........................“Left — Setting Separate Voices for the Left and Right Sections of the Keyboard” on page 61

Changing the sound


Enhancing the sound with reverb and other effects .....................................“Applying Voice Effects” on page 61
“Adjusting the Effects” on page 126
Adjusting the Level Balance ................................................................................................................. page 124
Combining two voices ...................................................... “Layer — Layering Two Different Voices” on page 60
Playing separate voices with the right and left hands
...........................“Left — Setting Separate Voices for the Left and Right Sections of the Keyboard” on page 61
Creating voices ...................................................................................................................................... page 91

Playing the auto accompaniment


Playing the accompaniment automatically ............................................................................................. page 63
Calling up ideal panel settings for your music ........................................................................................ page 73

Practicing
Muting the right- or left-hand part .......................................................................................................... page 83
Practicing with an accurate and steady tempo............................................. “Using the Metronome” on page 54

Recording
Recording your performance...........................................................................................................pages 98, 99
Creating a song by entering notes ........................................................................................................ page 101

Creating your original settings


Creating voices ...................................................................................................................................... page 91
Creating accompaniment styles............................................................................................................ page 113

12 CVP-210/208
Using a microphone
Connecting the microphone.............. “Connecting the Microphone or Guitar (MIC./LINE IN jack)” on page 155
Adding automatic harmonies to your singing ....................................................................................... page 131

Settings
Registering Panel Setups......................................................................................................................... page 88
Tuning the pitch/Selecting a scale ........................................................................................................ page 138
Making detailed settings for playing back songs ................................................................................... page 140
Making detailed settings for the auto accompaniment.......................................................................... page 141
Making settings for the pedals .......................................................“Making Settings for the Pedals” on page 142
Making detailed settings for the keyboard voices ................................................................................. page 144
Showing the display on a TV .................... “Showing the Clavinova Display on a TV — Video Out” on page 147
Making detailed settings for MIDI ........................................................................................................ page 148

Connecting the Clavinova to other devices


Basic information on MIDI..................................................................................... “What’s MIDI?” on page 159
Recording your performance................ “Playing the sounds of the Clavinova through an external audio system,
and recording the sounds to an external recorder (AUX OUT jacks)” on page 156
Raising the volume .............................. “Playing the sounds of the Clavinova through an external audio system,
and recording the sounds to an external recorder (AUX OUT jacks)” on page 156
Outputting another instrument’s sound from the Clavinova ............ “Outputting the sound of an external device
through the built in speakers of the Clavinova (AUX IN jacks)” on page 156
Connecting a computer.......................... .“Connecting a computer (USB terminal, MIDI terminal)” on page 157

Assembling
Assembling and disassembling the Clavinova............... “CVP-210/208: Keyboard Stand Assembly” on page 164

Quick solution
Basic functions of the Clavinova and how you can best use it .........................................................pages 12, 14
Resetting the Clavinova to the default setting
.................... “Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings of the CVP-210/208 — System Reset” on page 154
Displaying the Messages ......................................................................“About the Display Messages” on page 8
Adjusting the contrast/brightness............................................ “Making Settings for the Display, Speaker System,
and Voice Number Indication — CONFIG 2” on page 152
Troubleshooting ................................................................................................................................... page 166

CVP-210/208 13
What can you do with the Clavinova?

SONG VOCAL HARMONY DEMO


Playback previously recorded Automatic backup singing Explore the Demos
songs (page 21, 36, 77) (page 131) (page 20, 56)
Enjoy a wide variety of preset songs This sophisticated function These not only showcase the
as well as songs on commercially automatically adds appropriate stunning voices and styles of
available disks. vocal harmonies to your singing. the instrument, they
introduce you to the various
functions and features — and
give you hands-on
experience using the
Clavinova!

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R
A
MASTER VOLUME
HELP

REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B


FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

NEW SONG SYNC. START DIGITAL


MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D

TAP TEMPO SOUND


CREATOR
E
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING

ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6

STYLE GUIDE DIGITAL RECORDING


Back up your performance Learn and practice with the Record your performances
with Auto Accompaniment Guide functions (page 38, 82) (page 97, 113)
(page 28, 63) Play back the preset songs or the With the powerful and easy-to-
Playing a chord with your left appropriate disk software, and let use song recording features, you
hand automatically plays the auto the display and guide lamps show can record your own keyboard
accompaniment backing. Select you when and where to play the performances, and create your
an accompaniment style — such proper notes. It’s never been easier own complete, fully orchestrated
as pop, jazz, Latin, etc. — and let or more fun to learn new music! compositions — which you can
the Clavinova be your backing then save to the USER drive or a
band! floppy disk for future recall.

14 CVP-210/208
LCD MUSIC FINDER VOICE
The large LCD (together Call up the perfect accompaniment Enjoy a huge variety of
with the various panel style (page 33, 73) realistic voices (page 25, 58)
buttons) provides If you know what song you want to play, The Clavinova features a wealth of
comprehensive and easy- but you don’t know which style or voice exceptionally authentic and
to-understand control of would be right for it, let the Music Finder dynamic voices (more than 800)
the Clavinova’s operations. help you. Just select the song title, and — including piano, strings,
the Clavinova automatically calls up the woodwinds, and more!
most appropriate style and voice.

VOICE EFFECT
REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

VOICE
PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
F VOICE PART
ON OFF
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
G LAYER

H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING

I
1 2 3 4

PIANO REGISTRATION MEMORY


DATA
ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY

3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

USB terminal Organ Flutes


Make music with a computer — Craft your own organ voices
quickly and easily (page 157) (page 96)
Dive in and take advantage of the This special function not only
PIANO wide world of computer music gives you a full set of rich and
Set up the piano — software. Connections and setup are luscious organ sounds, it also lets
instantly (page 59) exceptionally easy, and you can play you create your own original
You can call up all the back your computer recorded parts organ voices, just as on a
optimum piano settings for with different instrument sounds — traditional organ, by increasing
the Clavinova with just a all from a single Clavinova! and decreasing the flute footages,
single button press — then and adding percussive sounds.
play the extraordinarily
realistic grand piano voice.
AUX PEDAL USB MIDI
THRU OUT IN

(LEVEL FIXED)
L/L+R R L/L+R R L R

VIDEO OUT AUX IN AUX OUT

CVP-210/208 15
Setting Up the Clavinova
■ To lower the music rest:
Key cover
■ To open the key cover:
1 Pull the music rest toward yourself as far as it will go.
Lift the cover slightly, then push and slide it open. 2 Gently lower the music rest backward until it is all
the way down.
■ To close the key cover:
Slide the cover toward you and gently lower the
cover over the keys.

CAUTION
Do not try to use the music rest in a half-raised position. Also, when
lowering the music rest, let the music rest all the way down before
CAUTION releasing it.
Be careful to avoid catching
your fingers when opening or
closing the cover.

CAUTION
Sheet Music Braces
Hold the cover with both hands when opening or closing it. Do not
release it until it is fully opened or closed. Be careful to avoid catching
These braces are for holding the pages of music books in
fingers (yours or others, especially children’s) between the cover and place.
the unit.
■ To open
CAUTION
Do not place objects such as a piece of metal or paper on top of the
key cover. Small objects placed on the key cover may fall inside the
unit when the cover is opened and may be nearly impossible to
remove. This could cause electric shock, short circuit, fire or other
serious damage to the instrument.

Music Rest
■ To close
■ To raise the music rest:
1 Pull the music rest toward yourself as far as it will go.
2 Lower the music rest until it locks in place.

16 CVP-210/208
Setting the volume
Turning the Power On
Use the [MASTER VOLUME] dial to adjust the volume to
and Off an appropriate level.

Connect the power cord MASTER VOLUME

1 Insert the plugs at the ends of the cord, one into the
AC INLET on the Clavinova, and the other into a FADE IN / OUT
standard AC outlet.
In some areas, a plug adapter may be provided to
match the pin configuration of the AC wall outlets in MIN MAX

your area.
CAUTION
Do not use the Clavinova at a high volume level for a long period of
time, or your hearing may be damaged.

Using headphones
Connect a pair of headphones to one of the [PHONES]
jacks.
Two [PHONES] jacks are provided.
Two sets of standard stereo headphones can be plugged
in. (If you are using only one pair of headphones, you
can plug them into either of these jacks.)

(The shape of plug differs depending on locale.)

2 Press the [POWER] switch.


→ The main display appears in the LCD display. The
drive lamp below the lower right end of the
keyboard also lights. INPUT MIC.
VOLUME LINE IN MIC. LINE PHONES
MIN MAX

POWER
ON OFF

The drive lamp lights. Using the Headphone Hanger


A headphone hanger is included in the CVP-210/208
BACK

package so that you can hang the headphones on the


Clavinova. Install the headphone hanger using included
A

two screws (4 × 10 mm) as shown in the figure.


C

BALANCE

CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

CAUTION
Do not hang anything other than the headphones on the hanger.
Otherwise, the Clavinova or the hanger may be damaged.

When you’re ready to turn off the power, press the


[POWER] switch again.
→ Both the display and the drive lamp below the
right end of the keyboard will turn off.

CVP-210/208 17
Panel Controls and Terminals
75 74 73
69 70 71 72 AUX PEDAL USB
THRU
MIDI
OUT IN

INPUT MIC. MIC. LINE PHONES


VOLUME LINE IN
MIN MAX

(LEVEL FIXED)
L/L+R R L/L+R R L R

VIDEO OUT AUX IN AUX OUT

76 77 78 79

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER


START ⁄ STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING

1 5 6 7 8 9 MENU

ON OFF
2 SONG 36 DEMO
42
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R

MASTER VOLUME 37 A

10 11 12 HELP

FADE IN ⁄ OUT
REC TOP START ⁄ STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE
38 FUNCTION
B

3 4 13
NEW SONG
14 15
SYNC. START
16 17 18 19 DIGITAL
C

MIN MAX STUDIO


TEMPO TRANSPOSE D
SOUND
TAP TEMPO
39 CREATOR
E
RESET 20 21 RESET 22 DIGITAL
STYLE
40
RECORDING

ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING ⁄ rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START ⁄ STOP
41 MIXING BALANCE 43
OTS LINK
24 CONSOLE

PART

23 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 CHANNEL
ON ⁄ OFF
44
PART

45 50
DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5

POWER 27 [INTRO] button ............................................................... P. 31, 70


1 [ON / OFF] button (POWER)................................................ P. 17 28 MAIN [A] button.................................................................... P. 68
29 MAIN [B] button.................................................................... P. 68
METRONOME 30 MAIN [C] button ................................................................... P. 68
2 [START / STOP] button (METRONOME) ............................. P. 54 31 MAIN [D] button ................................................................... P. 68
32 [ENDING / rit.] button ..................................................... P. 31, 70
MASTER VOLUME
33 [SYNC.STOP] button............................................................ P. 69
3 [MASTER VOLUME] dial...................................................... P. 17 [SYNC.START] button .......................................................... P. 64
34
4 [FADE IN / OUT] button........................................................ P. 69 [START / STOP] button (STYLE) ......................................... P. 64
35
MIC. MENU
5 [VOCAL HARMONY] button............................................... P. 131 36 [DEMO] button ..................................................................... P. 56
6 [TALK] button...................................................................... P. 131 37 [HELP] button....................................................................... P. 53
7 [EFFECT] button ................................................................ P. 131 38 [FUNCTION] button ........................................................... P. 136
8 [VH TYPE SELECT] button ................................................ P. 131
9 [MIC. SETTING] button ...................................................... P. 131 DIGITAL STUDIO
39 [SOUND CREATOR] button ................................................. P. 91
SONG
40 [DIGITAL RECORDING] button ................................... P. 97, 113
10 [EXTRA TRACKS (STYLE)] button ...................................... P. 81 41 [MIXING CONSOLE] button............................................... P. 123
11 [TRACK 2 (L)] button............................................................ P. 81
12 [TRACK 1 (R)] button ........................................................... P. 81 DISPLAY CONTROL
13 [REC] button ........................................................................ P. 97 42 [A] - [J] buttons..................................................................... P. 44
14 [TOP] button......................................................................... P. 80 43 [BALANCE] button ............................................................... P. 65
15 [START / STOP] button (SONG) .......................................... P. 78 44 [CHANNEL ON / OFF] button ........................................ P. 65, 80
16 [REW] button........................................................................ P. 80 45 [DIRECT ACCESS] button ................................................... P. 51
17 [FF] button............................................................................ P. 80 46 [BACK] button ................................................................ P. 44, 50
18 [REPEAT] button .................................................................. P. 81 47 [NEXT] button ................................................................ P. 44, 50
19 [GUIDE] button..................................................................... P. 82 48 VOICE PART ON / OFF [LAYER] button .............................. P. 60
49 VOICE PART ON / OFF [LEFT] button................................. P. 60
TEMPO
50 [1▲▼] - [8▲▼] buttons ................................................. P. 39 - 49
20 [E] [F] buttons (TEMPO) ............................................... P. 54
51 [ENTER] button.................................................................... P. 50
21 [TAP TEMPO] button ............................................................ P. 55
52 [DATA ENTRY] dial............................................................... P. 50
TRANSPOSE 53 [EXIT] button ........................................................................ P. 44
22 [E] [F] buttons (TRANSPOSE) ................................... P. 144 VOICE EFFECT
STYLE 54 [REVERB] button ................................................................. P. 61
23 [ACMP] button...................................................................... P. 64 55 [DSP] button......................................................................... P. 61
24 [AUTO FILLIN] button........................................................... P. 70 56 [VARIATION] button ............................................................. P. 61
25 [OTS LINK] button................................................................ P. 72 57 [HARMONY / ECHO] button ................................................ P. 62
26 [BREAK] button .................................................................... P. 68 58 [MONO] button..................................................................... P. 62
59 [LEFT HOLD] button ............................................................ P. 62

18 CVP-210/208
68

80 67
81 82

VOICE EFFECT
REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ⁄ ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
46 BACK NEXT
47 54 55 56 57 58 59
42 F VOICE PART
VOICE
PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES

ON ⁄ OFF
60 BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
G LAYER
48
H LEFT 49 51
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING

I
61 62 1 2 3 4

PIANO REGISTRATION MEMORY


DATA
ENTRY
63 64 FREEZE
65 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
66
52

50
53
4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

VOICE The Panel Logos


60 VOICE buttons ..................................................................... P. 58 The logos printed on the Clavinova panel indicate standards/formats it
supports and special features it includes.
MUSIC FINDER GM System Level 1
61 [MUSIC FINDER] button ...................................................... P. 73 “GM System Level 1” is an addition to the MIDI standard which
guarantees that any data conforming to the standard will play
ONE TOUCH SETTING accurately on any GM-compatible tone generator or synthesizer from
62 [1] - [4] buttons (ONE TOUCH SETTING)............................ P. 71 any manufacturer.
PIANO Setting XG Format
XG is a new Yamaha MIDI specification which significantly expands
63 [PIANO] button ..................................................................... P. 59 and improves on the “GM System Level 1” standard with greater
REGISTRATION MEMORY voice handling capacity, expressive control, and effect capability
while retaining full compatibility with GM. By using the Clavinova’s
64 [FREEZE] button .................................................................. P. 90 XG voices, it is possible to record XG-compatible song files.
65 [1] – [8] buttons (REGISTRATION MEMORY) ..................... P. 88
66 [MEMORY] button ................................................................ P. 88 XF Format
The Yamaha XF format enhances the SMF (Standard MIDI File)
standard with greater functionality and open-ended expandability for
67 Floppy disk drive (3.5”)........................................................... P. 6 the future. The Clavinova is capable of displaying lyrics when an XF
68 Keyboard guide lamps ......................................................... P. 82 file containing lyric data is played. (SMF is the most common format
used for MIDI sequence files. The Clavinova is compatible with SMF
Microphone and Headphone Connectors Formats 0 and 1, and records “song” data using SMF Format 0.)
69 [INPUT VOLUME] knob...................................................... P. 155
Vocal Harmony
70 [MIC. LINE IN] jack............................................................. P. 155 Vocal Harmony employs state-of-the-art digital signal processing
71 [MIC. LINE] switch.............................................................. P. 155 technology to automatically add appropriate vocal harmony to a lead
72 [PHONES] jacks................................................................. P. 155 vocal line sung by the user. Vocal Harmony can even change the
character and gender of the lead voice as well as the added voices to
Connectors produce a wide range of vocal harmony effects.
73 MIDI [THRU] [OUT] [IN] terminals...................................... P. 157
Disk Orchestra Collection
74 [USB] terminal.................................................................... P. 157 The DOC voice allocation format provides data playback
75 [AUX PEDAL] jack.............................................................. P. 157 compatibility with a wide range of Yamaha instruments and MIDI
76 [VIDEO OUT] jack .............................................................. P. 156 devices.
77 AUX IN [L / L+R] [R] jacks.................................................. P. 156
Style File Format
78 AUX OUT [L / L+R] [R] jacks.............................................. P. 156 The Style File Format (SFF) is Yamaha’s original style file format, which
79 AUX OUT (LEVEL FIXED) [L] [R] jacks ............................. P. 156 uses a unique conversion system to provide high-quality automatic
accompaniment based on a wide range of chord types. The Clavinova
Pedals uses the SFF internally, reads optional SFF style disks, and creates SFF
80 Left pedal ............................................................................. P. 62 styles using the Style Creator feature.
81 Sostenuto pedal ................................................................... P. 62
USB
82 Damper pedal ...................................................................... P. 62 USB is an abbreviation for Universal Serial Bus. It is a serial interface
for connecting a computer with peripheral devices. It allows “hot
swapping” (connecting peripheral devices while the power to the
computer is on).

CVP-210/208 19
Quick Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Playing the Demos Reference
on page 56

The Clavinova features an extensive variety of Demo


songs, that showcase its rich, authentic voices and its Demo button
dynamic rhythms and styles.
What’s more, there’s a special selection of Demo
functions. These take you through a hands-on journey of
all the important features and functions of the instrument
— letting you see firsthand how to effectively use the
Clavinova in your own music.

1 Press the [DEMO] button to


call up the menu for
2 Press the [BACK]/[NEXT] button to select the Demo
categories.
selecting a Demo song.
BACK NEXT

MENU

DEMO

HELP

FUNCTION

Function Demos demon-


For this example, VOICE is strate many of the different
selected. Voice Demos functions on the CVP-210/
showcase the voices of the 208. Style Demos introduce
CVP-210/208. you to the rhythms and
accompaniment styles of the
CVP-210/208 (page 56).

3 Press any of the [A] to [J] buttons or [8▼] (AUTO) button (FUNCTION page only) to select the Demo songs.
For this example, press the [A] button to playback the GrandPiano(C) demo.

For details about the Demos,


A F VOICE PART refer to page 56.
ON ⁄ OFF

B G LAYER

C H LEFT

D I

E J

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Press the [EXIT] button to exit from the demo mode and return to the MAIN display when you’ve finished playing the
demo songs.

When you’re done with the Demos, you can get to know your Clavinova even better with these functions:
• Preset Song (Song Book) playback (page 21)
• Disk Song Playback (page 21)
• Short demo playback of the selected voice (in the Voice Open display; page 26).

20 Quick Guide
Song Playback

Song Playback Reference


on page 77
Here’s where all of the amazing voices, effects, rhythms, styles and other sophisticated features of
the Clavinova come together — in songs!
As you heard in the Demos, the Clavinova contains many built-in recordings. But there’s more. Call up the Song Open
(PRESET) display. And there’s an even greater wealth of song material you can enjoy with your Clavinova — in
commercially available software.

Make sure that the Lan-


Song related buttons guage setting for the instru-
ment (page 154) is the same
as that of the file name of the
song that you are playing
back.

BALANCE and Floppy disk drive


CHANNEL buttons

The following songs are compatible for playback on the CVP-210/208. Refer to pages 77, 162 for more details on the
logos.

Disks bearing this logo contain song data for voices defined in the GM standard. Songs containing a large
amount of data may not be
Disks bearing this logo contain song data using the XG format, an extension of the GM able to be read properly by
standard that provides a wider variety of voices and more comprehensive sonic control. the instrument, and as such
you may not be able to
Disks bearing this logo contain song data for voices defined in Yamaha’s DOC format. select them. The maximum
capacity is about 200–
300KB, however this may
differ depending on the data
contents of each song.

Playback of Songs

1 If you want to play back a disk song, insert an appropriate disk containing song data into the disk drive.
CAUTION
• Make sure to read the
section “Using the Floppy
Disk Drive (FDD) and
Floppy Disks” on page 6.

Quick Guide 21
Song Playback

2 Press the [A] button to call up the Song Open display.


If the MAIN screen is not displayed, press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button followed by the [EXIT] button.

B
From the MAIN display (the
display shown when the
C
power is turned on), you can
D
select songs, voices, accom-
paniment styles, etc.
E

PRESET FLOPPY DISK

Press the [BACK]/[NEXT] button to select the drive.

3 Press the [A] button to select the preset songs (Song Book) folder.

22 Quick Guide
Song Playback

4 Press one of the [A] to [J] buttons to select a song file.

5 Press the SONG [START/STOP] button to start playback.

REC TOP START / STOP


• To rewind or fast forward to the playback point of the song, press the [REW] or [FF] button.
• With song data software (Standard MIDI format 0) that includes lyrics, you can view the lyr-
ics on the display during playback. You can also view the score. See pages 84 and 87 for
NEW SONG SYNC.START
details.

6 While the song is playing, try using the Mute function to turn certain instrument channels off or on —
letting you craft dynamic arrangements on the fly!
1) Press the [CHANNEL ON/OFF] button.
2) Press the [1 - 8▲▼] button corresponding to the channel you wish to turn on or off.

CHANNEL
ON / OFF

PART
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

If the STYLE tab is


selected, press this button
again.

Quick Guide 23
Song Playback

7 Finally, take the producer’s seat and try your hand at mixing. These Balance controls let you adjust the levels
of the individual parts — the song, the style, your singing, and your playing.
1) Press the [BALANCE] button.
2) Press the [1 - 8▲▼] button corresponding to the part of which the volume you wish to adjust.

BALANCE You can call up a full set of


mixing controls by pressing
the [MIXING CONSOLE]
button (page 123).

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

8 Press the SONG [START/STOP] button to stop playback.


REC TOP START / STOP

• The [FADE IN/OUT] but-


ton (page 69) can be used
NEW SONG SYNC.START to produce smooth fade-
ins and fade-outs when
starting and stopping the
song, as well as the
accompaniment.

24 Quick Guide
Playing Voices

Playing Voices Reference


The Clavinova features a stunning variety of over 800 dynamic, rich and realistic voices. Try playing on page 58
some of these voices now and hear what they can do for your music. Here, you’ll learn how to
select individual voices, combine two voices in a layer, and split two voices between your left and right hands.

Voice related buttons

Playing a Voice

1 Press the [F] button to call up the menu for selecting the MAIN voice.
If the MAIN screen is not displayed, press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button followed by the [EXIT] button.

The voice you’re selecting


here belongs to the MAIN
part, and is called the MAIN
F VOICE PART
ON OFF voice. (See page 60 for more
G LAYER information.)
H LEFT

You’ll want to hear the MAIN


voice all by itself — so make sure
that the LAYER and LEFT parts
are turned off.

2 Select a voice group.

VOICE
PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES

BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER

For this example, STRINGS


is selected.

Press the [BACK]/[NEXT]


button to select the memory
location of the voice. For this
example, PRESET is
selected.

Quick Guide 25
Playing Voices

3 Select a voice.

You can instantly jump back


A
to the Main display by “dou-
ble-clicking” on one of the [A]
B
- [J] buttons.
C

For this example, E

”Orchestra” is
selected. Press the [8▲] button to start the
Demo for the selected voice. To stop
the Demo, press this button again.
There’s more to the Demo features
Press the corresponding buttons to select the than just voices, though–for more
other pages — and discover even more voices. information, see page 56.

4 Play the voices.


Naturally, you can play the voice yourself from the keyboard, but you can also
have the Clavinova demonstrate the voice for you. Simply press the [8▲] button
from the display above, and a Demo of the voice plays automatically.

Playing Two Voices Simultaneously

1 Press the VOICE PART ON/OFF [LAYER] button to


turn the LAYER part on.
VOICE PART
ON OFF

G LAYER

2 Press the [G] button to select the LAYER part.


H LEFT

3 Select a voice group.


Here, we’ll select a lush pad to fill out the sound. Call up the “CHOIR & PAD” group.

VOICE
PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES

BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER

4 Select a voice.
For example, select “Hah Choir.”

5 Play the voices.


Now, you can play two different voices together in a
rich sounding layer — the MAIN voice you selected in
the previous section, plus the new LAYER voice you’ve
selected here.

And that’s just the beginning. Check out these other voice-related features:
• Instant setup of the Clavinova for piano play — with the press of a single button (page 59).
• Create your own original voices — quickly and easily — by changing the settings of existing voices (page 91).
• Set up your favorite panel settings — including voices, styles, and more — and call them up whenever you need
them (page 88).

26 Quick Guide
Playing Voices

Playing Different Voices with the Left and Right Hands

1 Press the VOICE PART ON/OFF [LEFT] button to turn the


LEFT part on.
VOICE PART
ON OFF

G LAYER

2 Press the [H] button to select the LEFT part.


H LEFT

3 Select a voice group.


Here, we’ll select the “STRINGS” group — so that you can play rich, orchestral chords with your left hand.

VOICE
PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES

BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER

4 Select a voice, then press the [EXIT] button to return to the MAIN display.
For example, select “Symphon. Str.”

5 Press the [I] button to call up the SPLIT POINT display. From here, you can set the particular key on the
keyboard that separates the two voices — called the Split Point. To do this, simultaneously hold down the [F]
or [G] button and press the desired key on the keyboard. (For more information, see page 141.)

F F

G G

H H

I I

J J

6 Play the voices.


The notes you play with your left hand sound one voice, while the notes you play with your right sound a
different voice (or voices).

Split Point

LEFT MAIN/LAYER

MAIN and LAYER voices are meant to be played with the right hand. The LEFT voice is played with the left
hand.

7 Press the [EXIT] button to return to the MAIN display.

EXIT

Quick Guide 27
Playing Styles

Playing Styles Reference


The Clavinova has a huge variety of musical “styles” that you can call upon to back up your own on page 63
performance. They give you anything from a simple, yet effective piano backing or percussion
accompaniment to a full band or orchestra.

Style related buttons

Playing a style

1 Press the [D] button to call up the style group.


If the MAIN screen is not displayed, press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button followed by the [EXIT] button.

Press the
[BACK]/[NEXT]
A button to select
B
the memory
location of the
C style. For this
example,
D
PRESET is
E selected.

2 Select a style group and a style.

A
A

B
B

C
C

D
D

E
E

For this example, Dance is For this example,


selected. EuroTrance is selected.

28 Quick Guide
Playing Styles

3 Turn ACMP on.


The specified left-hand section of the keyboard becomes the “Auto Accompaniment” section, and chords
played in this section are automatically detected and used as a basis for fully automatic accompaniment with
the selected style.

Split Point • The point on the keyboard


ACMP
that separates the auto
accompaniment section
and the right-hand sec-
tion of the keyboard is
called the “split point.”
Auto Accompaniment Refer to page 141 for
section instructions on setting the
split point.

4 Turn SYNC.START on.


SYNC.START

5 As soon as you play a chord with your left hand, the style starts.
For this example, play a C major chord (as shown below).
Split Point

Auto Accompaniment
section

6 Change the tempo by using the TEMPO[ ] [ ] buttons if necessary.


Simultaneously press the TEMPO [ ] [ ] buttons to return the tempo to its The Tempo can also be
original setting. Press the [EXIT] button to leave the TEMPO display. adjusted by using the [TAP
TEMPO] button (page 55).

7 Try playing other chords with your left hand.


For information on how to enter chords, see “Chord Fingerings” on page 66.

8 Press the STYLE [START/STOP] button to stop the style.

And there’s much more. Check out these other style-related features:
• Easily create your own original styles (page 113).
• Set up your favorite panel settings — including styles, voices, and more — and call them up whenever you need
them (page 88).

Quick Guide 29
Playing Styles

Embellish and enhance your melodies — with the automatic Harmony and Echo effects
This powerful performance feature lets you automatically add harmony notes to the melodies you play with your
right hand — based on the chords you play with your left. Tremolo, Echo, and other effects are available, too.
1 Turn HARMONY/ECHO on. VOICE EFFECT
REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY / ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD

2 Turn ACMP on (page 28).


3 Play a chord with your left hand and play some notes in the right-hand range of the
keyboard. For details about Harmony/
The CVP-210/208 has various Harmony/Echo types (page 146). Echo types, refer to the sep-
The Harmony/Echo type may change according to the selected MAIN voice. arate Data List.

• Harmony/Echo is just one of the many Voice Effects you can use. Try out some of
the other effects and see how they can enhance your performance (page 61).

Style Sections
Each style in the auto accompaniment is made up of “sections.” Since each section is a rhythmic variation of the basic
style, you can use them to add spice to your performance and mix up the beats — while you’re playing. Intros, Endings,
Main patterns, and Breaks — they’re all here, giving you the dynamic elements you need to create professional-
sounding arrangements.
INTRO This is used for the beginning of the song. When the intro finishes playing, accompaniment shifts to the
main section.
MAIN This is used for playing the main part of the song. It plays an accompaniment pattern of several measures,
and repeats indefinitely until another section’s button is pressed.
BREAK This lets you add dynamic variations and breaks in the rhythm of the accompaniment, to make your
performance sound even more professional.
ENDING This is used for the ending of the song. When the ending is finished, the auto accompaniment stops
automatically.

1-4 Use the same operations as in “Playing a style” on pages 28 and 29.

5 Press the [INTRO] button. BREAK INTRO

A B
MAIN

C D
ENDING / rit.

6 As soon as you play a chord with your left hand, the Intro starts.
For this example, play a C major chord (as shown below).
Split Point

Auto Accompaniment
section

When the playback of the intro is finished, it automatically leads into main section.

7 Press any of the MAIN [A] to [D] buttons or [BREAK] button


as desired. (See the Accompaniment Structure on the next
BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit.

A B C D
page.) or

30 Quick Guide
Playing Styles

8 Press the [AUTO FILL IN] button to add a fill-in, if


necessary.
AUTO FILLIN

Fill-in patterns play automatically between each change in


the Main sections.

9 Press the [ENDING] button.


This switches to the ending section. When the ending is
BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit.

A B C D
finished, the style automatically stops.

■ Accompaniment Structure

INTRO (page 70) INTRO A INTRO B INTRO C

(max. three patterns)

MAIN VARIATION
via BREAK

MAIN
VARIATION
B

MAIN MAIN
VARIATION VARIATION
A C via BREAK
via BREAK

MAIN
VARIATION
D

via BREAK

Press the [ENDING] button.

You can have the


ending gradually slow
ENDING A ENDING B ENDING C down (ritardando) by
ENDING (page 70) pressing the [ENDING]
button again while the
ending is playing back.
(max. three patterns)

• An Intro doesn’t necessarily have to be at the beginning! If you want, you can play an Intro section in the middle of your performance by
simply pressing the INTRO] button at the desired point.
• Watch your timing with the Break sections. If you press a [BREAK] button too close to the end of the measure (i.e., after the final eighth
note), the Break section starts playing from the next measure. This also applies to the Auto Fill-in.
• Mix up your intros and use any of the other sections to start the style, if you want.
• If you want to come back into the style right away after an Ending, simply press the [INTRO] button while the Ending section is playing.
• If you press the [BREAK] button while the ending is playing, the break will immediately start playing, continuing with the main section.

Quick Guide 31
Playing Styles

Other Controls
FADE IN/OUT The [FADE IN/OUT] button can be used to produce smooth fade-ins and fade-outs (page 69) when starting and stopping
FADE IN / OUT
the style.

TAP TEMPO The style can be started at any tempo you desire by “tapping” out the tempo with the [TAP TEMPO] button. For details,
TAP TEMPO see page 55.

SYNC.STOP When Synchro Stop is on, you can stop and start the style anytime you want by simply releasing or playing the keys (in
SYNC.STOP the Auto Accompaniment section of the keyboard). This is a great way to add dramatic breaks and accents to your
performance. For details, see page 69.

ONE TOUCH SETTING


buttons

One Touch Setting


One Touch Setting is a powerful and convenient feature that automatically calls up the most appropriate panel settings
(voice number, etc.) for the currently selected style, with the touch of a single button. This is a wonderful way to
instantly reconfigure all the settings on the Clavinova to match the style you want to play.

1 Select a style (page 28).

2 Press one of the [ONE TOUCH SETTING]


buttons.
ONE TOUCH SETTING

Not only does this instantly call up all the settings 1 2 3 4

(voices, effects, etc.) that match the current style


(see page 71) — it also automatically turns on
ACMP and SYNC. START, so that you can
immediately start playing the style.

3 As soon as you play a chord with your left hand, the auto
accompaniment starts.

4 Play melodies with your right hand and play various chords
with your left hand.
Split Point

Auto Accompaniment
section

5 Try out other One Touch Setting setups.


You can also create your own One Touch Setting
ONE TOUCH SETTING

1 2 3 4
setups.
For details, refer to page 72.

• Here’s another way to further automate musical changes and spice up your performance: Use the convenient OTS
(One Touch Setting) Link function to automatically change One Touch Settings when you select a different Main
section (page 72).

32 Quick Guide
Music Finder

Music Finder Reference


on page 73

MUSIC FINDER button

If you want to play in a certain song but don’t know which style and voice settings would be appropriate, the
convenient Music Finder can help you out. Simply select the song name from the Music Finder and the CVP-210/208
automatically makes all appropriate panel settings to let you play in that music style!

Using the Music Finder

1 Press the [MUSIC FINDER] button.


MUSIC FINDER

2 Select a record.

Press the [BACK]/[NEXT]


button to select the desired
page of records. For this
example, ALL is selected.

Select the desired


record.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

For this example, press the [1 - 3▲▼] button to select a record by song title.

3 Play along with the style playback.

You can also have the voice


and other important settings
change automatically with
the style changes. To do this,
Split Point
turn on OTS LINK (page 72)
and set the OTS LINK TIM-
ING (page 141) to “REAL
TIME.”

Auto Accompaniment
section

Press the [EXIT] button to return to the MAIN display.

Quick Guide 33
Music Finder

Searching the Music Finder Records


The Music Finder is also equipped with a convenient search function that lets you enter a song title or keyword — and
instantly call up all the records that match your search criteria.

1 Press the [MUSIC FINDER] button.


MUSIC FINDER

2 Press the [I] button to call up the MUSIC FINDER SEARCH 1 display.
The results of Search 1 and
2 appear in the correspond-
ingly numbered SEARCH 1/
2 displays.

Refer to page 49 for instruc-


tions on entering characters.
A F

4 For this example,


press the [A]
B G

button to call up C H

the display for D I

inputting the song E J

title. 3 Press the [F], [G]


and [H] to clear
For this example, the previous
ANY is selected. conditions, if
necessary.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

5 Enter the song title,


then press the [8▲]
For this example,
(OK) button. Press the [8▲] (START SEARCH)
ALL is selected.
6 button.
The search function calls up all
records that contain the entered
word or words.

34 Quick Guide
Music Finder

7 Select a record (see step #2 on page 33) and play along with the style playback.

Split Point

Auto Accompaniment
section

Press the [EXIT] button to return to the MAIN display.


You can also create your own Music Finder setups and save them to floppy disk (pages 40 and 48). In this
way, you can expand your Music Finder collection by exchanging them with other Clavinova users.

Saving and Recalling Music Finder Data


To save your Music Finder data, call up the MUSIC FINDER Open/Save window from
the SYSTEM RESET page (page 154) of the UTILITY display, and follow the same Music Finder data is compat-
procedure as that in the Open/Save window for Voice (page 40, 48). To recall the ible for both the CVP-210
saved data, execute the appropriate operation from the MUSIC FINDER’s Open/Save and the CVP-208.
window. Records can be replaced or added (page 75).

In the instructions above, all Music Finder data is handled together. Besides this, when you save or load style files,
the Music Finder data that uses the relevant style file(s) is stored or added automatically. When you copy or move a
style file on a floppy disk to the USER drive (page 46, 47), the record which was recorded when storing the relevant
style is automatically added to the CVP-210/208.

• In the example above, you specified a song title, but you can also look for relevant records by keyword or music
genre — for example, Latin, 8-beat, etc. (page 74).

Quick Guide 35
Playing and Practicing with the Songs

Playing and Practicing with the Songs Reference


on page 77

Song related buttons

Playing Along with the Clavinova


In this section, try using the Clavinova’s song playback features to cancel or mute the right-hand melody while you play
the part yourself. It’s like having a very talented and versatile playing partner accompany you while you perform.
If you haven't yet mastered the melody part, take a look at the section “Mastering Your Favorite Songs” on page 38, and
practice it a while.

1-4 Use the same operations as in “Song Playback” on pages 21 - 23.

5 Press the [TRACK 1] button to cancel the right hand melody part.
TRACK 1
(R) To cancel the left hand part,
press the [TRACK 2] button.

6 If you want to have the notation displayed as you play, press the [C] button. If you want to see the lyrics,
press the [B] button.
If the MAIN screen is not displayed, press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button followed by the [EXIT] button.

If the selected song does not


A
contain lyric data, lyrics are
not displayed.
B

7 Press the SONG [START/STOP] button and play the part.


REC TOP START / STOP • If you want to start the song right
away without an intro, use the Sync
Start function. To set Sync Start to
NEW SONG SYNC.START
standby, simultaneously hold down
the [TOP] button and press the
SONG [START/STOP] button. Song
playback starts automatically the
moment you start playing the mel-

8 Press the SONG [START/STOP] button to stop playback.


ody.
• If you can hear the Clavinova playing
the melody part as well, check the
REC TOP START / STOP
channel setting for the melody part in
the song data, and change the chan-
nel assigned to Track 1 (page 140).
NEW SONG SYNC.START
You can also change the song chan-
nel itself permanently (page 108).

36 Quick Guide
Playing and Practicing with the Songs

Recording
The Clavinova lets you record, too — quickly and easily. Try out the Quick Recording feature now and capture your
keyboard performance.

1-3 Select a voice for recording. Use the same operations as in “Playing a Voice” on pages 25, 26.

4 Press the [REC] and [TOP] buttons simultaneously to select “New Song” for recording.

REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT

NEW SONG SYNC.START

5 Press the [REC] button.

REC

6 Recording starts as soon as you start playing the keyboard.

7 When you’ve finished recording, press the [REC] button.


REC

8 To hear your newly recorded performance, return the song to the beginning by
using the [TOP] button and press the SONG [START/STOP] button. CAUTION
The recorded data will be
REC TOP START / STOP
lost if you turn off the
power. To keep your impor-
tant recordings, you’ll
NEW SONG SYNC.START need to save them to the
User drive or floppy disk.

9 Save the recorded data as required (pages 40, 48).

Quick Guide 37
Playing and Practicing with the Songs

Mastering Your Favorite Songs


The Clavinova has several very useful practice features that help learn and master
recorded songs. Here, you’ll try out the Follow Lights function, and use the special guide Before Practicing
lamps to help you play the right notes. Before starting a practice
session, play back the entire
song (without canceling any

1-6 Use the same operations as in “Playing Along with the Clavinova” on
page 36.
parts) and listen to it care-
fully. This will give you a
clear idea of how the song
should be played, and will
For this example, you practice the right hand part of “Playing Along with make your practice sessions
the Clavinova.” progress more smoothly. If
you want to hear only the
melody part, turn the
[TRACK 2] and [EXTRA

7 Press the [GUIDE] button.


TRACKS] buttons off.

GUIDE

8 Press the SONG [START/STOP] button and practice the missing (muted) part, according to the key guide
lamps.
If you want, you can adjust the tempo by pressing the TEMPO[ ] [ ] buttons.

REC TOP START / STOP TEMPO

RESET
NEW SONG SYNC.START

9 You can use the powerful Repeat function to practice and master difficult parts. Simply specify a short
phrase you want to work on and repeat it until you’ve got it down.
1) While the song is playing back, press the [GUIDE] button once to turn the GUIDE function off.
2) Just before the desired phrase comes around, press the [REPEAT] button to designate the beginning point
for Repeat.
3) Just after the phrase finishes, press the [REPEAT] button again to designate the end point.
4) Turn the GUIDE function on again.

10 Press the SONG [START/STOP] button to stop playback.


REC TOP START / STOP See pages 82 and 140 for
more information on the
Guide function.
NEW SONG SYNC.START

38 Quick Guide
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data
Contents shown in the Main Display
When the power is turned on, the MAIN Display appears, showing important and
relevant operation information. If the MAIN Display is not
Pressing the [A] - [J] buttons when the MAIN Display appears calls up displays shown, press the [DIRECT
corresponding to each button. The displays called up by the buttons (with the exception ACCESS] button followed by
the [EXIT] button.
of [B] and [C]) are called Open/Save displays (see following page). Pressing the [B] and
[C] buttons calls up the Lyrics display and Score display respectively.

8 9

1
2 0
3 A
4 B
5
6 C
7 D

1 Transpose (page 144)


The [TRANSPOSE] buttons allow the pitch of the keyboard and song to be shifted down or up in semitones. The transpose value by the
semitone shifted is displayed here.
2 Song (page 78)
The name of the currently selected song and other song information is displayed.
3 Playback Position of Song (page 78) or Accompaniment Style (page 63)
The current position of the song or the accompaniment style being played is displayed.
4 Tempo (page 54)
When a song or a accompaniment style is playing, the tempo is displayed.
5 Chord (page 66)
When [ACMP] is on, the chord specified in the left hand section is displayed.
6 Accompaniment Style (page 63)
The name, beat, and tempo of the accompaniment style selected currently is displayed.
7 Intro and Ending (page 70)
The names of the intro and ending of the currently selected style are displayed.
8 Pedal Function (page 142)
In addition to the conventional Sustain, Sostenuto and Soft functions, the pedals can be assigned to other various functions, such as Song
Start/Stop and Glide. The functions assigned to the three different pedals are displayed here.
9 Registration Sequence (page 145)
You can save your custom panel settings as a Registration Memory preset and recall it at any time pressing the appropriate REGISTRATION
MEMORY [1] - [8] button. You can also use the Registration Sequence function to program the Registration Memory presets to be selected in
any specified order, and step through that order by using the [BACK]/[NEXT] buttons or the pedal. The Registration Sequence is displayed
here (unless Registration Sequence is set to OFF).
0 Main Part (page 58)
The voice selected for the Main part is displayed.
A Layer Part (page 60)
The voice selected for the Layer part is displayed.
B Left Part (page 61)
The voice selected for the Left part is displayed.
C Split Point (page 141)
Split Points are specific positions on the keyboard that divide the keyboard into separate sections. There are two kinds of Split Points: “A”,
which separates the auto accompaniment from the rest of the keyboard, and “L”, which divides the left-hand and right-hand sections.
D Registration Memory Bank (page 89)
Registration Memory presets are stored in banks, eight presets to a bank. The name of the currently selected Registration Memory bank is
displayed here.
E Volume balance of the parts (page 65)
You can change the volume balance by pressing the [1▲▼] - [8▲▼] buttons under the LCD. The volume balance of each part is displayed.

CVP-210/208 39
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Open/Save Display
The CVP-210/208 utilizes a variety of data types — including voices, accompaniment styles, songs and registration
memory settings. Much of this data is already programmed and contained in the CVP-210/208; you can also create and
edit your own data with some of the functions on the instrument.
All this data is stored in separate files — just as is done on a computer.
Here, we’ll show you how to use the basic operations of the display controls in handling and organizing the data of the
CVP-210/208 in files and folders.
Files can be opened, saved, named, moved, or deleted in their respective Open/Save displays. You can select these
displays according to their respective file types, as well: Song, Voice, Style, etc. Moreover, you can organize your data
efficiently by putting various files of the same type into a single folder.
The Open/Save displays for Song, Voice, Style, and Registration Bank can be called up from the MAIN display (the
display shown when the power is turned on) by pressing the appropriate [A] - [J] button.

Open/Save display for Song (page 78) Open/Save display for Voice (page 58)

handles the Song files. handles the Voice files.

The following Open/Save display types are also


available; however, these are selected from displays
A F other than the MAIN display (page 154).
• SYSTEM SETUP
B G
• MIDI SETUP
C H • USER EFFECT
• MUSIC FINDER
D I
• MAIN PICTURE
E J • LYRICS BACKGROUND PICTURE (page 87)

If the MAIN screen is not displayed, press the


[DIRECT ACCESS] button followed by the [EXIT]
button.

Open/Save display for Style (page 63) Open/Save display for Registration Bank (page 89)

handles the Style files. handles the Registration Bank files.

40 CVP-210/208
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Example — Open/Save display


Each Open/Save display consists of three kinds of drive pages: PRESET, USER, and FLOPPY DISK.
In the examples given here, the Open/Save display for Voice is shown.

PRESET drive USER drive FLOPPY DISK drive


The files that are pre- Files kept here are those You can also store your original
programmed and installed containing your own original data to floppy disk.
internally to the CVP-210/208 data, created or edited using the Commercially available disk
are kept here. Preset files can be various functions of the CVP- software can also be called up
loaded but cannot be re-written. 210/208. They are stored here. Naturally, these files are
However, you can use a preset internally to the CVP-210/208. available only when the
file as a basis for creating your appropriate disk is inserted in
own original file (which can be the floppy disk drive.
saved in the USER or FLOPPY
DISK drive).

BACK NEXT

Changes drives among


PRESET, USER and
FLOPPY DISK.

Calls up the upper


level directory page.
In this example, the
voice folder selection
page can be called
up.

Current Memory
File “Current Memory” is the area where the voice is called up when
All data, both pre- you select a voice. Also it is the area where you edit your voice
programmed and your own using the SOUND CREATOR function. Your edited voice should
original, are stored as “files.” then be saved as a file in the USER or FLOPPY DISK drive.
Recording songs (page 97) and creating accompaniment styles
(page 113) are done within the current memory. Please make sure
to properly save this data to the USER/FLOPPY DISK drive as a file
or files. The data will be lost if you turn off the power without
saving.
For details, see page 43.

CVP-210/208 41
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

■ Files and Drives

You can also manage files (copying,


saving, etc.) on the USER drive or
floppy disk by using a computer.
(page 157)

PRESET drive USER drive FLOPPY DISK drive


Cannot be overwritten

Voice Voice Voice

Style Style Style

Song Song Song

Registration Memory Bank Registration Memory Bank

Vocal Harmony Type Vocal Harmony Type

Copy & Paste / Cut & Paste


System Setup System Setup System Setup
Copy

MIDI Template MIDI Template

Save

MIDI Setup MIDI Setup MIDI Setup

User Effect User Effect User Effect

Music Finder Music Finder Music Finder

Main Display Picture Main Display Picture Main Display Picture

Lyrics Background Picture Lyrics Background Picture Lyrics Background Picture

This is the Voice Open/Save display


called up by pressing the [PIANO] but-
ton in the VOICE section. BACK NEXT

Select a Memory drive by


using the [BACK]/[NEXT]
buttons.

The Open/Save display


indicates only those
files that can be man-
aged from the selected
display. The FD (Floppy
Disk) drive of the Voice
Open/Save display, for
example, indicates only
voices even if style or
song files are saved to
the floppy disk.

42 CVP-210/208
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

■ Features and Memory Drives

Data not maintained when the power is turned off

Data maintained when the power is turned off

Features Current Memory USER drive


FLOPPY DISK drive

Unedited voice

Compare

Edit
Sound Creator Voice Voice
Record/
Assemble
Style Creator Style Style

Register
One Touch Setting

Register Registration Memory


Registration Memory
Bank
Panel settings
Creating a
New Record Music Finder Music Finder
Record

System Setup System Setup

Record Save
Song Creator Song Song

Edit
MIDI MIDI settings MIDI Template

Save

MIDI Setup
Edit
Vocal Harmony Type User Vocal Harmony

User Effect Edit


User Effect User Effect
(Mixing Console)

Edit
Master EQ Edit User Master EQ
(Mixing Console)

CAUTION
• The data in the USER/
FLOPPY DISK drive is main- * The Save operation is executed from the
Open/Save display.
tained even when the power
is turned off. However, cur-
rently active data in mem- **The corresponding Open/Save display
can be called up from the [FUNCTION]
ory may be lost when you → UTILITY → SYSTEM RESET display.
select another file or turn
the power off. Make sure to
save any necessary data in
memory to the User drive or
the Floppy Disk drive before
selecting another file or
turning the power off.

CVP-210/208 43
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Selecting Files and Folders


Select a file shown in the display. In this example, we’ll select a voice file.
First, press the VOICE [PIANO & HARPSI] button to call up the display containing the files.
This display (“Open/Save” display) is typical of those used to call up and store files (voice files).
The CVP-210/208 already contains a variety of voices in the PRESET section. You can store your own original voices
created with the Sound Creator function to the USER or FLOPPY DISK section.

BACK NEXT
1 Select “PRESET,” “USER,” or
“FLOPPY DISK” by using the
[BACK][NEXT] button.
A F VOICE PART
ON OFF

B G LAYER

Selecting a different lan-


C H LEFT
ENTER guage in the “LANGUAGE”
D I display (page 53, 154) may
cause the following prob-
E J
lems.
DATA • Some characters of the
ENTRY
file names you entered
may be garbled.
• Files may not be accessi-
ble.
Restoring the original lan-
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
3 Select the file/folder.
There are two ways to select the file/
guage solves the above
problems.
folder: Reading the files on the
• Press the [A] - [J] button. computer with a different
Use the [1▲] - [7▲] buttons to
2 turn the pages.
Press the letter button
corresponding to the file/folder you
language system may cause
similar problems to those
When the amount of pages exceeds seven, wish to call up. (In the example above.
the bottom of the display changes as shown display shown above, the voice files
below. are shown.)
• Use the [DATA ENTRY] dial and
the [ENTER] button. Double-clicking the
When you turn the [DATA ENTRY] appropriate [A] -[J] button
Press Prev.(previous) Press Next dial, the highlight moves among the calls up the corresponding
available files/folders. Highlight the file and returns to the MAIN
desired file or folder (voice files are display.
shown in the example above) and
press the [ENTER] button to call up
the selected item.
Highlighting the desired file
and double-clicking the
[ENTER] button calls up the
corresponding file and
returns to the MAIN display.
Press the [EXIT] button to go back to the MAIN display.
END You can go back to the previous display by pressing the [EXIT] button.

Exiting from small pop-up windows


You can also exit from small pop-up
windows (such as in the illustration
below) by pressing the [EXIT] button.

44 CVP-210/208
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

File/Folder-related Operations
Naming Files/Folders
You can assign names to files and folders. Any file/folder in the USER and FLOPPY DISK sections can be named or
renamed. Execute the following steps when there is data in the User drive. If there are Preset files/folders you wish to
rename, copy them beforehand (page 47) and use them as User files/folders.

1 Press the [1▼] (NAME) button (page 39).


The NAME display appears.
A file/folder name can con-
tain up to 50 half size letters
(or 25 Hiragana and kanji let-
ters), including the Icon ID
(see the note below) and the
extension.

The file name will appear on


2 Select the appropriate file/folder and press the [7▼](OK) button.
The currently selected file/folder is highlighted. To select another file/folder, press one of the
your computer as follows. If
you change the Icon ID or
[A] - [J] buttons. the extension, the icon may
change or the file may not be
properly recognized.

ABCDE.S002.MID
A F
File ID Icon ID
B G
Extension
C H

D I

E J

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

END Input the new name (page 49).

Press the [8▲] (OK) button. To cancel,


press the [8▼] (CANCEL) button.

CVP-210/208 45
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Moving Files/Folders
You can move files and folders as desired, for organizing your data. Any file/folder in the USER and FLOPPY DISK
sections can be moved, using the cut-and-paste operation described below.

the [2▼] (CUT) button (page 40).


1 Press
The CUT display appears.
This operation cannot be
used to directly move a file/
folder from one floppy disk to
another. If you want to do
this, cut and paste the file or
folder from the first floppy
disk to the USER page, then
change disks and paste it to
the FLOPPY DISK page.

2 Select the desired file/folder for moving.


Select the appropriate file/folder and press the [7▼](OK) button.
The currently selected file/folder is highlighted. To select another file/folder, press one of the [A] - All files/folders in a floppy
[J] buttons. disk can be copied to
Several files/folders can be selected together, even those from other pages. To release or cancel another disk in one batch
the selection, press the button of the selected file/folder again. (page 153).
Press the [6▼] (ALL) button to select all the files/folders in the displayed page (USER/FLOPPY
DISK). When the [6▼] (ALL) button is pressed the [6▼] button changes to “ALL OFF” button to
release or cancel the selection.
After being pasted, the files
are automatically re-ordered
in alphabetical order and
displayed.

3 Press the [7▼] (OK) button.


To stop the operation, press the [8▼] (CANCEL) button.
About files/folders in a
floppy disk
In the FLOPPY DISK page
of the Open/Save display,
only the files which can be
handled in that Open/Save
4 Call up the destination display.
Only the USER and FLOPPY DISK pages can be selected as the destination.
display will appear — even
though a folder in a floppy
disk can contain different
kinds of files.
In the case of a folder cut-
and-paste operation (for
floppy disk), an entire folder
can be cut; however, only the
Press the [4▼] (PASTE) button. specific files which can be
END The file/folder you cut is now pasted at the destination. handled in the current Open/
Save display will be pasted.

46 CVP-210/208
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Copying Files/Folders
You can also copy files and folders as desired, for organizing your data. Any file/folder in the PRESET, USER and
FLOPPY DISK sections can be copied, using the copy-and-paste operation described below.

the [3▼] (COPY) button


1 Press
(page 40).
2 Select the desired file/folder.
Select the appropriate file/folder
Please note that the copy
functions are intended for
The COPY display appears. and press the [7▼](OK) button. your personal use only.
The currently selected file/folder is
highlighted. To select another file/
folder, press one of the [A] - [J]
buttons.
This operation cannot be
Several files/folders can be
used to directly copy a file/
selected together, even those from
folder from one floppy disk to
other pages. To release or cancel
another. If you want to do
the selection, press the button of
this, copy and paste the file
the selected file/folder again.
or folder from the first floppy
Press the [6▼] (ALL) button to
disk to the User page, then
select all the files/folders in the
change disks and paste it to
displayed page (PRESET/USER/
the Floppy Disk page.
FLOPPY DISK). When the [6▼]
3 Press the [7▼] (OK) button.
To stop the operation, press the [8▼]
(ALL) button is pressed, the [6▼]
button changes to “ALL OFF,”
(CANCEL) button. letting you release or cancel the
selection.

4 Call up the destination display.


Only the USER and FLOPPY DISK pages can
END
Press the [4▼] (PASTE) button.
The file/folder you copied is now pasted at the destination.
be selected as the destination.

Deleting Files/Folders
You can also delete files and folders as desired, for organizing your data. Any file/folder in the USER and FLOPPY DISK
sections can be deleted, using the operation described below.

Press the [7▼] (OK) button.


1 Press the [5▼] (DELETE) button (page 40).
The DELETE display appears. END To cancel the operation, press the [8▼] (CANCEL)
button.

The message “Are you sure you want to delete the


“******” file (or data/folder)? YES/NO” appears.
YES ........... Deletes the highlighted item.
NO............. Exits from the prompt without deleting.

When several files have been selected, the message

2 Select the desired file/folder.


Select the appropriate file/folder and press the [7▼](OK)
“Are you sure you want to delete the “******” file (or
data/folder)? YES/YES ALL/NO/CANCEL” appears.
button. YES/NO..... Deletes the highlighted item (YES), or
The currently selected file/folder is highlighted. To select skips the highlighted item without
another file/folder, press one of the [A] - [J] buttons. deleting (NO).
Several files/folders can be selected together, even YES ALL ... Deletes all selected items at once.
those from other pages. To release or cancel the CANCEL ... Exits from the prompt without deleting.
selection, press the button of the selected file/folder
again.
Press the [6▼] (ALL) button to select all the files/folders
in the displayed page (USER/FLOPPY DISK). When the
[6▼] (ALL) button is pressed, the [6▼] button changes
to “ALL OFF,” letting you release or cancel the selection.

CVP-210/208 47
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Saving Files
This operation lets you save the data (such as song and voice) you created in current
memory (page 41) to files. The files can be saved only to the USER and FLOPPY DISK The internal memory capac-
drives. ity of the Clavinova is about
If the Open/Save display for the type of data you wish to save is not shown, first return to the 3.3MB. Memory capacity for
2DD and 2HD floppy disks is
MAIN display by pressing the [DIRECT ACCESS] button followed by the [EXIT] button.
about 720KB and 1.44MB,
Then, press the appropriate button [A] - [J] from the MAIN display to call up the respective respectively. When you store
Open/Save display. Finally, call up the USER or FLOPPY DISK page (pages 40, 41). data to these locations, all
file types of the Clavinova
(Voice, Style, Song, Regis-
the [6▼]
1 Press
(SAVE) button.
Enter a name for the new file (page 49). tration, etc.) are stored
together.

The files of commercially


available DOC software and
Press the [8▲] (OK) button. Yamaha Disklavier software,
To stop the operation, press the [8▼] (CANCEL) button. and their edited files on the
CVP-210/208, can be stored
in the USER page, but can-
not be copied to another
floppy disk.

Organizing Files by Creating a New Folder


This operation lets you easily organize your various files into categories by creating a new Folder directories can con-
folder for each category. Folders can only be created in the USER and FLOPPY DISK tain up to four levels.
sections. The maximum total number
of files and folders which can
be stored is 3,200, but this
may differ depending on the
1 Call up the page to
which you wish to
Enter the name of the new folder (page 49).
length of the file names.
The maximum number of
create a new folder files which can be stored in a
and press the [7▼] folder will be 250.

(NEW) button
Press the [8▲](OK) button.
(page 40). To cancel the operation, press the [8▼] (CANCEL) button.

Displaying Upper Level pages


Press the [8▼] (UP) button to call up the upper level pages. For example, you can call up the folder level pages from
the file level pages.

Entering Characters and Changing Icons

the [1▼]
1 Press
(NAME), [6▼]
Change the type of character by using the [1▲] button.
If you select Japanese as the Language in the
FUNCTION display (page 154), the following
(SAVE), or [7▼] different types of characters and sizes can be
(NEW) button entered:
(page 40). (kana-kan)
Hiragana and kanji, marks (full size) Call up the ICON SELECT display by pressing
(kana) the [1▼] button. This lets you change the icon
Katakana (normal size), marks (full size) at the left of the file name.
(kana)
Katakana (half size), marks (half size)
A B C — Alphabet (capital and small letters, full size), numbers (full size), marks (full size)
ABC — Alphabet (capital and small letters, half size), numbers (half size), marks (half size)

If you’ve selected a language other than Japanese in the FUNCTION display (page 154), the
following types of characters are available:
CASE — Alphabet (capital letters, half size), numbers (half size), marks (half size)
case — Alphabet (lowercase letters, half size), numbers (half size), marks (half size)

48 CVP-210/208
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Entering Characters
The instructions that follow show you how to enter characters in naming your files and folders. The method is much the
same as inputting names and numbers to your cell phone.

1 Move the cursor to the desired position by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial.

Press the appropriate button, [2▲] - [7▲] and [2▼]- [6▼], corresponding to the character you wish to enter.
2 Several different characters are assigned to each button, and the characters change each time you press the button.
To actually enter the selected character, move the cursor or press another letter-input button.
If you’ve entered a character by mistake, move the cursor to the character letter you wish to erase and press the
[7▼] (DELETE) button. If you want to delete all of the characters on the line at once, press and hold down the
[7▼] (DELETE) button for a while, or press the [8▼] (CANCEL) button. When the cursor appears in reverse display
(highlight), only the reversed area is deleted.

To actually enter the new name, press the [8▲] (OK) button.
3 To cancel the operation, press the [8▼] (CANCEL) button.
The following half-size
marks cannot be used in
■ Converting into Kanji (Japanese language) naming files and folders:
¥\/:*?“<>|
This applies only if you are using the “ (kana-kan)” button (in Japanese). When
the input “hiragana” characters are shown in reverse display (highlighted), press the
[ENTER] button one or several times to convert the characters into the appropriate
kanji. The reversed area can be changed by the [DATA ENTRY] dial. The converted
area can be changed back to “hiragana” by the [7▼] (DELETE) button. The reversed
area can be cleared at once by the [8▼] (CANCEL) button. To actually enter the
change, press the [8▲] (OK) button or enter the next character. To enter the
“hiragana” itself (without converting it), press the [8▲] (OK) button.

■ Entering special character marks (umlaut, accent, Japanese “ ” and “ ”)


Select a character to which a character mark is to be added and press the [6▼] button
(before actual entry of the character.)

■ Entering miscellaneous characters (marks)


You can call up the mark list by pressing the [6▼] button, after actually entering a
character by moving the cursor. In the case of characters
which are not accompanied
by special character marks
(with the exception of kana-
kan and half-size katakana),
you can call up the mark list
Move the cursor to the desired mark by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial, then press the by pressing the [6▼] button
[8▲] (OK) or [ENTER] button. after selecting a character
(before actual entry of a
character).
■ Entering numbers
First, select one of the following: “A B C” (full-size alphabet), “ABC” ”CASE“ (half-size
capital alphabet) and “case” (half-size lowercase alphabet). Then, press and hold
down the appropriate button, [2▲] - [7▲] and [2▼] - [5▼], for a while, or press it
repeatedly until the desired number is selected.

CVP-210/208 49
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Changing the Icon


You can also change the icon that
appears at the left of the file name.
Call up the ICON SELECT display by BACK NEXT

pressing the [1▼] (ICON) button from


the character input display (page 49). A F

Select the desired icon by using the B G


Turns pages
[A] - [J] buttons, or by using the C H
for icon
selection.
[3▲▼] - [5▲▼] buttons, then enter D I

the selected icon by pressing the [8▲] E J

(OK) button.

Enters the selected icon.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Cancels the icon selection operation.

Using the [DATA ENTRY] Dial


This convenient control lets you easily select items in the display or quickly change parameter values. The actual
function of the [DATA ENTRY] dial differs depending on the selected display.

■ Adjusting values
You can change parameter values by
rotating the [DATA ENTRY] dial. In the
example [BALANCE] display, turning
the dial adjusts the volume of the part
in reverse display (highlight). To adjust
the volume of another part, first select
the part by pressing the [▲▼] button
corresponding to the part, then rotate
the [DATA ENTRY] dial.

■ Selecting items
You can select the desired item or
function in the display by rotating the
[DATA ENTRY] dial. The selected item
can then be called up or executed by
using the [ENTER] button. ENTER

In the example VOICE display, you


can select the desired voice file with
the [DATA ENTRY] dial, and call up DATA
ENTRY

the selected item by pressing the


[ENTER] button on the panel.

50 CVP-210/208
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Direct Access — Instant Selection of Displays

DIRECT ACCESS

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

With the convenient Direct Access function, you can instantly call up the desired display — with just a single additional
button press. Press the [DIRECT ACCESS] button and a message appears in the display prompting you to press the
appropriate button. Then, simply press the button corresponding to the desired setting display to instantly call up that
display. In the example below, Direct Access is used to call up the display for selecting the Chord Fingering (page 142).

ACMP

DIRECT ACCESS

Refer to the Direct Access Chart (page 52) for a list of the displays that can be called up
with the Direct Access function. Here’s a convenient way to
return to the MAIN display
from any other display:
Simply press the [DIRECT
ACCESS] button, then the
[EXIT] button.

CVP-210/208 51
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Direct Access Chart


Operation: [DIRECT ACCESS] button + button listed below Corresponding LCD display and function See pages
STYLE [ACMP] FUNCTION CHORD FINGERING FINGERING TYPE selection 142
[BREAK] VOICE settings
[INTRO] VOLUME/VOICE PANPOT settings 124
MAIN [A] VOLUME settings
MAIN [B] MIXING CONSOLE (STYLE HARMONIC CONTENT settings
FILTER 125
MAIN [C] PART) BRIGHTNESS settings
MAIN [D] REVERB settings
[ENDING] EFFECT CHORUS settings 126
[AUTO FILL IN] DSP settings
[OTS LINK]
FUNCTION STYLE SETTING/SPLIT POINT 141
[SYNC. STOP] SYNC. STOP WINDOW setting
[SYNC. START] —
[START/STOP] —
SONG [TRACK1] TRACK1 CHANNEL selection
[TRACK2] TRACK2 CHANNEL selection
[EXTRA TRACKS] FUNCTION SONG SETTING 140
[REPEAT]
[GUIDE] GUIDE MODE selection
[REC] —
[TOP] —
[START/STOP] —
[REW] —
[FF] —
METRONOME [START/STOP] METRONOME settings
[FADE IN/OUT] UTILITY FADE IN/OUT settings 151
TEMPO [TAP TEMPO] TAP settings
FUNCTION
[E ]
E MIDI MIDI CLOCK setting 149
[ ]
TRANSPOSE [E ] CONTROLLER TRANSPOSE assignment 144
E
[ ] MIXING CONSOLE TUNE TRANSPOSE settings 125
MENU [DEMO] LANGUAGE selection 154
UTILITY
[HELP] LCD BRIGHTNESS settings 152
[FUNCTION] FUNCTION MIDI MIDI settings 148
DIGITAL STUDIO [SOUND CREATOR] MASTER TUNING setting
MASTER TUNE/SCALE TUNE 138
[DIGITAL RECORDING] SCALE TUNING setting
[MIXING CONSOLE] MIXING CONSOLE EQ settings 128
[BALANCE] MIXING CONSOLE (SONG VOLUME settings
PART) VOLUME/VOICE 124
[CHANNEL ON/OFF] VOICE settings
[DIRECT ACCESS] Exit from the Direct Access mode
[NEXT] —
[BACK] —
[ENTER] —
[EXIT] Return to the MAIN display
VOICE PART [LAYER]
TUNE OCTAVE settings 125
[LEFT]
VOICE EFFECT [REVERB] MIXING CONSOLE REVERB settings
[DSP] EFFECT DSP settings 126
[VARIATION] EFFECT TYPE selection
[HARMONY/ECHO] FUNCTION HARMONY/ECHO 146
[MONO] MIXING CONSOLE TUNE PORTAMENTO TIME settings 125
[LEFT HOLD] STYLE SETTING/SPLIT POINT SPLIT POINT (LEFT) setting 141
VOICE [PIANO & HARPSI]
[E.PIANO]
[ORGAN & ACCORDION]
[PERCUSSION]
[GUITAR]
[BASS]
FUNCTION
[BRASS] VOICE SET 146
[WOODWIND]
[STRINGS]
[CHOIR & PAD]
[SYNTH.]
[XG]
[USER]
ORGAN FLUTES MIXING CONSOLE EQ settings 128
[MUSIC FINDER] MUSIC FINDER MUSIC FINDER SEARCH1 (Searching the records) 74
ONE TOUCH SETTING [1] —
[2] —
[3] —
[4] —
MIC. [VOCAL HARMONY] MIXING CONSOLE EFFECT MIC. REVERB setting 126
[TALK] MIC. SETTING TALK SETTING 135
[EFFECT] MIXING CONSOLE EFFECT MIC. DSP setting 126
[VH TYPE SELECT] VOCAL HARMONY VOCAL HARMONY EDIT (Editing the VOCAL HARMONY parameters) 131
[MIC. SETTING] MIXING CONSOLE EFFECT MIC. EFFECT TYPE selection 126
[PIANO] CONTROLLER KEYBOARD TOUCH selection 144
FUNCTION
REGISTRATION MEMORY [FREEZE] FREEZE 145
[1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
REGISTRATION BANK REGISTRATION EDIT (Editing the REGISTRATION) 89
[5]
[6]
[7]
[8]
[MEMORY] REGISTRATION SEQUENCE (Creating the REGISTRATION SEQUENCE) 145
PEDAL RIGHT RIGHT PEDAL function assignment
CENTER FUNCTION CENTER PEDAL function assignment
CONTROLLER 142
LEFT LEFT PEDAL function assignment
AUX AUX PEDAL function assignment

52 CVP-210/208
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Help Messages
The Help messages give you explanations and descriptions of all the main functions and features of the CVP-210/208.

HELP

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

Help messages can be displayed in


MENU any one of the following languages:
1 DEMO 2 ENGLISH
JAPANESE
HELP
GERMAN
FUNCTION FRENCH
SPANISH
ITALIAN

The language can also be selected


in the FUNCTION “LANGUAGE”
(page 154) display.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Selecting a different language here


2-1 Select the desired may cause the following problems.
Help topic.
2-2 Call up the topic.
• Some characters of the file
names you entered may be gar-
Select the Language, if necessary. The language bled.
selected here are also used for various “Messages” • Files may not be accessible.
shown during operations.
Restoring the original language
solves the above problems.
Reading the files on the computer
with a different language system
may cause similar problems to
those above.

BACK NEXT

3
Use this to select
different pages.

ENTER

END
DATA
ENTRY Press this to return
to the previous
display.
Help messages also feature links to the detailed explanation or actual
setting display of the selected topic. Simply select the underlined word
(using the [DATA ENTRY] dial), and press the [ENTER] button to jump to EXIT

the detailed explanation or actual setting display of the selected topic.

CVP-210/208 53
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Using the Metronome


The metronome provides a click sound, giving you an accurate tempo guide when you practice, or letting you hear and
check how a specific tempo sounds.

METRONOME

START STOP

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

The metronome starts by pressing the METRONOME [START/STOP]


button. Adjust the tempo by using the TEMPO[ ] [ ] buttons (see below).
The sound, volume level,
To stop the metronome, press the [START/STOP] button again.
and the beat (time signature)
of the metronome can all be
changed (page 151).

Adjusting the Tempo


This section shows you to adjust the playback tempo — which not only affects the metronome, but also the playback of
a song or an accompaniment style.

TEMPO
TAP TEMPO

RESET

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

Songs and accompaniment


TEMPO
styles have been given
1 RESET
TAP TEMPO
2 default (initial) tempo
settings, designed to best
suit the song/style.
Adjust the tempo by using either the TEMPO [ ]
[ ] buttons or the [DATA ENTRY] dial.
Press either the TEMPO [ ] The number in the display indicates how many
button or the [ ] button. quarter-note beats there are in one minute. The
range is between 5 and 500. The higher the value,
the faster the tempo.

Press this to When you change the tempo, both tempos of the
current song and style will be changed to the same
E ND close the
TEMPO display.
EXIT tempo. To restore their respective default (initial)
tempo settings, press both the TEMPO [ ] [ ]
buttons simultaneously. Also refer to the “Tempo
Indications — MAIN display” (page 55) for more
about tempo.

54 CVP-210/208
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data

Tap Tempo
This useful feature lets you tap out the tempo for a song or an accompaniment style.
Simply tap the [TAP TEMPO] button at the desired speed, and the tempo of the song or Hitting the [TAP TEMPO]
the accompaniment style changes to match your tapping. button produces a tapping
sound. You can change this
sound, if desired (page 152).

1 Playback the song or the TEMPO

n
accompaniment style
2
TAP TEMPO

You can also use Tap Tempo


(page 63, 78). RESET
to automatically start the
song or accompaniment
style at the desired tempo.
While both the song and
Tap the [TAP TEMPO] button twice accompaniment style are
to change the tempo. stopped, tap the [TAP
TEMPO] button several
times, and the selected
accompaniment style starts
automatically at the tempo
■ Tempo Indications — MAIN Display you tapped.
While a song is set to Sync.
There are three different tempo indications in the Main display, as shown below. Start stand-by (page 64, 78),
tapping the [TAP TEMPO]
Indicates the default (initial) tempo button starts the song play-
setting for the currently selected back in the same manner.
song (unless the tempo has been For songs and styles in 2/4
changed manually). and 4/4 time, tap four times;
for 3/4 time, tap three times;
for 5/4 time, tap five times.
Indicates the current tempo for the
selected song, accompaniment
style or the metronome which is
now playing back. When nothing is
playing back (stopped), this
indicates the tempo for the selected
style. When the song and style are
played back simultaneously, the
tempo of the style is automatically
changed to match the tempo of the
song, and is displayed here. This
tempo is used for recording when
recording a song or
accompaniment style.

Indicates the default (initial) tempo


setting for the currently selected
accompaniment style (unless the
tempo has been changed
manually).

CVP-210/208 55
Playing the Demos
The CVP-210/208 is an extraordinarily versatile and sophisticated instrument, featuring a wide variety of dynamic
Reference
voices and rhythms, plus a wealth of advanced functions. Three different types of Demo songs have been specially
prepared showcasing the stunning sound and features of the CVP-210/208.

MENU

DEMO
POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT
START ⁄ STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ⁄ ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU

ON OFF
SONG HELP DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON ⁄ OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START ⁄ STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN ⁄ OUT
FUNCTION FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING ⁄ rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START ⁄ STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON ⁄ OFF

PART

1 MENU

DEMO

HELP

FUNCTION

2 2-1 Use the [BACK][NEXT] buttons to select the desired Demo category.
Function Demos ...... These demonstrate each of the different functions.
Voice Demos ............ These showcase the voices.
Style Demos ............. These introduce you to the rhythms and accompaniment styles.

BACK NEXT

A F

B G

C H

D I

E J

2-3 Press one of these buttons to


start the desired demo.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

2-2 Use these to select Press this to play back all Demo songs/items continuously, starting from
different display pages. the first item at the top left of the display. This is available only from the
FUNCTION page.
All of the available demos are played back in sequence, starting from the one
at top left. The VOICE and STYLE pages do not have the [AUTO] button;
however, all demo songs are played back in sequence.
Pressing this button cancels the interactive features of the Function Demos
(otherwise available in step 3 below).

56 CVP-210/208
Playing the Demos

3 For the Function demos, an introduction screen appears in the display and
the Demo starts playing.
Use the [BACK][NEXT]
buttons in the introduction
screen to call up the previ-
ous or next page.
This example shows the Voices in the
FUNCTION demo. n
Press the SONG [START/
BACK NEXT
STOP] button to stop the
Demo song. To start the
F VOICE PART Demo again from the point
ON OFF
at which it was stopped,
G LAYER
press the SONG [START/
H LEFT STOP] button again.
ENTER
Rewind and fast-forward
I
can also be used with the
J
Demo songs (page 80).

DATA
ENTRY

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Select the desired word or item by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial, then press the
[ENTER] button or number buttons ([1▼],[2▼],etc.) to call it up.

4 Relevant explanations are shown in the display.

A F

B G

C H

D I

E J

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

END EXIT

Return to the MAIN screen.

CVP-210/208 57
Voices
The CVP-210/208 gives you an enormous selection of authentic voices, including various keyboard instruments, strings
and brass — and many, many more.

VOICE
PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES

BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

Selecting a Voice

1 Select
the
VOICE
PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
When you select a voice
group, the last selected
desired voice will automatically be
voice BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
selected.
group. n
Selecting a voice automati-
cally selects the best-suited
effect and other settings for
that particular voice. You can

2 Indicates that the display


is for selecting the MAIN
voice (page 25).
2-1 Select the memory location of the
voice (PRESET/USER/FLOPPY DISK).
disable this so that settings
are not automatically
selected (page 146).

BACK NEXT
n
You can set how much the
volume of the voice changes
A F according to your playing
strength (page 144).
B G

C H
n
For a list of the available
D I voices, refer to the separate
E J
Data List.

n
You can set whether the
voice bank and program
2-3 Select the voice. change numbers (“MSB-
LSB-Program Change num-
2-2 Select the ber” at the right above the
various pages Press this to start the voice name) are displayed or
in the current
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 demo of the selected not (page 152).
voice group. voice. To stop the demo
Press this to call up the display for selecting at any time, press this n
the voice group. button again. XG is a major enhancement
of the GM System level 1 for-
mat, and was developed by
Yamaha specially to provide
more voices and variations,
as well as greater expressive

3 Play the keyboard to hear the


selected END
Press this to return to
the MAIN display.
control over voices and
effects, and to ensure com-
patibility of data well into the
voice. future.

EXIT

58 CVP-210/208
Voices

Voice Characteristics
The voice type and its defining characteristics are indicated above the voice name.
Natural!
These rich and luscious voices are comprised mostly of keyboard instrument sounds and are especially intended
for playing piano and other keyboard parts. Since they use a completely independent sound source, you can play
full, sustained chords — even along with the accompaniment style — and not have to worry about notes cutting
off. They also take full advantage of Yamaha’s advanced sampling technology such as Stereo Sampling, Dynamic
Sampling, Sustain Sampling, and Key-off Sampling.
Live!
These acoustic instrument sounds were sampled in stereo, to produce a truly authentic, rich sound — full of
atmosphere and ambience.
Cool!
These voices capture the dynamic textures and subtle nuances of electric instruments — thanks to a huge amount
of memory and some very sophisticated programming.
Sweet!
These acoustic instrument sounds also benefit from Yamaha’s sophisticated technology — and feature a sound so
finely detailed and natural, you’ll swear you’re playing the real thing!
Drum
Various drum and percussion sounds are assigned to individual keys, letting you play the sounds from the
keyboard.
SFX
Various special effect sounds are assigned to individual keys, letting you play the sounds from the keyboard.
Live!Drums
These are high-quality drum sounds taking full advantage of Stereo Sampling and Dynamic Sampling.
Organ Flutes!
This authentic organ voice lets you use the Sound Creator to adjust the various footages and craft your own
original organ sounds.
Live! SFX
These are high-quality Latin percussion sounds taking full advantage of Stereo Sampling and Dynamic sampling.
They give you a broader and more versatile range of Latin percussion than the normal drum voices.

Keyboard Percussion
When one of the drum of SFX kits is selected in the PERCUSSION voice group, various drum, percussion, and special
effect sounds are assigned to individual keys, letting you play the sounds from the keyboard. The various drums and
percussion instruments of the Standard Kit are indicated by symbols above the assigned keys. Keep in mind that even
though different kits feature different sounds, some same-named sounds in different kits are identical.
Refer to the separate Data List (Drum/key Assignment List) for a listing of the sounds in each drum/SFX kit.

One-touch Piano Play


This convenient, easy-to-use feature completely and automatically reconfigures the entire CVP-210/208 for optimum
piano performance. No matter what settings you’ve made from the panel, you can instantly call up the piano settings by
a single button press.
PIANO

PIANO button You can also use the metro-


This reconfigures all of the panel settings for playing the CVP-210/208 as a nome with this function
piano. (page 54).

Piano Lock function


The convenient Piano Lock function lets you “lock” the piano so that you don’t Even if you turn Piano Lock
inadvertently change the settings by pressing another button on the panel. Once locked, off, the piano settings are
the CVP-210/208 stays in the piano mode, even if other buttons are pressed — preventing still active.
you from accidently starting a song or accompaniment style during a piano concert.
Hold down the [PIANO] button for a short time, until a message appears prompting you
to enable Piano Lock.
To enable Piano Lock, select “OK.”
To turn Piano Lock off, hold down the [PIANO] button again for a short time.

CVP-210/208 59
Voices

Layer/Left — Playing Several Sounds Simultaneously


The CVP-210/208 lets you set three voices for simultaneous play: MAIN, LAYER, and LEFT. By effectively combining
these three, you can create richly textured, multi-instrument setups for your performance.

VOICE PART
ON OFF

G LAYER

H LEFT

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

Playing a layer of two voices

LAYER part
MAIN part

Playing two voices separately — on the left Split point


and right sections of the keyboard

LEFT part
MAIN part
Left range Right range

Playing three different voices — one on the Split point


LAYER part
left section of the keyboard, plus a layer of
two on the right
LEFT part
MAIN part
Left range Right range

Layer — Layering Two Different Voices

1 Press this to
turn the LAYER
function on. To
2 Select LAYER with the [G]
button. Press the same
turn it off, press button to call up the VOICE F

the button again. display, from which you can G

select the specific voice you H


VOICE PART
ON OFF
want to play in a layer with
I
G LAYER the Main voice.
H LEFT
The method of selecting a J

voice here is the same as that


in VOICE (MAIN) display
(page 58).

There is an alternate way for


quickly selecting both the MAIN
Press this to return to and LAYER voices from the
END EXIT the MAIN display.
panel: While holding down one
panel voice button, press a sec-
ond voice button. The first
selected voice becomes the
MAIN voice, and the second
becomes the LAYER.

60 CVP-210/208
Voices

Left — Setting Separate Voices for the Left and Right Sections of the Keyboard

1 Set the LEFT to


ON. Press this
button again to
2 Select LEFT with the [H] button. Press the same
button to call up the VOICE display, from which you
The split point can be freely
set to any key on the key-
set it to OFF. can select the specific voice you want to play in a board. To set it, call up the
SPLIT POINT display by
left. How to select the voice is the same as the way of pressing the [I] (SPLIT
G LAYER VOICE (MAIN) screen (page 58). POINT) button in the MAIN
H LEFT
display. The operation steps
are the same as in the
STYLE SETTING/SPLIT
POINT display of the FUNC-
F
TION page (page 141).
G
n
H Each part (MAIN, LAYER,
and LEFT) can have its own

END volume setting (page 65).


I

n
J

You can also use the LAYER


and LEFT functions
EXIT
together, to create a combi-
nation layer/split. To do this,
set separate voices for the
Press this to left and right sections of the
return to the keyboard (as indicated), and
set up a layer of two different
MAIN display. voices on the right.

Applying Voice Effects


This section of the panel lets you add a variety of effects to the voices you play on the keyboard.

VOICE EFFECT
REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

Press one of the effect buttons to turn the corresponding effects on. Press it again to turn the effect off.
For explanations on each of the effects, see below.

■ REVERB
Reverb is an effect that recreates the acoustic ambiance of a performance space — anything from a small jazz club to a
concert hall.

■ DSP
The CVP-210/208 features a variety of dynamic built-in digital effects, letting you process The DSP and VARIATION
the sound in various ways. You can use DSP to enhance the voices in subtle ways — such effect types and the their
as by applying chorus to add animation and depth, or using a symphonic effect to give depth can be selected and
adjusted in the MIXING CON-
the sound warmth and richness. DSP also has effects such as distortion that can SOLE display (page 126).
completely change the character of the sound. DSP is set for the currently selected part
(MAIN/LAYER/LEFT).

■ VARIATION (Not available for the Natural voices; page 92)


This control changes the Variation effect settings, letting you alter some aspect of the effect, depending on the selected
type. For example, when the Rotary Speaker effect is selected (page 126), this lets you switch the rotor speed between
slow and fast.

CVP-210/208 61
Voices

■ HARMONY/ECHO
This control adds Harmony or Echo effects to the voices played on the right hand section The Portamento effect creates
a smooth pitch glide between
of the keyboard (page 146).
successively played notes.

■ MONO
This control determines whether the voice is played monophonically (only one note at a You can add special empha-
time) or polyphonically for each part (MAIN/LAYER/LEFT). This is set to MONO when the sis to melody lines you play
lamp is lit, and set to polyphonic when the lamp is off. When set to MONO, only the last over chords by using the
Layer function with a mono-
note played will sound. This lets you play wind instrument voices more realistically. phonic voice. Set the Main
Depending on the selected voice, the MONO setting also lets you effectively use the voice to play polyphonically
Portamento effect, when playing in legato. and set the Layer voice to
play monophonically
(MONO). In this case, the
■ LEFT HOLD melody you play — including
This function causes the left part voice to be held even when the keys are released — the the top notes of any chords
— sounds monophonically.
same effect as when the damper (sustain) pedal is pressed. This function is especially Try this using the following
effective when used with the auto accompaniment. For example, if you play and release a voices.
chord in the auto accompaniment section of the keyboard (with the left part on and the MAIN voice: Brass Section
(polyphonic) + LAYER voice:
Left voice set to Strings), the strings part sustains, adding a natural richness to the overall Sweet Trump (monophonic)
accompaniment sound.

Using the Pedals


The CVP-210/208 features three pedals. You can also assign one of
many other functions to
these pedals (as well as the
optional foot controller or
footswitch). For example, you
Left Pedal Damper Pedal can use it to start/stop the
accompaniment style, or use
Sostenuto Pedal
it to play Fill-ins (page 142).

■ Damper Pedal (Right)


The damper pedal performs the same function as the • Some voices may sound
damper pedal on an actual acoustic piano, letting you continuously or have a
sustain the sound of the voices even after releasing the long decay after the notes
have been released while
keys. the damper pedal is held.
• Certain voices in the [PER-
When you press the damper pedal CUSSION] and [XG]
here, the notes you play before you groups may not be affected
release the pedal have a longer sustain. by use of the damper pedal.

■ Sostenuto Pedal (Center)


If you play a note or chord on the keyboard and press the • Certain voices, such as
sostenuto pedal while the note(s) are held, those notes will [STRINGS] or [BRASS],
be sustained as long as the pedal is held, but all sustain continuously when
the sostenuto pedal is
subsequently played notes will not be sustained. pressed.
• Certain voices in the
When you press the sostenuto pedal [PERCUSSION] and [XG]
here while holding the note, the note will groups may not be
sustain as long as you hold the pedal. affected by use of the sos-
tenuto pedal.

■ Left Pedal
When the Piano voice is selected, pressing this pedal reduces the volume and slightly The depth of the left pedal
changes the timbre of the notes you play. effect can be adjusted
(page 142).
The settings assigned to this pedal may differ depending on the selected voice.

■ Foot Controller/Footswitch
An optional Yamaha foot controller (FC7) or footswitch (FC4 or FC5) can be connected to
the AUX PEDAL jack and used to control various functions assigned in the FUNCTION page (page 142).

62 CVP-210/208
Styles
The CVP-210/208 features styles (accompaniment patterns) in a variety of different musical genres including pops, jazz,
Latin and dance. To use it, all you have to do is play the chords with your left hand as you perform and the selected
Accompaniment Style (style) matching your music will automatically play along, instantly following the chords you
play. Try selecting some of the different styles (refer to separate Data List (Style List) ) and play them.

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

STYLE

ACMP AUTO FILLIN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START / STOP

A B C D
OTS LINK

Playing a style

1 A
To call up the [MAIN] dis-
play, first press the
[DIRECT ACCESS] button,
B then press the [EXIT] but-
ton.
C

2 BACK NEXT
For a list of the available
accompaniment styles, refer
A F 2-1 Select a location to the separate Data List
(Preset, User, (Style List).
B G
Floppy Disk) for
C H
saving the style.

D I

E J

2-2 Select a Style.

When you’ve opened a lower directory’s


display, this button (UP) lets you call up
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
the next higher directory, from which you
can select Style groups.

CVP-210/208 63
Styles

3 When the [ACMP] button is set to on, you can play/indicate chords from the auto
accompaniment section of the keyboard. (Depending on the settings, this may be
the range of the Left voice, or the entire keyboard.)
You can set the key range
for auto accompaniment
(page 141).
STYLE

ACMP AUTO FILLIN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START / STOP

A B C D
OTS LINK

4 STYLE
Turn SYNC. (SYNCHRONIZED) START on. Sync. Start
Enabling this lets you start
the style simply by playing
ACMP AUTO FILLIN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START / STOP
the keyboard.
A B C D
OTS LINK

• You can begin the rhythm


channels (tracks) of the
Style by pressing the
5 As soon as you play a chord with the auto accompaniment section, the style starts.
For details about chord fingerings, refer to page 66.
Split point
[START/STOP] button.
• The rhythm channels of
The Tempo can be adjusted the style can also be
using the TEMPO [ ][ ] or started by tapping the
[TAP TEMPO] button. [TAP TEMPO] button.
If you tap the [TAP TEMPO] With the style stopped,
button, the tempo will adjust to tap the [TAP TEMPO]
the same speed that you tapped. button three, four or five
times (three for 3/4 time,
Auto Accompaniment
four for 2/4 or 4/4 time,
section
five for 5/4 time).

6 Stop the style.


END Turn ACMP off.
When you simultaneously
play back accompaniment
styles with a song, the
STYLE accompaniment parts
ACMP
recorded to the song (chan-
SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START / STOP
nels 9 - 16) are temporarily
replaced by the selected
accompaniment style — let-
ting you try out and use dif-
ferent accompaniment with
the song (page 79).

Accompaniment Style Characteristics


The defining characteristics of some of the accompaniment styles are indicated above the relevant style names in the Open/Save display.

Session!
These styles provide even greater realism and authentic backing by mixing in original chord types and changes, as well as special riffs with
chord changes, with the Main sections. These have been programmed to add “spice” and a professional touch to your performances of
certain songs and in certain genres. As a result, the styles may not necessarily be appropriate — or even harmonically correct — for all
songs and for all chord playing. In some cases for example, playing a simple major triad may result in a seventh chord, or playing an on-
bass chord may result in incorrect or unexpected accompaniment.

Piano Combo!
These accompaniment styles feature a basic piano trio (piano, bass, and drums), augmented in some cases with other instruments. Since
this is a small combo sound, the accompaniment backing is appropriately sparse, making it useful and effective for a wide variety of songs.

Pianist!
These special styles provide piano-only accompaniment — effectively recreating the left-hand performance of an accomplished pianist.
Just by playing the proper chords with your left hand, you can automatically add complicated arpeggios and bass/chord patterns — such as
difficult-to-play stride piano parts.

64 CVP-210/208
Styles

Playing a Style’s Rhythm Channels only

1 Select a style (page 63). The Rhythm channels are


part of the styles. Each style
has different rhythm pat-
terns.

You can also start the


2 Rhythm starts. rhythm simply by playing a
key on the keyboard, if Sync
STYLE
Start is enabled (turn on the
ACMP AUTO FILLIN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START / STOP [SYNC.START] button).
A B C D
OTS LINK

Set to off.

3 Play along with the rhythm playback.


The Tempo can be adjusted using the TEMPO [ ][ ] or [TAP TEMPO] buttons.
If you tap the [TAP TEMPO] button, the tempo will adjust to the same speed that
you tapped.

When selecting the style


group “PIANIST,” the
rhythm doesn’t sound.
Press the STYLE [START/STOP] button When you want to use any
END again to stop the rhythm playback. of the styles, always make
sure that ACMP is turned
on.

Adjusting the Volume Balance/Channel Muting


BALANCE display
MIC part

STYLE part (Auto


Accompaniment section) Parts played from the
Call up the
keyboard (MAIN/LAYER/
BALANCE
SONG part LEFT)
display.

Adjust the output level of the Part.


BALANCE

CHANNEL
ON / OFF CHANNEL ON/OFF display
Channel
PART
Refers to the MIDI channel
in the song data
Call up the (page 161). The channels
Channel ON/ are assigned as shown
OFF display. below.
Call up the STYLE display by pressing the [CHANNEL ON/OFF] Song
button, then turn the instrument you want to cancel off. To listen to 1 - 16
only one instrument by itself, hold down the appropriate button for Accompaniment Style
9 - 16
the channel to set the channel to SOLO. To cancel SOLO, simply
press the appropriate channel button again.

CVP-210/208 65
Styles

Chord Fingerings
The style playback can be controlled by the chords you play in the keys to the left of the split point. There are 7 types of
fingerings as described below. Go to the CHORD FINGERING page (page 142), and select the Chord Fingerings. The
page shows how to play chords with your left hand.
SINGLE FINGER
Single Finger accompaniment makes it simple to produce beautifully orchestrated accompaniment using major,
seventh, minor and minor-seventh chords by pressing a minimum number of keys on the auto accompaniment section
of the keyboard. The abbreviated chord fingerings described below are used.
For a major chord, press the root key only. For a minor chord, simultaneously press the root key
and a black key to its left.

For a seventh chord, simultaneously press the root For a minor-seventh chord, simultaneously press the
key and a white key to its left. root key and both a white and black key to its left.

MULTI FINGER
The Multi Finger mode automatically detects Single Finger or Fingered chord fingerings, Chord detection in the AI
so you can use either type of fingering without having to switch fingering modes. If you Full Keyboard mode occurs
at approximately 8th-note
want to play minor, seventh, or minor-seventh chords using the SINGLE FINGER intervals. Extremely short
operation in the MULTI FINGER Mode, always press the closest white/black key(s) to the chords — less than an 8th
root of the chord. note in length — may not be
detected.
FINGERED
This mode lets you produce accompaniment by playing full chords on the auto
accompaniment section of the keyboard. The Fingered mode recognizes the various In Full Keyboard mode,
chord types listed on the next page. chords are detected based
on the lowest and second
FINGERED ON BASS lowest notes you play. If the
This mode accepts the same fingerings as the FINGERED mode, but the lowest note two lowest notes fall within a
played in the auto accompaniment section of the keyboard is used as the bass note, single octave, those two
notes determine the chord. If
allowing you to play “on bass” chords. For example, to indicate a C-on-E chord, play a C the lowest note and the sec-
major chord with E as the lowest note (E, G, C). ond lowest note are sepa-
rated by more than one
FULL KEYBOARD octave, the lowest note
This method detects chords in the entire key range. Chords are detected in a way similar becomes the bass and the
to Fingered, even if you split the notes between your left and right hands — for example, chord is determined from the
second lowest note and the
playing a bass note with your left hand and a chord with your right, or by playing a chord other notes played in the
with your left hand and a melody note with your right. same octave.

AI FINGERED
This mode is basically the same as FINGERED, with the exception that less than three
notes can be played to indicate the chords (based on the previously played chord, etc.). AI
AI FULL KEYBOARD Artificial Intelligence
When this advanced auto accompaniment mode is engaged, the CVP-210/208 will
automatically create appropriate accompaniment while you play just about anything,
anywhere on the keyboard using both hands. You don’t have to worry about specifying the accompaniment chords.
Although the AI Full Keyboard mode is designed to work with many songs, some arrangements may not be suitable for
use with this feature.
This mode is similarto FULL KEYBOARD, with the exception that less than three notes can be played to indicate the
chords (based on the previously played chord, etc.). 9th and 11th chords cannot be played.

66 CVP-210/208
Styles

Chord Types Recognized in the Fingered Mode (Example for “C” chords)
 11
C C9 C6 C6 9 CM7 CM7 9 CM7 C5 CM7  5

)
)

)
)

(
(

(
(
Csus4 Caug CM7aug Cm Cm9 Cm6 Cm7 Cm7 9 Cm7 11

)
(
)

)
(

(
CmM7 CmM7 9 Cm7  5 CmM7  5 Cdim Cdim7 C7 C7  9 C7  13

)
)

(
(

(
 11 9
C7 9 C7 C7 13 C7 C7  5 C7aug C7sus4 Csus2

)
)
)

(
(
(

Chord Name [Abbreviation] Normal Voicing Display for root “C”


• Notes in parentheses can
Major [M] 1-3-5 C be omitted.
Ninth [9] 1-2-3-5 C9 • For FINGERED, FIN-
GERED ON BASS, and AI
Sixth [6] 1 - (3) - 5 - 6 C6 FINGERED, if you play
Sixth ninth [69] 1 - 2 - 3 - (5) - 6 or 3 - 6 - 2* C69 any three adjacent keys
(including black keys), the
Major seventh [M7] 1 - 3 - (5) - 7 CM7 chord sound will be can-
Major seventh ninth [M79] 1 - 2 - 3 - (5)j - 7 CM79 celed and only the rhythm
    instruments will continue
Major seventh add sharp eleventh [M7 11] 1 - (2) - 3 - 4 - 5 - 7 or 1 - 2 - 3 - 4 - (5) - 7 CM7 11
playing (Chord Cancel
Flatted fifth [  5] 1 - 3 - 5 C 5 function). This let you play
Major seventh flatted fifth [M7  5]  CM7  5
back only the rhythm.
1-3- 5-7
• Playing two same root
Suspended fourth [sus4] 1-4-5 Csus4 keys in the adjacent
 octaves produces accom-
Augmented [aug] 1-3- 5 Caug
paniment based only on

Major seventh augmented [M7aug] 1 - (3) - 5 - 7 CM7aug the root.
Minor [m] 1 - 3 - 5 Cm • A perfect fifth (1 + 5) pro-
duces accompaniment
Minor ninth [m9] 1 - 2 - 3 - 5 Cm9 based on the root and the
Minor sixth [m6] 1 - 3 - 5 - 6 Cm6 fifth.
• The auto accompaniment
Minor seventh [m7] 1 -  3 - (5) -  7 Cm7 Style will sometimes not
Minor seventh ninth [m79] 1 - 2 -  3 - (5) -  7 or  3 -  7 - 2 Cm79 change when related
chords are played in
Minor seventh eleventh [m711] 1 - (2) -  3 - 4 - 5 - (  7) Cm711 sequence (e.g. some
Minor major seventh [mM7] 1 -  3 - (5) - 7 CmM7 minor chords followed by
the minor seventh).
Minor major seventh ninth [mM79] 1 - 2 -  3 - (5) - 7 CmM79 • You can also have the
Minor seventh flatted fifth [m7  5] 1 - 3 - 5 - 7 Cm7  5 CVP-210/208 “teach” you
how to play Fingered
Minor major seventh flatted fifth [mM7  5] 1 - 3 - 5 - 7 CmM7  5 chords. From the CHORD
Diminished [dim] 1 - 3 - 5 Cdim FINGERING display
(page 142), specify the
Diminished seventh [dim7] 1 - 3 - 5 - 6 Cdim7 chord you want to learn,
Seventh [7] 1 - 3 - (5) -  7 or 1 - (3) - 5 -  7 C7 and the notes you should
press are indicated in the
Seventh flatted ninth [7  9] 1 -  2 - 3 - (5) -  7 C7  9
display.
Seventh add flatted thirteenth [7  13] 1 - 3 - 5 - 6 - 7 C7  13
Seventh ninth [79] 1 - 2 - 3 - (5) -  7 or 3 -  7 - 2* C79
 11     
Seventh add sharp eleventh [7 ] 1 - (2) - 3 - 4 - 5 - 7 or 1 - 2 - 3 - 4 - (5) - 7 C7 11
Seventh add thirteenth [713] 1 - 3 - (5) - 6 -  7 or 3 - 6 -  7 C713
   
Seventh sharp ninth [7 9] 1 - 2 - 3 - (5) - 7 C7 9
Seventh flatted fifth [7  5] 1 - 3 - 5 - 7 C7  5

Seventh augmented [7aug] 1 - 3 - 5 - 7 C7aug
Seventh suspended fourth [7sus4] 1 - 4 - 5 - 7 C7sus4
Suspended second [sus2] 1-2-5 Csus2

* Only this voicing (inversion) is recognized. Other chords not marked with an asterisk can be played in any inversion.

CVP-210/208 67
Styles

Arranging the Style Pattern (SECTIONS: MAIN A/B/C/D, INTRO, ENDING, BREAK)
The CVP-210/208 features various types of Auto Accompaniment Sections that allow you
to vary the arrangement of the Style. They are: Intro, Main, Break and Ending. By You can also use this func-
switching among them as you play, you can easily produce the dynamic elements of a tion to play only rhythms
(page 65).
professional-sounding arrangement in your performance.

1 Select a style (page 63). • If you press the [INTRO]


button, you can play back
an Intro section while an
accompaniment is play-
ing.
• Section button indications
— [BREAK], [INTRO],
[MAIN], [ENDING] but-
2 tons
LED is green
STYLE — The section is not
ACMP AUTO FILLIN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START / STOP
selected.
LED is red
A B C D — The section is cur-
OTS LINK
rently selected.
LED is off
2-1 Turn the ACMP function on. 2-3 Turn the SYNC. START function on. — No section data; the
section cannot be
played.
2-2 Press the [INTRO] button. To cancel the INTRO section
• You can dynamically con-
before starting the style, press the [INTRO] button again.
trol the level of the
accompaniment by how
softly or strongly you play
the keys in the Auto
Accompaniment section
of the keyboard
(page 141).
• If you press the [SYNC.

3 The Intro section starts as soon as you play a key in the Auto
Accompaniment section of the keyboard, and changes to the Main section.
START] button while an
accompaniment is play-
ing, the accompaniment
will stop and the CVP-
Split point 210/208 will enter Syn-
chronized Start standby
status.
• You can also change
style sections by using
the pedal (page 142).
• The Break section lets
Auto Accompaniment you add dynamic varia-
tions and breaks in the
section
rhythm of the accompani-
ment, to make your per-
formance sound even
more professional. If you
press the [BREAK] but-
ton while an accompani-
ment is playing, the fill-in
4 will play back for one
measure.
Main sections can be shifted. • The indicator of the desti-
STYLE
nation section (MAIN A/
B/C/D) will flash while the
ACMP AUTO FILLIN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START / STOP
Break is playing.
A B C D • When the [AUTO FILLIN]
OTS LINK
button is set to on and
the MAIN [A][B][C][D]
button is pressed after
Press this button to add breaks. the final half beat (eighth
note) of the measure, the
fill-in will begin from the
next measure.

68 CVP-210/208
Styles

This switches to the ending section. When the ending is finished, the Style stops • Styles can also be started
END automatically. You can have the ending gradually slow down (ritardando) by
pressing the same [ENDING/rit.] button again while the ending is playing back.
by pressing the STYLE
[START/STOP] button.
STYLE
• You can select the Intro
and Ending type by press-
ACMP AUTO FILLIN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START / STOP
ing the [E] button in the
A B C D MAIN window (page 70).
OTS LINK
• If you press the [INTRO]
button while the ending is
playing, the Intro section
will begin playing after the
Fade-in/Fade-out ending is finished.
The accompaniment style also include a convenient Fade-in/Fade-out function that • When the [AUTO FILLIN]
gradually fades in and fades out the accompaniment. To start the style with a fade-in, button is set to on and you
press a MAIN button while
press the [FADE IN/OUT] button, then turn SYNC. START on. To cancel the fade-in the ending is playing, fill-in
before starting the style, press the button again. accompaniment will
To fade out and stop the Style, press this button while the style is playing. The time of the immediately start playing,
continuing with the Main
fade-in/fade-out can also be set (page 151). section.
• You can begin the accom-
paniment by using the
Stopping the Style Playback While Releasing Keys (SYNC. STOP) Ending instead of the Intro
section. In this case, the
When the Synchro Stop function is engaged, accompaniment playback will stop auto accompaniment
completely when all keys in the Auto Accompaniment section of the keyboard are released. doesn’t stop when the
ending is finished.
Accompaniment playback will start again as soon as the key in the Auto Accompaniment • If you select a different
section is played. style while the style is not
playing, the “default”
tempo for that style is also

1 Turn ACMP (Accompaniment) on. selected. If the accompa-


niment is playing, the
same tempo is maintained
even if you select a differ-
ent style.
• When STOP ACMP is set
2 Turn SYNC. STOP on. SYNC. START is also automatically set to on when
SYNC. STOP is turned on.
to on and the accompani-
ment is not playing, you
can play both chords and
STYLE
bass in the Auto Accom-
ACMP AUTO FILLIN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START / STOP
paniment section in the
A B C D keyboard (page 141).
OTS LINK

3 As soon as you play a chord with your left hand, the auto accompaniment
starts. Split point
You can also use the SYNC.
STOP function by pressing
the auto accompaniment
section/left-hand range
briefly (page 141).

Auto Accompaniment section

4 The auto accompaniment stops when you release your left hand from the keys.
Synchro Stop cannot be set
to on when the fingering
mode is set to Full Key-
board/AI Keyboard or the
Press the [SYNC. STOP]/ auto accompaniment on the
5 Playing a chord with your left
hand automatically restarts END [SYNC. START] button
panel is set to off.

the auto accompaniment. again to stop the


accompaniment.

CVP-210/208 69
Styles

Selecting Intro and Ending Types (INTRO/ENDING)

1 To call up the [MAIN] dis-


play, first press the [DIRECT
A
ACCESS] button, then press
the [EXIT] button.
B

2 D

E
3 Play the style using
the Intro or Ending
Select a Intro
section (page 30, 31).

Select a Ending

Playing Fill-in patterns automatically when


Fill
changing accompaniment sections — Auto Fill In A short phrase used to add
variation to the style.

1 STYLE

ACMP AUTO FILLIN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START / STOP

A B C D
OTS LINK

You can also add a fill-in by


2 Play the style and switch among the accompaniment sections as they play
(page 30, 31).
pressing the selected MAIN
button again.
Fill-in patterns play automatically between each change in the Main
sections.

You can temporarily disable


Auto Fill In during a perfor-
mance by pressing the next
Main section’s button twice

END To cancel the Auto Fill, press the [AUTO FILLIN] button again. quickly.

70 CVP-210/208
Styles

Appropriate Panel Setting for the Selected Style (ONE TOUCH SETTING)
The convenient One Touch Setting function makes it easy for you to select voices and effects that are appropriate to the style
you’re playing. Each preset style has four pre-programmed panel setups that you can select by pressing a single button.

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

ONE TOUCH SETTING

1 2 3 4

1 Select a style (page 63).

2 Press one of the ONE TOUCH SETTING buttons ([1] - [4]).


3 As soon as you play a
chord with your left
LED is red — The One Touch Setting is currently selected.
hand, the auto
ONE TOUCH SETTING
accompaniment starts.
1 2 3 4

Split point

LED is green — The One Touch LED is off — No One Touch


Setting is not selected. Setting data. The button is not
available.

Various settings (such as voices, effects, etc.) that match the selected Auto Accompaniment section
style can be instantly recalled. When the style is not playing, Auto
Accompaniment and Sync. Start will automatically be turned on.
For details about the One Touch Setting parameters, refer to the
separate Data List (Parameter Chart).

4 Stop the Auto Accompaniment.

STYLE

ACMP AUTO FILLIN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START / STOP

A B C D
OTS LINK

5 Try out other One Touch Setting setups. You can also create your own One
Touch Setting setups (page 72).

ONE TOUCH SETTING

1 2 3 4

CVP-210/208 71
Styles

Automatically Changing One Touch Settings with the Sections — OTS Link
The convenient OTS (One Touch Setting) Link function lets you automatically have One Touch Settings change when
you select a different Main section (A - D).

1 AUTO FILLIN

OTS LINK
2 When you switch among the Main sections (A
- D), the corresponding One Touch Setting will
The One Touch Settings
can be set to change with
the sections in one of two
be called up automatically. different timings (page 141):
The Main sections A, B, C, and D correspond • Immediately when you
to One Touch Settings 1, 2, 3, and 4, press a section button.
• At the next measure (in
respectively. an accompaniment
style), after you press a
section button.

END To cancel the OTS Link function, press the [OTS LINK] button again.

Registering the Panel Controls in One Touch Setting (ONE TOUCH SETTING)
This section covers how to create your own One Touch Setting setups (four setups per style). For a list of One Touch
Setting setup parameters, refer to the separate Data List (Parameter Chart).

1 Select a style.
2 Set up the panel controls
such as selecting a voice 3 Press the [MEMORY]
button.
MEMORY

as required.

4 Press one of the ONE TOUCH SETTING buttons: [1] through [4].
ONE TOUCH SETTING

1 2 3 4

The items you can register in a One Touch Setting are Voice, Harmony and Pedal settings.

Unless you store the panel


settings here, the registered
A message prompting you to save the current style will appear. Select “YES” settings will be deleted
E ND to call up the STYLE display, then save the panel settings (page 40, 48). when you select a different
accompaniment style.

72 CVP-210/208
Styles

Calling Up Ideal Setups for Your Music — Music Finder


The Music Finder feature lets you instantly call up the appropriate settings for the
instrument — including voice, style, and One Touch Settings — simply by selecting the The MUSIC FINDER records
desired song title. If you want to play a certain song but don’t know which style and voice and its contents is just one
settings would be appropriate, the convenient Music Finder function will help you out. example of the recom-
The recommended settings, which together make up a “record,” can also be edited and mended panel setups. You
can also create your own
stored. This lets you create and save your own Music Finder records for future recall. Music Finder settings for
your favorite songs and
POWER METRONOME
START STOP
MIC.
VOCAL HARMONY
SIGNAL OVER
TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING
VOICE EFFECT
REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
genres.
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
SOUND

Keep in mind that Music


TAP TEMPO CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ENTRY 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Finder is a performance aid


ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP FREEZE MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

in that it automatically finds


MUSIC FINDER
DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT
appropriate accompaniment
styles and voices for your
playing. Even though you
can specify song titles, it
does not actually contain
MUSIC FINDER
song data.

2 Select a record. For example, select the


top record by pressing the [1▲▼] button
to call up the recommended setups.
All.......................... Show all records.
FAVORITE ............. Show the records that have added to the “Favorite” page.
SEARCH1,2 .......... Show the results by SEARCH function (page 74).
The setting data shown here is referred
to as a “record.” Sorting the records
MUSIC .......The record is sorted by song title.
STYLE ...... The record is sorted by style name.
BEAT .........The record is sorted by beat.
TEMPO......The record is sorted by tempo.
F

G
Change the order of the records (ascending or
descending).
H

I Add the selected record to “Favorite (Bookmark)” page


When you press the [H] button, the “Add selected data to the
J
favorite list? YES/NO” message will be displayed. Select
[YES] to add the selected page to “FAVORITE” page.
Show the To delete the added record, select the record in the
number of “FAVORITE” page and press the [H](DELETE FROM
records of FAVORITE) button.
each page. Search record(s). Enter the condition of the search in the
MUSIC FINDER SEARCH display (page 74). The results of
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
SEARCH 1 or 2 appear in the “SEARCH 1” or “SEARCH 2”
page respectively.
Call up the MUSIC FINDER RECORD EDIT (page 75) display (for editing
Select a record by song title. the selected record).
When sorting records by song title,
use the [1▲▼] button to skip up or Turn TEMPO LOCK on/off. TEMPO LOCK function lets you avoid changing the Tempo
down through the songs during style playback when selecting another record. The on/off setting affects all pages
alphabetically. Simultaneously (ALL/FAVORITE/SEARCH 1/SEARCH 2).
press the [▲▼] buttons to move the
cursor to the first record. Select a record by style name. When sorting the records by style name, press these buttons to
move the cursor to the next /previous style. Simultaneously press the [▲▼] buttons to move the
cursor to the first record.

Records can be selected by


3 Play the style (page 64). using the [DATA ENTRY]
dial and pressing the
[ENTER] button.

CVP-210/208 73
Styles

Searching the Ideal Setups — Music Finder Search


You can search the record by music title or keywords. The results appears in the display.

1 Press the [I]


(SEARCH 1)
2 Enter the
conditions for
button or [J] the search (see A F

(SEARCH 2) below), then B G

button in the start search by C H

MUSIC FINDER using [START


D I

display. SEARCH] button.


E J

Start searching the record.


The results that satisfy all
the conditions appear in the
SEARCH page. For details
about the search settings in
this display, see below.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

■ [A] MUSIC
Searches by music or song title. Press this button to call up the display for
inputting the song title.
When you enter the song title (page 49), the search function calls up all
records that contain the entered word or words.

■ [B] KEYWORD
Searches by keyboard. Press this button to call up the display for inputting the
keyword.
When you enter the keyword (page 49), the search function calls up all
records that contain the entered word or words. You can search several
different keywords simultaneously by inserting a separator (comma) between each. The search function finds and
displays all records that contain at least one match in the keywords.

■ [C] STYLE
The STYLE FILE SELECT
Searches by style name. Press this button to call up the STYLE FILE SELECT display. Press display can only be used to
the [A] through [J] button in the display to select the desired accompaniment style. This select the style name for
convenient function lets you find all songs that use a certain accompaniment style. searching; it cannot be used
to call up the actual accom-
■ [D] BEAT paniment style.

Searches by beat or rhythmic feel.

■ [E] SEARCH AREA


Selects a specific location for searching. You can further narrow down your search by using the SEARCH 1 and 2
selections.

■ [F]~[H] CLEAR
Clears the entered item at left.

■ [1▲▼] TEMPO FROM


You can also narrow your search by specifying a tempo range. This lets you set the minimum tempo for the search. Press
the [▲▼] buttons simultaneously to instantly reset the tempo value to the minimum.

■ [2▲▼]TEMPO TO
You can also narrow your search by specifying a tempo range. This lets you set the maximum tempo for the search.
Press the [▲▼] buttons simultaneously to instantly reset the tempo value to the maximum.

■ [3▲▼]~[5▲▼] GENRE
Selects the specific music genre for searching. The available range includes all genres (ANY), the preset genres, and any
genres you’ve entered yourself (page 73).

■ [8▼] CANCEL
Press this to cancel the operation and return to the previous display.

74 CVP-210/208
Styles

Editing Records — Music Finder Record Edit


From this display, you can call up existing records and edit them to suit your
preferences. You can even use this to create your own Music Finder records. You can also change/clear a
preset record. To avoid chang-
ing/clearing the record, register

1 Press the
[8▲▼]
2 Change/clear the record data. You can also
register new records. For details about all
the record as a new record
after editing.
(RECORD settings and operations, see below.
EDIT) button in
All Music Finder records can be
the MUSIC stored together as a single file
FINDER A F
(page 154). When calling up a
display. B G
stored file, a message appears
prompting you to replace or
C H append the records as desired.
D I
• Replace:
All Music Finder records cur-
E J rently in the instrument are
deleted and replaced with the
records of the selected file.
• Append:
The records called up are
added to the vacant record
numbers.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

■ [A] MUSIC
Selects the music or song title for editing. Press the button to call up the
display for inputting the music or song title, then edit the name as desired.

■ [B] KEYWORD
Selects the keyword for editing. Press the button to call up the display for
inputting the keyword, then edit it as desired.
You can enter several different keywords by inserting a separator (comma)
between each.

■ [C] STYLE
The STYLE FILE SELECT
Selects the style name for editing. Always enter the name when a new record is registered. display can only be used to
Press the button to call up the STYLE FILE SELECT display. Press the [A] through [J] button select the style name for
in the display to select the desired style you want to change/clear/register. record editing; it cannot be
used to call up the actual
■ [D] BEAT accompaniment style.

Selects the beat (time signature) for editing. When another file is selected by pressing the
[C] button, the current beat setting is replaced with the beat setting of the selected file.
Keep in mind that the Beat
■ [E] FAVORITE setting made here is only for
the Music Finder search
Adds the selected record to the FAVORITE page (page 73). function; this does not affect
the actual Beat setting of the
■ [F]~[H] CLEAR accompaniment style itself.
Clears the entered item at left.

■ [I] DELETE RECORD


Clears the selected record. The deleted record number becomes empty. When you press
this button, a message appears prompting you to execute, abort or cancel the operation.
YES .................. Press this to clear the record and close the display.
NO .................. Press this to close the display without clearing the record.
CANCEL........... Press this to close the message box and return to the previous display.

■ [J] NEW RECORD


Registers a new record. The smallest available empty record number is used for registering. The maximum number of
When you press this button, a message appears prompting you to execute, abort or cancel records is 2500, including
internal records.
the operation.
YES .................. Press this to register the record and close the display.
NO .................. Press this to close the display without registering the record.
CANCEL........... Press this to close the message box and return to the previous display.

CVP-210/208 75
Styles

■ [1▼▲] TEMPO
Determines the tempo for the selected style. When changing the style with the [C] button, the tempo is automatically
changed to that of the changed style.

■ [3▼▲]~[5▼▲] GENRE
Indicates and changes the genre to which the selected record is assigned. The available range includes all preset genres
as well as any you’ve entered yourself.

■ [6▼▲] GENRE NAME


For entering a genre name. Press the button to call up the display for inputting
the genre name, then edit the name as desired. A maximum of 200 genre
names can be stored.
The genre name you input becomes effective when the current record is edited (overwritten) by pressing the [8▲] (OK)
button, or when a new record is registered by pressing the [J] (NEW RECORD) button.
If you exit from the MUSIC FINDER EDIT display without actually editing or registering a record, the input genre name
is deleted.

■ [8▲] OK
Executes all editing and changes to the record. When you press this button, a message appears prompting you to
execute, abort or cancel the operation.
YES .................. Press this to replace the record and close the display.
NO .................. Press this to close the display without replacing the record.
CANCEL........... Press this to close the message box and return to the previous display.

■ [8▼] CANCEL
Press this to cancel the operation and return to the MUSIC FINDER display.

CAUTION
To maintain the edited and registered data, make sure to save all Music Finder records as a file (page 154). If no saved, the data will
be lost when another Music Finder file is called up or the factory-programmed settings are restored (page 154).

76 CVP-210/208
Song Playback
Here you’ll learn how to play back songs. Songs include the internal songs of the instrument, performances you’ve
recorded yourself using the recording functions (page 97), and commercially available song data. You can use this
highly versatile feature in a variety of ways — playing along on the keyboard with the recorded song, as well as
practicing and learning new music with the Guide (page 82) and Repeat (page 81) functions. You can also display the
music notation and lyrics in the LCD.
If you connect a microphone to the CVP-210/208, you can sing along with the song and have vocal harmony parts
added automatically (page 131).

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO
SONG MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP
MIXING
CONSOLE
BALANCE
ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1 PART
(STYLE) (L) (R)

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE

NEW SONG SYNC.START

Compatible Song Types


• Internal songs (Song Book)
• Song data on included disk (50 greats for the Piano)
• Commercially available song data Commercially available
music data is subject to
copyright restrictions, and is
intended only for your own
Disks having this logo mark feature song data compatible with GM (General personal use.
MIDI).

Disks having this logo mark feature song data compatible with Yamaha’s XG For more information on the
song file types compatible
format. XG is a significant enhancement of the “GM system level 1” standard, with the Clavinova, see
providing more voices, greater editing control, and support for multiple effect page 162.
sections and effect types.

Disks having this logo mark feature song data compatible with Yamaha’s DOC (Disk Orchestra Collection)
format.

Disks having this logo mark feature song data compatible with Yamaha’s original MIDI file format.

• Songs you recorded (page 97) and stored to the CVP-210/208 or disk.

CVP-210/208 77
Song Playback

Song Playback
Playing the Internal Songs

1 BACK If the MAIN screen (at left) is


not displayed, press the
[DIRECT ACCESS] button
A F
followed by the [EXIT] button.
B G

n
C H
You can also make a variety
D I of other settings (such as
tempo, voice selection, set-
E J
tings for the practice func-
tions, etc.) and have them
automatically called up
when you play back the
song (page 109).

You can enable the Synchro


Start for the song by simul-
2-1 Select the PRESET tab with the [BACK]
2 button.
taneously pressing the
[TOP] button and the
SONG [START/STOP] but-
BACK
ton. The song starts as
soon as you play the key-
A F
board. You can also use this
function along with the
B G Style’s Synchro Start func-
C H
tion (page 64).

D I n
You can have the volume
E J
automatically fade in and
2-2 Open a folder and fade out at the beginning
select a song to be and end of the song. Simply
played back. press the [FADEIN/OUT]
button at the start of song
playback to fade in the song,
and press it again at the end
of the song to fade out.

3 The song starts.


END
START / STOP
REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE

To stop the song immediately, press the


NEW SONG SYNC.START button again.

Adjust the tempo by using the TEMPO [ ][ ] buttons


(page 54) or the [TAP TEMPO] button.
Press the EXIT button in order to go back to the
You can even change the playback speed by tapping out previous screen.
the tempo — simply tap the [TAP TEMPO] button twice.

Songs can also be played back con- Make sure that the Language setting
tinuously. Set SONG CHAIN PLAY to for the instrument (page 154) is the
ON from the SONG SETTING dis- same as that of the file name of the
play (page 140). song that you are playing back.

78 CVP-210/208
Song Playback

The accompaniment stops


Simultaneously Playing a Song and an Accompaniment Style when you stop the song. If
When playing back a song and an accompaniment style at the same time, channels 9 - the accompaniment style is
playing and you start the
16 of the song data are replaced with accompaniment style channels — allowing you song, the accompaniment
to use the auto accompaniment styles and features in place of the accompaniment parts automatically stops. How-
of the song. Make the settings below and play your own chord substitutions in place of ever, for internal songs that
use accompaniment styles,
the song’s chord data. the accompaniment style is
not stopped.
• [ACMP] button .................. ...ON
• [AUTO FILL IN] button ..... ...ON

1 Select the song and start playback by pressing the SONG [START/STOP] button.

2 Select the desired accompaniment style.

3 Start the style by pressing the STYLE [START/STOP] button.

4 While the song is playing, insert a break or change sections (with the STYLE
section buttons.)
Fill-in patterns play when you switch sections.

END
The style automatically stops when the song finishes or is stopped.

Some of the internal songs have been created using the accompaniment styles. For these songs, the
accompaniment styles are automatically started when starting song playback.

CVP-210/208 79
Song Playback

Playing Back Songs on Disk


Before proceeding, make
Insert the disk into the drive. sure to read the section
“Handling the Floppy Disk
Drive (FDD) and Floppy
Disk” (page 6).
Insert the disk shutter side
first and label face up. n
You can set whether or not
the Clavinova automatically
calls up the first disk song
when a disk is inserted
(page 153).
The method for playing back is the same as in the “Playing the Internal Songs” instructions
n
(page 78), except that you should select FLOPPY DISK page in the SONG display. Some song data for the
Clavinova has been
recorded with special “free
tempo” settings. During play-
back of such song data, the
Other Playback-related Operations measure numbers shown in
the display will not corre-
■ Repeat / Rewind / Fast forward spond to the actual mea-
sure; this only serves as a
During playback, you can have the song return to the top and play back again reference as to how much of
from the beginning by pressing this button. When playback is stopped, the song has been played
pressing this button returns the song to the beginning. back.

REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT


n
Songs containing a large
amount of data may not be
able to be read properly by
NEW SONG SYNC.START
the instrument, and as such
Press this button to call up the SONG POSITION display (see you may not be able to
below). To return to the SONG display, press the [EXIT] button. select them. The maximum
capacity is about 200–
SONG POSITION display 300KB, however this may
differ depending on the data
When “BAR” is selected, you can specify a measure number (counted from the contents of each song.
beginning of the song) by using the [REW] and [FF] buttons.
When “PHRASE MARK” is selected, specify the phrase mark number by using the
[REW] and [FF] buttons.
Phrase Mark
This data specifies a certain
location in the song data.

“PHRASE MARK” is shown only when the song contains phrase marks. Press the
[J] button to toggle between “BAR” and “PHRASE MARK,” then use the [REW]
and [FF] buttons to select the desired measure or phrase mark.

■ Adjusting the Volume Balance / Muting Specific Channels

BALANCE

CHANNEL Press this button to call up the BALANCE display (page 65).
ON / OFF

PART Press this button to call up the CHANNEL ON/OFF display (see below).

CHANNEL ON/OFF display


Channel
Refers to the MIDI channel
in the song data. The chan-
nels are assigned as shown
Select the [SONG] tab with the [CHANNEL ON/OFF] button, and mute the desired channel below for the CVP-210/208.
Song
by setting it to [OFF]. To solo a channel (only that channel will sound), hold down the 1 - 16
appropriate button corresponding to the channel. To release the solo for the channel, press Accompaniment Style
that channel’s button again. 9 - 16

80 CVP-210/208
Song Playback

Muting Specific Parts — Track1/Track2/Extra Tracks


This feature lets you mute certain parts of the song (Track1, Track2, Extra Tracks), and play back only those parts you
want to hear. For example, if you want to practice the melody of a song, you can mute just the right-hand part and play
that part yourself.

1 Select the song to be played back (page 77).


You can change the channel
assignments for Track 1 and
Track 2 (page 140), letting
you specify which parts are
muted when pressing the
Use this button to turn on/off the additional performance parts [TRACK 1]/[TRACK 2]/
2 (all but the right hand/left hand).
SONG
[EXTRA TRACKS] buttons.

EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1


(STYLE) (L) (R)

Use this button to turn on/off the right-hand part.


All tracks are automatically
Use this button to turn on/off the left-hand part.
set to on when selecting a
different song.

Start the song.


3 Adjust the tempo by using the TEMPO [ ][ ] buttons (page 54).
END START / STOP

REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE


To stop the song, press the
button again.
NEW SONG SYNC.START

Repeat Playback of a Specific Range


This feature allows you to specify a certain range of the song (between Point A and Point B), and play it back repeatedly.

1 Play back the song (page 78, 80). You can also specify Points
A and B when the song is
stopped. Set Point A by
pressing the [REPEAT] but-
ton, then use the [FF] but-
ton to move to the desired
2 REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT Press this button at the point you want the
repeating phrase to start (Point A).
end location, then set Point
B by pressing the
[REPEAT] button again.
Press this button at the point you want the
NEW SONG SYNC.START
repeating phrase to end (Point B).

Point B cannot be selected


unless Point A has been

3 After an automatic lead-in (to help guide you into the phrase), the range from
point A to point B is played back repeatedly.
selected first.

n
Regardless of whether the song is playing back or is stopped, pressing the [TOP] Specifying only Point A
results in repeat playback
button returns to point A. between Point A and the
end of the song.

n
The specified A and B

4 Stop the song.


START / STOP
END REPEAT
points will be erased when
selecting a different song
number, cancelling the
Repeat function, or select-
To cancel the Repeat function, press the ing a different repeat mode
— such as Phrase Repeat
button again. or repeat in Song Chain
Play (page 140).

CVP-210/208 81
Song Playback

Using the Practice Functions — Guide


These fun features make it easy to learn new music. The key guide lamps indicate the notes
you should play, when you should play them, and how long you should hold them down. You can turn the key guide
Also, when you sing and play along with a song using a connected microphone, the lamps on/off from the SONG
Clavinova automatically adjusts the timing of the song to match your vocal performance. SETTING display (page 140).

REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE

NEW SONG SYNC.START

Key guide lamp

Practice Functions
For keyboard performance

■ Follow Lights
When this is selected, you can see which notes you should play by watching the key You can also determine the
timing by which the key
guide lamps. They light up in time with music, showing you when to play a note. You guide lamps light to fit your
can also practice at your own pace — since the accompaniment waits for you to play playing preference (Guide
the notes correctly. Lamp Timing; page 140).

• Accompaniment Guide n
If you want to learn how to
If the song data you’re using contains chord data and the [ACMP] button is turned on, play certain chords, use the
you can use the guide lamps (page 140) to help you play chords as well. Watch the Chord Tutor function
guide lamps and try playing the appropriate chords. (page 142).

■ Any Key n
The Accompaniment Guide
With this function, you can play the melody of a song simply by pressing a single key function cannot be used if
(any key is OK) in time with the rhythm. As long as you play the key in time with the the chord fingering method
is set to Single Finger, Full
music, the melody flows smoothly with the song. keyboard or AI Full Key-
board.

For sing-along performance


■ Karao-Key
This convenient function lets you control the song and accompaniment playback with just one finger, while you sing
along. Simply play a key on the keyboard in time with the music — any key is fine — and the accompaniment parts
of the song follow your playing. This lets you control the timing and tempo of the song and accompaniment to
perfectly match your singing performance.

■ Vocal CueTIME
Similar to Follow Lights above, you can see which notes to sing by watching the key guide lamps. The Clavinova
follows your singing and automatically adjusts the timing and tempo of the song to match your vocal performance.

82 CVP-210/208
Song Playback

Practicing Music with the Guide Functions

1 Select the desired practice function from the SONG SETTING page in the
FUNCTION display (page 140).
For details on the SONG SET-
TING display, see page 140.
Selects the specific practice function. n
A The guide lamps light
Turns the key guide lamps on/off. according to song channel
B
recorded to Tracks 1 and 2
Determines the timing by which the key C
and the chord data in the
guide lamps light. song (when such data is
JUST ..... The guide lamp lights in time D
included). Normally, you can
with the music, at the same E
leave the AUTO SET CH
time you should play the function set to ON, and the
appropriate notes. song channel will automati-
NEXT..... The guide lamps light slightly cally be set. If the results
ahead of the music, indicating aren't satisfactory, you'll
the notes you should play need to match the Channel
next. The guide lamp flashes if Setting “TRK1 CH” and
you do not play the key with “TRK2 CH” parameters to
the correct timing. the appropriate right- and
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
left-hand parts.

Determines whether phrase mark sections in the song will be repeatedly n


Determines the channel for played back or not. When this is set to ON, the specified measures of the
playing back the harmony Vocoder
phrase play back repeatedly. Call up the SONG POSITION display by This lets you indicate or
sound of the Vocoder. pressing either the [REW] button or the [FF] button, and select “PHRASE “play” the harmony notes
MARK” by pressing the [J] button. Set the desired phrase mark number from the keyboard.
by using the [REW] and [FF] buttons.
n
Phrase Mark
This data specifies a certain
location in the song data.

2 Select the desired song (page 78, 80) and mute the track you wish to practice
(page 81).
n
Track 1 or Tracks 1 & 2 are
automatically selected for
practicing when calling the
practice function — as long
as you haven’t muted the

3 REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE


track to be practiced.

n
The key guide lamps some-
NEW SONG SYNC.START
times light an octave or two
lower/higher than the actual
pitch. Any notes outside of
the 88-key range cannot be
indicated by the key guide

4 REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE lamps.

n
NEW SONG SYNC.START
If the right- and left-hand
parts recorded to the song
data have not been properly
Start the song and try playing the part you’ve muted. separated, the practice func-
Adjust the tempo by using the TEMPO [ ][ ] buttons (page 54). tions may not work as
expected.

5REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE

NEW SONG SYNC.START


END GUIDE

To turn the practice function, press the


button again.
Stop the song.

CVP-210/208 83
Song Playback

Displaying Music Notation — Score


With this feature, you can have the notation automatically shown on the display as the song plays. This can be used
with your own recordings as well as the internal Demo songs.

1 Select the
desired song 2 If the MAIN screen (at left)
is not displayed, press the
(page 78, 80).
A
[DIRECT ACCESS] button
B followed by the [EXIT] but-
ton.
C

The displayed notation is


generated by the Clavinova
based on the song data. As
a result, it may not be
exactly the same as com-
mercially available sheet
music of the same song —
especially when displaying

3 notation of complicated pas-


sages or many short notes.

n
Enables/disables display of the left-hand key range. Some song data for the
Depending on other settings, this parameter may be Clavinova has been
unavailable and may appear grayed out. If this is the recorded with special “free
case, go to the detailed setting display (shown tempo” settings. For such
below; use the [8▲▼] buttons) and set the LEFT song data, the tempo, beat,
CH. parameter to any channel except “AUTO.” Or, measure and music nota-
go to the SONG SETTING display in the Function tion will not be displayed
menu (page 140) and set the TRACK 2 parameter correctly.
to any channel except “OFF.”
n
[RIGHT] and [LEFT] cannot
be turned off at the same
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Enables/disables display of the right-hand key range. time.
Channel 1 is automatically selected when
[TRACK1] is set to [OFF] from the SONG SETTING n
display (page 140). The note name is indicated
at the left of the note. When
the space between the
Enables/disables display of the lyrics.
notes is too small, the indi-
If the selected song does not contain lyric data, lyrics are
cation may be moved to the
not displayed.
top left of the note.

Enables/disables display of the chords. n


If the selected song does not contain chord data, chords You can increase the num-
are not displayed. ber of measures that will be
displayed by decreasing the
Enables/disables display of the note name (pitch). other items to be displayed
Determines the display resolution (or zoom level) of the notation. (parts, lyrics, chords, etc.).
The resolutions are selected in order: X-LARGE (Extra Large),
LARGE, MEDIUM, and SMALL. n
When accidentals (sharp
This calls up the detailed setting display for notation. and flats) and notes cannot
For details, see the next page. be displayed on one line,
they are displayed in the
next line from the middle of
the measure.

n
The notation functions can-
not be used to create song
data by inputting notes. For
information on creating
song data, see page 101.

84 CVP-210/208
Song Playback

Detailed Settings for Notation

When “LEFT” and “RIGHT”


are set to the same channel,
the notation of the right-hand
notes and left-hand notes
are displayed in piano format
(two connected staves).

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

■ [1▲▼] LEFT CH/[2▲▼] RIGHT CH


This determines the Left channel (channel for the left-hand part) and Right channel (channel for the right-hand part).
This setting returns to AUTO when a different song is selected.
AUTO .........................The channels for the right- and left-hand parts are assigned automatically — setting the parts
to the same channel as the channel which is specified in the SONG SETTING display of the
Function menu (page 140).
1-16 ............................Assigns the part to the specified channel, 1- 16.
OFF (LEFT CH only)....No channel assignment.

■ [3▲▼], [4▲▼] KEY SIGNATURE


This lets you enter key signature changes in the middle of a song, at the stopped position. This menu is useful when
the selected song contains no key signature settings for displaying notation.
For a list of the key signatures, with their relative minor keys and accidentals, see the chart below.

Key Signatures and Accidentals


C Maj (A min) G Maj (E min) D Maj (B min) A Maj (F min) E Maj (C min) B Maj (G min) F Maj (D min) C Maj (A min)

C Maj (A min) G Maj (E min) D Maj (B min) A Maj (F min) E Maj (C min) B Maj (G min) F Maj (D min)

The note indicates the root note of the major key, and the note indicates the root of the relative minor.

■ [5▲▼] QUANTIZE
This gives you control over the note resolution in the notation, letting you shift or correct Short notes and ornamented
notes (such as trills and
the timing of all displayed notes so that they line up to a particular note value. Make sure grace notes) which are
to select the smallest note value which is used in the song. shorter than the Note resolu-
tion will not be displayed in
Note resolution: the notation.
1/4 note, 1/8 note, 1/16 note, 1/32 note, 1/4 note triplet, 1/8 note triplet, 1/16 note
triplet, 1/32 note triplet

CVP-210/208 85
Song Playback

■ [6▲▼] NOTE NAME


Select the Note Name type when “NOTE” (page 84) is set to ON.
ABC ................. Note names are indicated as letters (C, D, E, F, G, A, B).
Fixed Do .......... Note names are indicated in solfeggio and differ depending on the selected language (page 53).
English.............. Do Re Mi Fa Sol La Ti
French .............. Ut Re Mi Fa Sol La Si
Italian............... Do Re Mi Fa Sol La Si
German............ Do Re Mi Fa Sol La Si
Spanish............. Do re Mi Fa Sol La Si
Japanese...........
Movable Do..... Note names are indicated in solfeggio according to the scale intervals, and as such are relative to
the key. The root note is indicated as Do. For example, in the key of G major the root note of Sol
would be indicated as Do.
As with “Fixed Do,” the indication differs depending on the selected language.

■ [7▲▼] COLOR NOTE


When this is set to ON, the notes in the display appear in color (C: red, D: yellow, E: green, F: orange, G: blue, A:
purple, and B: white).

■ [8▲] OK
This closes the detailed setting display and starts generating the notation. You can also You can select the display
execute this by pressing the [ENTER] button on the panel. pages (one before and after)
by the using the [BACK]/
[NEXT] buttons or the pedal
■ [8▼] CANCEL (page 142).
This closes the detailed setting display without changing the settings. You can also
execute this by pressing the [EXIT] button on the panel.

86 CVP-210/208
Song Playback

Displaying the Lyrics


This function lets you display the lyrics while the song is playing back — making it easy to sing along with your
performance or song playback.

1 Select the
desired song 2 The language used for lyr-
ics display depends on the
(page 78, 80). A particular lyric data. If the
lyrics are garbled or unread-
B
able, you can remedy this
C by changing the “LYRICS
LANGUAGE” setting from
D
the SONG SETTING dis-
E play (page 140).

3 When the back ground color


is specified in the song
data, the BACK GROUND
setting cannot be changed.

If the selected song does


not contain lyric data, lyrics
Select the BACK are not displayed.
GROUND setting.

If the selected song con-


tains chord data, chord
names are displayed with

4
REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE
the lyrics.

NEW SONG SYNC.START

Start the song. The lyrics can also be


shown on a connected TV
(page 147, 156).

5 The color of
the lyrics END
changes as the
song plays. REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE

The lyrics can be changed


NEW SONG SYNC.START
(page 112).

Stop the song.


To return to the previous page, press the EXIT
button.

CVP-210/208 87
Saving and Recalling Custom Panel Setups — Registration Memory
Registration Memory is a powerful feature that lets you set up the Clavinova just as you want — selecting specific
voices, styles, effect settings etc. — and save your custom panel setup for future recall. Then, when you need those
settings, simply press the appropriate REGISTRATION MEMORY button.
POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT
START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER

REGISTRATION MEMORY FADE IN OUT


FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4

FREEZE 1 2 3 4 TAP TEMPO


5 6 SOUND
CREATOR
E
7 8 MEMORY J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

Registering Panel Setups — Registration Memory


This shows you how to register your custom panel settings to the REGISTRATION
MEMORY buttons. Make all the settings you want with the panel controls, and Registration
Keep in mind that songs or
Memory will “remember” them for you. styles on disk cannot
registered to Registration

1 Set up the panel controls as desired.


For a list of the settings that can be registered, refer to the separate Data List
Memory. If you want to
register a disk-based song
or style, copy the relevant
(Parameter Chart). data to “USER” in the
SONG/STYLE display
(page 40) and register the
data separately.

2 REGISTRATION MEMORY

FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY

3
F Cancels the registration
Select the desired parameter groups and returns to the MAIN
for the settings you want to register. G
display. You can also use
You can also use the [DATA ENTRY] H the [EXIT] button.
dial to navigate in this display. To
register a parameter group, checkmark I

the corresponding box. Groups left J


without checkmarks will not be included
in the Registration Memory setting. Enters a checkmark to the
This allows you to maintain certain selected box. You can also
settings, even when switching among use the [ENTER] button.
Registration Memory presets. You can
also use the Freeze function (page 90)
to override the Registration Memory Removes the checkmark from
changes — letting you prevent certain the selected box. You can also
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
panel settings from being changed. use the [ENTER] button.

Press the desired number button for registering the settings.


END REGISTRATION MEMORY

FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY

Indicator is green ..... The panel setting is registered, but not selected.
Indicator is red......... The panel setting is registered and is currently selected.
Indicator is off.......... The panel setting is not registered.

For information on saving the settings registered here, refer to the next page.

88 CVP-210/208
Saving and Recalling Custom Panel Setups — Registration Memory

Saving Your Registration Memory Setups


The settings registered to the REGISTRATION MEMORY [1]-[8] buttons are saved as a single file.

Keep in mind that the size of


All settings registered to buttons [1]- the Registration bank files
[8] are referred to as a “bank.” The and the memory space they
banks can be saved to “USER” or occupy depends on the
BANK 01 “FLOPPY DISK” as Registration amount of functions set in
bank files. each.

Press the [DIRECT


1 ACCESS] button and [EXIT]
button to call up the MAIN
F
display.
G

2 Save the settings you’ve made to the Registration Memory


buttons as a single Registration bank file (page 48).

The REGISTRATION EDIT display


appears. For details on this display,
see below.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

REGISTRATION EDIT display


The contents of the current Registration Memory bank (REGIST.) are listed in the REGISTRATION EDIT screen. The
names of the stored Registration Memory presets are shown in the display and the indicators of the relevant
REGISTRATION MEMORY buttons are lit in green.
From this screen, you can select, name, or delete the Registration Memory presets.
Select ...............Press the [A] - [J] buttons. The REGIST. display is linked to the REGISTRATION MEMORY [1] - [8]
buttons. When you select the Registration Memory preset in the display, the related button turns
on (indicator is red).
Name ...............This operation is the same as that in “Naming Files and Folders” (page 45) in “Basic Operations
— Organizing Your Data.”
Delete ..............This operation is the same as that in “Deleting Files/Folders” (page 47) in “Basic Operations —
Organizing Your Data.”

Save the result of the Name/Delete operation by returning to the REGISTRATION BANK display and pressing
the [8▼] (UP) button.

CVP-210/208 89
Saving and Recalling Custom Panel Setups — Registration Memory

Recalling a Registration Memory Setup


You can recall all of the panel settings you’ve made — or only those you specifically want or need. For example, if you
de-select “STYLE” in the REGISTRATION MEMORY display, you can keep the currently selected style even when you
change the Registration Memory preset.

Recalling the Registered Settings


Select the desired bank in the REGISTRATION BANK display (page 89).
Press the appropriate REGISTRATION MEMORY button (any whose indicators are
green) to recall the desired settings. You can program your
REGISTRATION MEMORY Registration Memory
FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
presets to be called up in
sequence, in any order you
desire. Once programmed,
the presets 1 - 8 can be
selected in sequence with
the [BACK][NEXT] buttons
or the pedal (page 145).

Selecting the Freeze Settings

1 MENU

DEMO
2
HELP

FUNCTION

Call up the “FREEZE”


page from the
REGIST.SEQUENCE/ Enters a checkmark
FREEZE/VOICE SET to the selected box.
screen (page 145).
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Removes the
checkmark from the
Select the Freeze settings. selected box.

3 Press the [FREEZE] button. When Freeze is active (lamp is lit), the settings you specified in the Freeze
page will be maintained or left unchanged, even when changing Registration Memory presets.

REGISTRATION MEMORY

FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY

4 Press the appropriate REGISTRATION MEMORY button (any whose indicators are green) to recall the
desired settings.
REGISTRATION MEMORY

FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY

90 CVP-210/208
Editing Voices — Sound Creator
The CVP-210/208 has a Sound Creator feature that allows you to create your own voices
by editing some parameters of the existing voices. Once you’ve created a voice, you can • The Voice can be edited in
save it as a USER voice for future recall. realtime while playing
back a song/style.
• Keep in mind that adjust-
POWER METRONOME
START STOP
MIC.
VOCAL HARMONY
SIGNAL OVER
TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING

MENU
BACK NEXT
VOICE EFFECT
REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
ments made to the param-
ON

MASTER VOLUME
OFF
SONG
EXTRA TRACKS
STYLE
TRACK 2
L
TRACK 1
R

TAP TEMPO
DEMO

HELP
A F VOICE PART
ON OFF
VOICE
PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES eters may not make much
change in the actual
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
MIN MAX
TEMPO
TAP TEMPO
TRANSPOSE
DIGITAL
STUDIO

SOUND
CREATOR
D I
1 2 3 4 sound depending on the
E J

STYLE

ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO


RESET

MAIN ENDING rit.


RESET

SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP


DIGITAL
RECORDING

MIXING
CONSOLE
BALANCE
DATA
ENTRY
PIANO
FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
original settings of the
OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART
voice.
SOUNDDIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

CREATOR

Operation

1 Press the [F], [G] or [H] button to select the


Part (MAIN, LAYER or LEFT) containing the 2 Press the
[SOUND
The voice can also be
selected in the SOUND
voice you wish to edit. CREATOR] CREATOR display.
button.

DIGITAL CAUTION
F STUDIO

G
SOUND The settings are lost if the
CREATOR
edited part’s voice is
H
DIGITAL
RECORDING switched to another voice.
I

MIXING
Important data should be
J CONSOLE saved to User Drive or
PART floppy disk.

3 Edit the voice parameters.


The operations for each function selected in this step are covered in detail, starting on page 93 (Natural/
Regular Voice) and page 96 (Organ Flutes).
Select the desired menu by pressing the [NEXT]/[BACK] button.

NATURAL VOICE REGULAR VOICE ORGAN FLUTES

Select the
desired menu.
The selected
menu is
highlighted.

Indicates the parameters available Can be used during editing to


for editing in this display. These compare the sound of the original
correspond to the parameters/values voice with the edited voice.
Opens the Save (Voice) display for saving
shown at the bottom of the display. the edited voice as a User voice (page 48).

4 Save the edited voice to the USER drive


(Flash ROM) as a USER voice (page 48). 5 Press the [USER] button to select the
edited voice, and play the keyboard.

CVP-210/208 91
Editing the voice — Sound Creator

SOUND CREATOR Parameters (Natural/Regular Voices)


PIANO Determines the parameters unique to piano sounds, such as tuning curve or sustain
sampling. This page is available only when the Natural piano voice is selected. The available parameters
differ depending on the
COMMON Determines the common settings such as voice volume or octave. selected voice type, Regular
or Natural (see below).
SOUND Determines the timbre/EG (Envelope Generator)/vibrato of the voice (Regular voice only).
EFFECT/EQ Determines the effect depth/type and equalizer settings.
Keep in mind that there are
HARMONY Determines the Harmony/Echo settings. certain parameters whose
Sound Creator settings
affect only the Main part’s
The parameters for Organ Flutes, see page 96.
voice.
The following parameters are linked to the ones in each display.
Common parameter Other location
MONO VOICE EFFECT (TOP PANEL) page 62
PORTAMENTO TIME MIXING CONSOLE page 125
LEFT PEDAL TYPE CONTROLLER (FUNCTION) page 142
LEFT PEDAL SETTING CONTROLLER (FUNCTION) page 142
FILTER BRIGHTNESS MIXING CONSOLE page 125
FILTER HARMONIC CONTENT MIXING CONSOLE page 125
REVERB DEPTH MIXING CONSOLE page 126
CHORUS DEPTH MIXING CONSOLE page 126
DSP ON/OFF VOICE EFFECT (TOP PANEL) page 61
DSP DEPTH MIXING CONSOLE page 126
DSP TYPE/VARIATION MIXING CONSOLE/VOICE EFFECT (TOP PANEL) page 61,126
EQ LOW GAIN MIXING CONSOLE page 128
EQ HIGH GAIN MIXING CONSOLE page 128
HARMONY/ECHO TYPE HARMONY/ECHO (FUNCTION) page 146
HARMONY/ECHO VOLUME HARMONY/ECHO (FUNCTION) page 146
HARMONY/ECHO SPEED HARMONY/ECHO (FUNCTION) page 146
HARMONY/ECHO ASSIGN HARMONY/ECHO (FUNCTION) page 146
HARMONY/ECHO CHORD NOTE ONLY HARMONY/ECHO (FUNCTION) page 146
HARMONY/ECHO TOUCH LIMIT HARMONY/ECHO (FUNCTION) page 146

Natural Voices and Regular Voices


Built into the CVP-210/208 are two different tone generation sources, Natural and Voices sounded with the XG
XG. The Natural tone generation source and its voices feature a huge amount of wave source are divided into two
memory, giving you enormous and finely detailed expressive power over the sound. groups. One is the original
set of Clavinova voices
The XG source (which powers the Regular voices) provide maximum compatibility (Cool!, Sweet!, Live!,
with a wide variety of devices and song data. Live!Drums, Organ Flutes),
and the other is the conven-
The maximum amount of polyphony for each tone generation source is set up to best tional XG set.
enhance your performance. In general, the songs and styles are played back using the
XG source, while the Natural voices are played from the keyboard — allowing you to
play the Natural voices with full polyphony, even if the song and style data exceeds the polyphonic limit.
Natural! Cool! Sweet! Live! Live!Drums OrganFlutes! XG
Clavinova-exclusive voices GM/XG-compatible voices
Natural voices (sounded by
Regular voices (sounded by XG tone generation source)
Natural tone generation source)
Used mainly for keyboard-played
For keyboard-played voices, song/style playback*
voices

* Depending on the particular style selected, a Natural voice may be used for the accompaniment. Usually, songs are played back using the
XG voices (page 163); however, you can have them automatically “re-voiced” — using the exceptionally rich and realistic sounds exclusive
to the CVP-210/208 (page 124).

92 CVP-210/208
Editing the voice — Sound Creator

PIANO (Natural Piano Voice has been selected)


The explanations here apply to step #3 on page 91.

Determines the tuning curve, especially


for piano voices. Select “FLAT” if you The available parameters
feel the tuning curve of the piano voice differ depending on the
does not quite match that of other selected voice.
instruments voices.
STRETCH .. Tuning curve particularly
for pianos
FLAT .......... Tuning curve in which the
frequency is octave
doubled over the entire
keyboard range
Determines the depth of
These controls are used to adjust the string resonance.
brilliance of the tone. This setting
affects all Natural voices globally. When
other than piano voice (Natural) is Determines the depth of
selected, set this on EFFECT page. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
sustain sampling for the
For details, see the EFFECT page damper pedal.
(page 95).

COMMON
The explanations here apply to step #3 on page 91.

The parameters are the


same as for CONTROLLER
display. For details, see Set the portamento time of each
page 142. part (MAIN/LAYER/VOICE)
(Regular Voice only) (page 125).
Set the volume of the current edited
voice.
This determines whether the voice
is played monophonically (Regular
Determines the touch sensitivity, or Voice only) (page 62).
how greatly the volume responds to
your playing strength.
0 ........Produces more dramatic Shift the octave range of the
level drops, the more softly selected voice up or down in
you play. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
octaves. When the Main or Layer
64.......Normal response. part’s voice is used, the M/LYR
127.....Produces high volume for parameter is available; when the
any playing strength (fixed). Left part’s voice is used, the LEFT
parameter is available.

SOUND (Regular Voice only)


The explanations here apply to step #3 on page 91.

Determines the filter, EG, and


vibrato settings (see below).
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

CVP-210/208 93
Editing the voice — Sound Creator

■ FILTER
FILTER settings determine the overall timbre of the sound by boosting or cutting a
certain frequency range. In addition to making the
sound either brighter or
more mellow, Filter can be
used to produce electronic,
synthesizer-like effects.

• BRIGHTNESS Volume Cutoff frequency


Determines the cutoff frequency or
effective frequency range of the filter (see
diagram). Higher values result in a
brighter sound.

Frequency
(pitch)
These frequencies are Cutoff range
“passed” by the filter.

• Harmonic Content Volume


Determines the emphasis given to the Resonance
Resonance
cutoff frequency (resonance), set in
BRIGHTNESS above (see diagram).
Higher values result in a more
pronounced effect.
Frequency
(pitch)

■ EG
The EG (Envelope Generator) settings determine how the level of the sound changes in time. This lets you reproduce
many sound characteristics of natural acoustic instruments — such as the quick attack and decay of percussion
sounds, or the long release of a sustained piano tone.
• ATTACK ...... Determines how quickly the sound reaches its maximum Level
level after the key is played. The higher the value, the
slower the attack.
• DECAY........ Determines how quickly the sound reaches its sustain
level (a slightly lower level than maximum). The higher
ATTACK DECAY RELEASE
the value, the slower the decay. Time

Key on Key off


• RELEASE ..... Determines how quickly the sound decays to silence after
the key is released. The higher the value, the slower the release. If RELEASE is set to a large
value, the sustain becomes
■ VIBRATO long.

• DEPTH........ Determines the intensity of the Vibrato effect (see diagram). Higher
VIBRATO
settings result in a more pronounced Vibrato. Creates a wavering in the
sound by periodically chang-
• SPEED......... Determines the speed of the Vibrato effect (see diagram). ing the pitch.

• DELAY ........ Determines the amount of time that elapses between the SPEED
Level
playing of a key and the start of the Vibrato effect (see
diagram). Higher settings increase the delay of the Vibrato DEPTH
onset.
DELAY

Time

94 CVP-210/208
Editing the voice — Sound Creator

EFFECT/EQ
The explanations here apply to step #3 on page 91.

NATURAL VOICE
Determines the brilliance of the tone,
when a Natural voice is selected. This
can also be set from the PIANO page
(page 93), when a piano voice is
Determines the effect type (Reverb/ selected.
Chorus/DSP). • Metallic .........Sharp metallic tone
When a regular voice is selected, the • Bright ............Bright tone
DSP type and Variation are set in two • Normal ..........Standard tone
separate menus. For information on the • Mellow...........Soft and mellow tone
effect structure, see page 129; for a list • Dark...............Dark tone
of available effect types, refer to the
separate Data List.

• If you select [Bright] or


[Metallic] as the type of
brilliance, the volume level
This parameter enables you to select whether the will increase slightly. In
sound is sustained while you press the keys on this case, raising the
the keyboard (“PIANO LIKE”), or the sound is [MASTER VOLUME] may
sustained only while you press and hold down the result in distortion. If this
sustain pedal, like playing a real vibraphone happens, lower the vol-
(“NORMAL”) (for Vibraphone voice). ume accordingly.
• “SPEED” parameter is
added when selecting
The same as the “Mixing Console” VIBE ROTOR DSP type.
on page 126. This parameter enables
you to set the speed of
vibrato when you select
REGULAR VOICE the Vibraphone voice, rec-
reating the effect of a vibe
rotor pedal.

Determines the Frequency


and Gain of the Low and
High EQ bands.

The same as the “Mixing Console”


on page 126.

HARMONY
The explanations here apply to step #3 on page 91.

The parameters are the same as for HARMONY/ECHO display of FUNCTION. For details, see page 147.

CVP-210/208 95
Editing the voice — Sound Creator

Organ Flutes
In addition to the many organ voices in the ORGAN voice category, the CVP-210/208 has an ORGAN FLUTES voice.
The explanations here apply to step #3 on page 91.

Operation

The tremolo and trill effects


set via the Harmony/Echo
Use button [1▲▼] to function (page 146) do not
adjust the 16’ or 5 1/3’ Select or adjust the affect the Organ Flutes
footage. You can select parameters (see below). sound (CVP-210 only).
the desired footage
(16’ or 5 1/3’) with the
[D] button(CVP-210
only).

Adjust the Footage.

■ Parameters
Organ Type This parameter specifies the type of organ tone generation to be simulated: Sine or Vintage.
Rotary SP Speed The Rotary SP Speed ([C]) button alternately switches between the slow and fast rotary speaker
speeds when a rotary speaker effect is selected for the Organ Flutes (see “DSP Type” below), and the
VOICE EFFECT [DSP] button is turned on (the Rotary SP Speed button has the same effect as the
VOICE EFFECT [VARIATION] button).
Vibrato On/Off This ([G]) button alternately turns the vibrato effect for the Organ Flutes voice ON or OFF.
Vibrato Depth Can be set to any of three levels via the Vibrato Depth ([H]) button. The button sequentially selects a
depth of “1”, “2”, or “3”.
Footage The footage settings determine the basic sound of the organ flutes.
The term “footage” is a reference to the sound generation of traditional pipe organs, in which the sound
is produced by pipes of different lengths (in feet). The longer the pipe, the lower the pitch of the sound.
Hence, the 16’ setting determines the lowest pitched component of the voice, while the 1’ setting
determines the highest pitched component. The higher the value of the setting, the greater the volume
of the corresponding footage. Mixing various volumes of the footages lets you create your own
distinctive organ sounds.
Volume (VOL) Adjusts the overall volume of the Organ Flutes. The longer the graphic bar, the greater the volume.
Response (RESP) The Response control affects both the attack and sustain portion of the sound, increasing or
decreasing the response time of the initial swell and release, based on the FOOTAGE controls. The
higher the value the slower the swell and release.
Vibrato Speed Determines the speed of the vibrato effect controlled by the Vibrato On/Off and Vibrato Depth above.
Mode The MODE control selects between two modes: FIRST and EACH. In the FIRST mode, attack is
applied only to the first notes played and held simultaneously; while the first notes are held, any
subsequently played notes have no attack applied. In the EACH mode, attack is applied equally to all
notes.
Attack (4’, 2 2/3’, 2’) The ATTACK controls adjust the attack sound of the ORGAN FLUTE voice. The 4’, 2 2/3 ‘and 2’
controls increase or reduce the amount of attack sound at the corresponding footages. The longer the
graphic bar the greater the attack sound.
Length (LENG) The LENGTH control affects the attack portion of the sound producing a longer or shorter decay
immediately after the initial attack. The longer the graphic bar the longer the decay.
Reverb Depth For details about the digital effects, see pages 61, 126.
Chorus Depth
DSP on/off
DSP Depth
DSP Type Determines the DSP effect type to be applied to the Organ Flutes voice. Normally this will be one of the
fifteen (CVP-210), or seven (CVP-208) available Rotary Speaker effects. If any other type of effect is
selected, the Rotary SP Speed ([C]) button in the FOOTAGE/VOL/ATTACK display will not control
rotary speaker speed. Instead, it will have the same effect as the VOICE EFFECT [VARIATION] button.
Variation Variation Determines whether the DSP variation will be set to Slow or Fast when the Organ Flutes voice is
selected (when the Voice Set function is ON — page 146).
Value Sets the DSP variation parameter value (e.g., “LFO Freq” for a Rotary Speaker effect) when the DSP
variation is turned on.
EQ Low The EQ parameters determine the Frequency and Gain of the Low and High EQ bands.
EQ High

96 CVP-210/208
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs
— Song Creator
With these powerful yet easy-to-use song creating features, you can record your own keyboard performances and store
them for future recall. Several different recording methods are available: Quick Recording (page 98), which lets you
record easily and quickly; Multi Recording (page 99), which lets you record several different parts; and Step Recording
(page 101), which lets you enter notes one by one. Songs can include not only the voice settings for the keyboard
performance (Main, Layer, Left), but also the effects, auto accompaniment parts, and Vocal Harmony. The recorded song
can be stored to internal memory or floppy disk (page 40, 48).

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

SONG
DIGITAL
RECORDING
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
(STYLE) (L) (R)

REPEAT GUIDE
REC TOP START / STOP REW FF

NEW SONG SYNC.START

About Song Recording


There are two methods of recording songs: realtime recording and step recording.
■ Realtime Recording
This method lets you record performance data in real time. There are two ways to use realtime recording: Quick and Multi.
Quick Recording (page 98)
This is the easiest recording method, and lets you quickly record the piano song • The internal memory capacity of
you are practicing. You can select from three parts: right hand, left hand and auto the Clavinova is about 3.3MB.
accompaniment. For example, you can record only your right hand performance, Memory capacity for 2DD and 2HD
floppy disks is about 720KB and
or you can simultaneously record both your right hand and the auto 1.44MB, respectively. When you
accompaniment. store data to these locations, all file
types of the Clavinova (Voice,
Multi Recording (page 99) Style, Song, Registration, etc.) are
This lets you record a song with several different instrument sounds, and create stored together.
• The microphone input signal can-
the sound of a full band or orchestra. Record the performance of each instrument not be recorded.
individually and create fully orchestrated compositions. You can also record over • Songs recorded on the CVP-210/
an existing part on an internal song or a song on disk with your own performance. 208 are automatically recorded as
SMF (Standard MIDI File format 0)
■ Step Recording (page 101) data. For details on SMF see
page 162.
This method lets you compose your performance by “writing” it down one event at a • Playback of the recorded song
time. This is a non-realtime, manual recording method — similar to writing music data can be transmitted from MIDI
notation onto paper. By using the Event List (pages 110 - 112), you can input notes, OUT, letting you play the sounds of
a connected external tone genera-
chords and other events one by one. tor (page 149).
• The volume level of each channel
■ Song Editing (page 107) of the song can be adjusted from
The CVP-210/208 also lets you edit the songs you’ve recorded by the Quick the Mixing Console and the set-
tings can be saved. Moreover, even
Recording, Multi Recording and Step Recording methods. after you’ve set a voice for your
When re-recording a specific section of an already-recorded song, use the Punch IN/ keyboard play during recording,
OUT function (page 106). you can record voice selections, so
that the voice changes automati-
cally during playback (page 109).

CVP-210/208 97
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

Quick Recording
This is the easiest recording method — perfect for quickly recording and playing back a piano song you’re practicing, so
you can check your progress.

CAUTION
If you wish to save the recording, make sure to store it to internal memory (USER drive) or floppy disk (page 40, 48).
If you turn off the power or re-record over an existing track before you save the performance, any previous recording will be erased.

■ When creating a new song: ■ When recording over the part of an internal
song or a song on disk with your own
1 REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT
performance:

NEW SONG SYNC.START

1 Select the desired song (page 78, 80).

2 Select the voice and accompaniment style you want to use in the song.
If you want to record to the Layer/Left voices, make sure to set the [LAYER]/[LEFT] buttons to ON.
Make any other desired settings (Reverb, Chorus, etc.) as well.

3 To record without specifying a particular track, press the [REC] button.


In this case, your performance will be recorded automatically to TRACK 1.
If the “LAYER” or “LEFT”
button is on before pressing
To specify the track for recording, simultaneously hold down the [REC] button the REC button, the corre-
sponding Layer and Left parts
and press the button corresponding to the track you want to record. are automatically recorded to
You can select TRACK 1 or TRACK 2 and the EXTRA TRACKS for recording at the same time. different channels.
• Specifying the recording track
To record your keyboard performance: The performance of track 1/2
Press either the [TRACK 1] or [TRACK 2] button. is recorded to the channel
To record the auto accompaniment performance: specified in the SONG SET-
TING display (page 140).
Press the [EXTRA TRACKS] button. REC EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
(STYLE) (L) (R)

To stop recording, press the You can overdub a second


[REC] button again. right-hand performance onto
Track 2 after recording the
first right-hand performance
(including the layer voices)
on Track 1. To do this, set the
[LEFT] button to OFF and

4 Recording starts as soon as you play the keyboard.


You can also start recording by pressing the SONG/
repeat steps 2 and 3.

STYLE [START/STOP] button. Recording can also be To pause, press the SONG
started by pressing down the pedal, if the song start/stop [START/STOP] button. To
function is properly assigned to the pedal (page 142). resume recording, press the
SONG [START/STOP] but-
ton again.

To stop recording, press the [REC] button again. You can also use the metro-

END Recording can also be stopped by pressing down the pedal, if the song start/
stop function is properly assigned to the pedal (page 142).
nome click as a guide while
recording.
The sound of the metronome
is not recorded.

■ Play back your new song


To play back the performance you just recorded, return the song to the beginning by using the [TOP] button and
press the SONG [START/STOP] button.
Playback stops automatically at the end of the song, and returns to the beginning of the song.
You can edit the recorded song data from the SONG CREATOR (1 - 16) displays (page 110).
Press the [6▼] button from the Open/Save display for Song to store the recorded data (page 40, 48).
98 CVP-210/208
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

Multi Recording
This lets you record a song with several different instrument sounds on up to sixteen channels, and create the sound of
a full band or orchestra.
The structure of the channels and parts are shown in the chart below.
Parts Parts
Channels Available parts Channels Available parts
(default settings) (default settings)
Voice MAIN, LAYER, LEFT Accompaniment style Voice MAIN, LAYER, LEFT
1 Voice MAIN 9
Accompaniment style RHYTHM 1 RHYTHM 1 Accompaniment style RHYTHM 1
Accompaniment style RHYTHM 2 Accompaniment style Accompaniment style RHYTHM 2
2 Voice MAIN Accompaniment style BASS 10 Accompaniment style BASS
RHYTHM 2
Accompaniment style CHORD1 Accompaniment style CHORD1
Accompaniment style
3 Voice MAIN Accompaniment style CHORD2 11 Accompaniment style CHORD2
BASS
Accompaniment style PAD Accompaniment style PAD
Accompaniment style PHRASE1 Accompaniment style Accompaniment style PHRASE1
4 Voice MAIN 12
Accompaniment style PHRASE2 CHORD1 Accompaniment style PHRASE2
MIDI Accompaniment style MIDI
5 Voice MAIN 13
CHORD2
Accompaniment style
6 Voice MAIN 14
PAD
Accompaniment style
7 Voice MAIN 15
PHRASE1
Accompaniment style
8 Voice MAIN 16
PHRASE2
About the accompaniment style parts
Rhythm ... This is the basis for the accompaniment, containing the drum and percussion rhythm patterns. Usually one of the drum kits is used.
Bass ........ The Bass part uses various appropriate instrument sounds to match the style, such as acoustic bass, synth bass, and others.
Chord ...... This is the rhythmic chord backing, commonly used with piano or guitar voices.
Pad .......... This part features sustained chords and commonly uses lush sounds such as strings, organ, and choir.
Phrase..... This part is used for various embellishments and riffs that enhance the song, such as brass section accents and chord arpeggios.

CAUTION
If you wish to save the recording, make sure to store it to internal memory (USER drive) or floppy disk (page 40, 48).
If you turn off the power or re-record over an existing track before you save the performance, any previous recording will be erased.

■ When creating a new song: ■ When recording over the part of an internal
song or a song on disk with your own
1 REC TOP START / STOP REW FF REPEAT
performance:

NEW SONG SYNC.START

1 Select the desired song (page 78, 80).

2 Select the desired channel for recording (set it to “REC”) simultaneously


holding down the [REC] button and pressing the appropriate button [1▲▼]
The part is automatically
selected when setting the
- [8▲▼]. Several channels can be selected at the same time. several channels to “REC” at
REC ......................... Enables recording for the channel the same time.

ON ......................... Enables playback of the channel


OFF......................... Mutes the channel
To cancel or disable recording, press the [REC] button once again.

REC

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

CVP-210/208 99
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

3 Select the part you want to assign to the channel to be recorded.


This determines which of the keyboard-played parts (Main/Layer/Left) and the
When selecting the MIDI
part
accompaniment style parts (RHYTHM 1/2, BASS, etc.) are recorded to the • Setting a single channel
to MIDI
recording channels selected in step #2.
All incoming data received
For a list of the initial default assignments, see page 99. via any of the MIDI chan-
nels 1 - 16 is recorded.
When using an external
MIDI keyboard or control-
ler to record, this lets you
record without having to
set the MIDI transmit
C
channel on the external
device.
D
• Setting several channels
to MIDI
When using an external
MIDI keyboard or control-
ler to record, this records
data only over the set
MIDI channel — meaning
the external device must
also be set to the same
channel.

4 Recording starts as soon as you play the keyboard.


You can also start recording by pressing the A single part (with the
exception of MIDI parts) can-
SONG/STYLE [START/STOP] button. The not be assigned to several
recording can be started/stopped by pressing the channels.
pedal if the recording punch in/out function is set
to the pedal (page 106).
The settings of the recorded
parts is stored temporarily
until you execute Quick
Recording, select a song, or
turn the power off.

5 To stop recording, press the [REC] button again.


You can also use the pedal to stop recording by releasing it, if the recording
punch in/out function has been assigned to the pedal (page 106). To pause, press the SONG
[START/STOP] button. To
resume recording, press the
SONG [START/STOP] but-
ton again.

6 Play back your new song.


To play back the performance you just recorded, return the song to the You can also use the metro-
nome click as a guide while
beginning by using the [TOP] button and press the SONG [START/STOP] recording.
button. The sound of the metronome
Playback stops automatically at the end of the song, and returns to the is not recorded.
beginning of the song.

To record a new part, repeat steps 2 - 6 above.


END You can set previously recorded parts to play back, and monitor them
while you record a new part. Continue in this way until you have a
finished song.
You can edit the recorded song data from the SONG CREATOR (1 - 16)
displays (page 110).
Press the [6▼] button from the Open/Save display for Song to store
the recorded data (page 40, 48).

100 CVP-210/208
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

Recording Individual Notes — Step Record


This method lets you create a song by entering notes one by one, without having to perform them in real time. This is
also convenient for recording the chords and the melody separately.

Operation

1 Select an existing song (page 78, 80) to


which you want to add parts or re-record. 3 Press the [A] button to call up the Song
Creator display.
If you want to create a new song,
simultaneously press the [REC] button and
the [TOP] button.

2 Press the [DIGITAL RECORDING] button. C

DIGITAL
STUDIO
E

SOUND
CREATOR

DIGITAL
RECORDING

MIXING
CONSOLE

PART

4 Using the [BACK]/[NEXT]


buttons, select the “1-16” BACK NEXT

tab for recording melodies


and other parts, or select F

the “CHD” (Chord) tab for G

recording chords, and after H

selecting the “1-16” tab, I

select a record channel J

with the [F] (CH) button.

5 Call up the Step Record


display by pressing the
Any voice, effect and other
settings you make in the
[G] button. Mixing Console are automat-
F
ically cancelled when you
G call up the CHD (Chord)
page.
H

J
The voices in the USER and
FLOPPY DISK pages can-
not be selected for Step
recording. You can select
voices from the PRESET
page; however, these may
sound slightly different from
the original voice.

CVP-210/208 101
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

6 First, select the desired voice. To enter the note, first specify the length and loudness in this display,
then enter the pitch by actually playing the note on the keyboard.

Determines the velocity


Moves the cursor position A F
(loudness) of the note to be
up and down. B G
entered (only when recording
the melody). For information
Returns the cursor to the C H
on velocity settings, see below.
beginning of the song (the D I

first note of the first


measure). E J
Determines the length of the
note (as a percentage) from
the position at which it is to be
entered. (This is available only
when recording the melody.)
For information on gate time
settings, see below.
Use these to move the
selected event, in units of 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Each press of this button toggles
measures (BAR), beat, and among the three basic note
clocks. For information on selectors at the bottom of the
measure/beat/clock settings, Specifies the type of note to be input next. (Sixteenth display: normal, dotted, and triplet.
see below. notes are available only when recording the melody.) (This is available only when
This also determines the position to which the pointer recording the melody.)
will advance after a note has been entered. Deletes the event at the cursor.

To close the STEP RECORD display, press the [EXIT] button. Make sure to store the recorded
END data by pressing the [I] (SAVE) button (page 48).

■ Bar/Beat/Clock

Bar 1 2
Beat 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4
Clock 000- 000- 000- 000- 000- 000- 000- 000-
1919 1919 1919 1919 1919 1919 1919 1919

■ Velocity
The table below shows the available settings and the corresponding velocity values.
Kbd. Vel fff ff f mf mp p pp ppp
Actual
playing 127 111 95 79 63 47 31 15
strength

■ Gate Time
The following settings are available:
Normal ....................... 80%
Tenuto ........................ 99%
Staccato...................... 40%
Staccatissimo .............. 20%
Manual ....................... The gate time (note length) can be specified as a percentage by using the [DATA ENTRY] dial.

102 CVP-210/208
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

Recording Melodies — Step Record (Note)


In this section, we’ll show you how to use Step Recording
by guiding you through this actual music example,
shown at right.
The operations here apply to step 6 on page 102.

1 1-2 While holding down this note...

The notation display on the instrument may not be accu-


rate, especially for tied notes or longer notes. To have the
notation displayed accurately, set the gate time to tenuto
1-3 by using the [H] button, and input the notes as desired.
1-1 Select this note. ...press this (to input a tie).

2 2-2

2-3

2-1 Select this note.

3
Select this note.
Selecting a note enters a rest of
the equivalent value. For example,
selecting an eighth note () here
results in a eighth note rest ( ).

4 4-1 Press this button to


display the dotted notes.

4-3

4-2 Select this note.

5 5-1 Call up the normal notes


by pressing this button.

5-3

5-2 Select this note.

■ Play back the newly created melody


Use the [C] ( ▲ ) button to move the cursor to the beginning of the song, and press the SONG [START/STOP] button
to hear the newly entered notes. To actually enter the recorded data, press the [EXIT] button. The entered data can be
edited from the SONG CREATOR (1 - 16) display (page 110).
CVP-210/208 103
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

Recording Chord Changes for the Auto Accompaniment — Step


Record (Chord)
The Chord Step recording feature makes it possible to record auto accompaniment chord changes one at a time with
precise timing. Since the changes don’t have to be played in real time, you can easily create complex, tight chord
changes — over which you can record the melody in normal fashion.
The operations here apply to step 6 on page 102.

Entering Chords and Sections (Chord Step)


For example, you can input the following chord progression by the procedure described
below. Enter the chords by using
the currently selected chord
MAIN A BREAK MAIN B
fingering method in the Auto
Accompaniment section of
the keyboard.

C F G F G7 C

1 Press the MAIN [A] button to specify the section, and enter the chords as shown at right.
MAIN A

C F G
MAIN

C
001:1:000

F
001:3:000

Select this note value and play


G
002:1:000
the chords indicated at right.

2 Press the [BREAK] button to specify the Break section, and enter the chords as shown at right.
MAIN A BREAK

C F G F G7

F
BREAK INTRO 002:3:000

G7
002:4:000

Select this note value and play


the chords indicated at right.

104 CVP-210/208
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

3 Press the MAIN [B] button to specify the section and enter the chord indicated at right.

MAIN A BREAK MAIN B

MAIN

C F G F G7 C

C
003:1:000

Select this note value and play


the chords indicated at right.

■ Play back the newly created chord progression


Use the [C] ( ▲ ) button to move the cursor to the beginning of the song, and press the
SONG [START/STOP] button to hear the newly entered notes. To actually enter the To enter a fill-in, press the
recorded data, press the [EXIT] button. The entered data can be edited from the SONG [AUTO FILL IN] button and
CREATOR (CHD) display (page 111). Finally, press the [F] (EXPAND) button from the press one of the MAIN [A] –
[D] buttons.
SONG CREATOR (CHD) display in order to convert the input data into song data.

END Mark
An “END” mark is shown in
the display, indicating the
end of the song data.
The actual position of the
End mark differs depending
on the section that is input at
the end of the song. When
an Ending section is input,
the End mark automatically
follows the Ending data.
When a section other than
Ending is input, the End
mark is set two measures
after the final section.
The End mark can be freely
set to any position desired.

CVP-210/208 105
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

Select the Recording Options: Starting, Stopping,


Punching In/Out — Rec Mode
From this display you can set up how recording is started and stopped for either Quick Recording or Multi Recording.
To call up these settings, select the REC MODE display by using the [BACK][NEXT] button, after performing operation
steps 1–3 on page 101.
These settings determine how recording will
start.

Normal F

Overwrite recording starts when you press the


SONG [START/STOP] button or when you play G

the keyboard with Synchro standby set to ON. Calls up the SONG display,
H
from which you can save the
First Key On I edited data.
Overwrite recording starts as soon as you start
playing the keyboard. This setting also preserves J
When this is set to ON, you can
the previous lead-in data, letting you record over use the sostenuto (center)
the original lead-in without erasing it. pedal to control the punch-in
Punch In At and punch-out points. Press
The song plays back normally up to the indicated and hold down the sostenuto
Punch In measure (set by the [3▲▼] buttons), pedal to record. Recording
then starts overwrite recording at that Punch In stops when you release the
measure. pedal.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Determines the measure at which Punch In Determines the Punch Out


overwrite recording starts (when “PUNCH IN AT” measure — the measure at
is selected). which Punch In overwrite
recording stops (when
These settings determine how recording will stop as well as what happens to previously recorded data. “PUNCH OUT AT” is selected).
Replace All
This deletes all data following the point at which recording is stopped.
When the Pedal Punch In/
Punch Out
Out function is set to ON, the
This maintains all data following the point at which recording is stopped.
current function assignment
Punch Out At of the sostenuto pedal is
Overwrite recording continues until the indicated Punch Out measure (set by the [6▲▼] buttons), then cancelled.
stops at that Punch Out measure, after which song playback continues normally.

About Punch In/Out


This feature is useful primarily for re-recording or replacing a specific section of an already recorded channel. The
illustrations below indicate a variety of situations in which selected measures in an eight-measure phrase are re-recorded.
Original data
REC START setting 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 *1 When measures 1 - 2 are not
REC END setting overwritten, recording starts
Stop recording *2
from measure 3.
Start/start overwrite recording *1
NORMAL
REPLACE ALL 1 2 3 4 5 Deleted
*2 You’ll have to press the [REC]
button at the end of 5 measures.
Start/start overwrite recording *1 Stop recording *2
NORMAL
PUNCH OUT 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Stop overwrite recording/
Start/start overwrite recording *1 play original data
NORMAL
PUNCH OUT AT=006 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Start/ Start playing the keys/
play back original data start overwrite recording Stop recording *2
FIRST KEY ON
REPLACE ALL 1 2 3 4 5 Deleted

Start/ Start playing the keys/


play back original data start overwrite recording Stop recording *2
FIRST KEY ON
PUNCH OUT 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Start/ Start playing the keys/ Stop overwrite recording/
play back original data start overwrite recording play original data
FIRST KEY ON
PUNCH OUT AT=006 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Start/
play back original data Start overwrite recording Stop recording *2
PUNCH IN AT=003
REPLACE ALL 1 2 3 4 5 Deleted

Start/ Stop recording *2


play back original data Start overwrite recording
PUNCH IN AT=003
PUNCH OUT 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Start/ Stop overwrite recording/ Previously recorded data
play back original data Start overwrite recording play original data
PUNCH IN AT=003 Newly recorded data
PUNCH OUT AT=006 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Deleted data

106 CVP-210/208
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

Editing a Recorded Song


Whether you’ve recorded a song using Quick Recording, Multi Recording, or Step Recording, you can use the editing
features to change the song data.

Editing Channel-related Parameters — Channel


Calling up the operations here apply to step 4 on page 101. To call up the display shown below, use the [BACK]/[NEXT]
buttons.

Quantize
Quantize lets you “clean up” or tighten the timing of a previously recorded channel. For example, the following
musical passage has been written with exact quarter-note and eighth-note values.

Even though you think you may have recorded the passage accurately, your actual performance may be slightly ahead
of or behind the beat. Quantize allows you to align all the notes in a channel so that the timing is absolutely accurate to
the specified note value (see below).

A F
Use this to select the
desired edit operation. B G

Calls up the SONG display,


C H
from which you can save
Executes the Quantize D I the edited data.
operation. After the
E J
operation is completed, this Determines how strongly the
button changes to [UNDO], notes will be quantized. If a
letting you restore the value less than 100% is
original data if you’re not selected, notes will be
satisfied with the Quantize moved toward the specified
results. The Undo function quantization beats only by
only has one level; only the the specified amount.
previous operation can be Applying less than 100%
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
undone. quantization lets you
preserve some of the
Selects the desired Selects the quantize size (resolution). “human” feel in the
channel to be quantized. See the below for the details. recording.

■ About Quantize Size


Set the Quantize size to correspond to the smallest notes in the channel you are working with. For example, if the
data was recorded with both quarter notes and eighth notes, use 1/8 note for the Quantize size. If you apply a 1/4
note Quantize size, the eighth notes would be moved on top of the quarter notes.

One measure of eighth notes before quantization After 1/8 note quantization

Quantize Size

1/4 note 1/8 note 1/16 note 1/32 note 1/16 note +
1/8 note triplet *

1/4 note triplet 1/8 note triplet 1/16 note triplet 1/8 note + 1/16 note +
1/8 note triplet * 1/16 note triplet *
The three Quantize settings marked with asterisks (*) are exceptionally convenient, since they allow you to quantize two different
note values at the same time, without compromising the quantization of either one. For example, if you have both straight 1/8 notes
and 1/8 note triplets recorded to the same channel, and you quantize to straight 1/8 notes, all notes in the channel are quantized to
straight 1/8 notes — completely eliminating any triplet feel in the rhythm. However, if you use the 1/8 note + 1/8 note triplet setting,
both the straight and triplet notes will be quantized correctly.

CVP-210/208 107
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

Delete
This lets you delete recorded data in the specified channel.

A F
Use these to select the
desired edit operation. B G

C H

Deletes all data in the D I Calls up the SONG display,


selected channel. After the from which you can save
E J
operation is completed, this the edited data.
button changes to [UNDO],
letting you restore the
original data. The Undo
function only has one level;
only the previous operation
can be undone.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

These select the channel to be deleted.

Mix
This function lets you mix the data of two channels and place the results in a different channel. It also lets you copy the
data from one channel to another.

All data other than the mixed


A F
note data is derived from the
Use these to select the Source 1 channel.
desired edit operation. B G

C H

Executes the Mix operation. D I


Calls up the SONG display,
After the operation is E J
from which you can save
completed, this button the edited data.
changes to [UNDO], letting
you restore the original data
if you’re not satisfied with
the Mix results. The Undo
function only has one level;
only the previous operation
can be undone. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

These let you specify the two Determines the channel into which the
source channels to be mixed. mix or copy results will be placed.

If “COPY” is selected here, the data


from Source 1 is copied to the
Destination channel.

108 CVP-210/208
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

Channel Transpose
This allows you to transpose the recorded data of individual channels up or down by a maximum of two octaves in
semitone increments.

Toggles between the two


channel displays: Channels
A F 1 - 8, and Channels 9 - 16.
Use these to select the
desired edit operation. B G
To simultaneously set all
C H
channels to the same value,
adjust the Channel Transpose
Executes the Channel D I
for one of the channels while
Transpose operation. After E J
holding down this button.
the operation is completed,
this button changes to
[UNDO], letting you restore
the original data if you’re not Calls up the SONG display,
satisfied with the Channel from which you can save
Transpose results. The the edited data.
Undo function only has one
level; only the previous 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
operation can be undone.

Determines the amount of transpose for each channel.

Set Up
You can change the initial settings of the song — such as voice, level, and tempo — to the current settings of the mixing
console or panel controls.

A F

Use these to select the


desired edit operation. B G

C H

Executes the SET D I Calls up the SONG display,


UP operation. Once from which you can save
E J
SET UP has been the edited data.
executed, the
operation cannot be
cancelled or undone.

Use this to checkmark the


selected item.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Checkmarked items are
stored with the song.

Determines which playback features and functions will be automatically called up along with the selected song. All
events, with the exception of “KEYBOARD VOICE,” can be recorded only at the beginning of the song.
Before you select or checkmark any of these items (other than Keyboard Voice), make sure to return the song to the
beginning by using the [TOP] button, and stop playback.

Song.............................Stores the tempo setting and all settings made from the Mixing Console.
Keyboard Voice ...........This lets you automatically set the voice of the keyboard-played parts (Main/Layer/Left)
when playing back the song. Stores the keyboard-played voice and the part ON/OFF
settings. To record a voice change for the keyboard-played part in the middle of a song, stop
the song at the desired point, make the voice change, and press the [D] (EXECUTE) button.
Lyrics Bkgd/Lng..........Stores the settings of the Lyrics display.
Score Setting ..............Stores the settings of the Score display.
Mic. Setting..................Stores the microphone settings in the mixing console.
Guide Setting ..............Stores the settings of the practice functions. When the settings are stored, selecting a song
automatically turns on the Guide functions.

CVP-210/208 109
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

Editing Note Events — 1 - 16


From this display, you can edit individual note events (see below). Calling up operations here apply to step 4 on
page 101. Use the [BACK]/[NEXT] buttons to call up the display below.

Determines the channel to


Use these to move the be edited.
cursor up/down and select A F Calls up the Step Recording
the desired event. display (page 102).
B G

Returns to the beginning Calls up the Filter display


position of the current song C H
(page 112), letting you select
(the first note of the first D I
only the events you wish to
measure). shown in the Event List.
Use these to move the E J

Calls up the SONG display,


cursor left/right and select
from which you can save
the desired parameter of
the edited data.
the highlighted event.
Holding this button down
while using the [A] and [B]
buttons lets you select
multiple events.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Pastes all cut or copied events to


Determines the current
the selected location.
position of the event being
edited. If the value at the cursor has been
changed, pressing this restores the
For coarse adjustment of the event value. original value.
Copies all selected events. The
For fine adjustment of the event value. copied events can be pasted to
another location.

Cuts (deletes) all selected events. The cut events Deletes the
are copied and can be pasted to another location. event at the
cursor position.
To actually enter an edited
Adds a new event to the Event List.
value, move the cursor away
from the value or press the
SONG [START/STOP] but-
ton.

Note Events
Parameter Description
Note Determines the pitch, velocity (volume) and length of the note.
Determines the control change number and value. For details on control change messages, refer to the separate
Ctrl (Control change)
Data List booklet (MIDI Data Format).
Determines the voice (program) number. For details on program change messages and how to set them, refer to
Prog (Program change)
the separate Data List booklet (Voice List).
P.Bnd (Pitch bend) Determines the pitch bend value.
A.T. (After touch) Determines the after touch value.

The sound of the voices


recorded with Step recording
may sound slightly different
from the original.

110 CVP-210/208
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

Editing Chord Events — CHD


From this display, you can edit the chord events you’ve recorded to the song.
Calling up operations here apply to step 4 on page 101. Use the [BACK]/[NEXT] buttons to call up the display below.
With the exception of the [F] (EXPAND) button, the operations here are the same as those in Editing Note Events
(page 110).

A F Press this to convert the


recorded chord and section
B G
entries into song data.
C H

D I

To actually enter an edited


E J
value, move the cursor away
from the value or press the
SONG [START/STOP] but-
ton.

Chord Events
Parameter Description
Style (Accompaniment Displays the accompaniment style name. To enter an accompaniment style, call up the STYLE display and select
style) the desired style.
Tempo Determines the tempo value.
Chord Specifies the chord — its root note, chord type, and on-bass note.
Sect (Section) Specifies the section — its name and variation.
OnOff (Channel on/off) Determines whether specific channels (rhythm, bass, etc.) are turned on/off.
CH.Vol (Channel volume) Determines the level of specific channels (rhythm, bass, etc.).
S.Vol (Style volume) Determines the level of the entire accompaniment style.

Editing System Events — SYS/EX. (System Exclusive)


From this display, you can edit recorded System events.
Calling up operations here apply to step 4 on page 101. Use the [BACK]/[NEXT] buttons to call up the display below.
The operations here are the same as those in Editing Note Events (page 110).

System Events
Parameter Description
ScBar (Score initial measure) This determines the number of the top measure. The measure number is indicated in the MAIN display or in the
music notation. Only one value can be specified at the beginning of the song data.
Tempo Determines the tempo value.
Time (Time signature) Determines the time signature.
Key Determines the key, as well as the major/minor setting.
XG Prm (XG parameters) Allows you to make various detailed changes to the data. For more information on XG parameters, refer to the
separate Data List booklet (MIDI Data Format).
SYS/EX. (System Exclusive) Displays the System Exclusive data in the song. This does not let you change the actual contents of the data;
however, it lets you delete, cut, copy, and paste the data.
Meta (Meta event) Displays the SMF meta events in the song. This does not let you change the actual contents of the data;
however, it lets you delete, cut, copy, and paste the data.

CVP-210/208 111
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs — Song Creator

Inputting and Editing Lyrics


This convenient function lets you enter the song name and the lyrics for the song. It also lets you change or correct
already existing lyrics. For more information on lyric events, see the chart below. Calling up operations here apply to
step 4 on page 101. Use the [BACK]/[NEXT] buttons to call up the display below. The operations here are the same as
those in Editing Note Events (page 110).
In the following example, we’ll rewrite a portion of the lyrics to one of the songs, “Twinkle Twinkle Little Star.”
Select the internal song “Twinkle Twinkle Little Star.” The method for selection is the same as described on page 78.

1 Move the cursor


to the event A F
4 Press this button
to save the newly
containing the B G
changed lyric
lyric “star.” data.
C H

D I

2 Move the cursor


to the word “star.”
E J
The song “Twinkle Twinkle
Little Star” is in the folder
“For Children” in the Song
Book (page 78).
3 Use these buttons to call up
the Lyric display, from
which you can input lyrics. To actually enter an edited
From the Lyric display 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
value, move the cursor away
from the value or press the
(page 49), enter the new
SONG [START/STOP] button.
word, “(your name).”

Lyrics Events
Parameter Description
Name (Song name) Determines the song name. This calls up the NAME display, from which you can enter the name.
Lyrics Allows you to enter lyrics.
Code (Other controls) CR : Enters a line break in the lyrics text.
LF : Deletes the currently displayed lyrics and displays the next set of lyrics.

Customizing the Event List — Filter


This function lets you determine which event types will be shown in the event editing displays. To select an event for
display, checkmark the box corresponding to the event name. To filter out an event so that it is not shown on the list,
remove the checkmark so that the box is empty.
To call up the display below, press the [H] (FILTER) button from any of the following displays: CHD, 1 - 16, SysEX, or
LYRICS (page 110 - page 112).
Enters checkmarks for all
Calls up the Main Filter display.
items.
For more information on each
event type, refer to the separate A F
Selects only note data;
Data List booklet (MIDI Data checkmarks for all other
Format).
B G
boxes are removed.
C H

Calls up the Control Change D I Reverses the checkmark


Filter display. For more settings for all boxes. In
E J
information on each event type, other words, this enters
refer to the separate Data List checkmarks to all boxes
booklet (MIDI Data Format). that were previously un-
checked and vice versa.

Calls up the Accompaniment Filter display.


Enters/removes the checkmark
For more information on each event type,
for the selected item.
refer to the separate Data List booklet (MIDI
Data Format). 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Selects the item, scrolling up/


down one item at a time.
Execute the settings
END EXIT
by pressing the When “MAIN FILTER” or “ACCOMPANIMENT FILTER” is
selected, these select the item, scrolling up/down to the top or the
[EXIT] button. bottom. When “CONTROL CHANGE FILTER” is selected, these
select the item, scrolling up/down eight items at a time.

112 CVP-210/208
Creating Accompaniment Styles — Style Creator
This powerful feature lets you create your own original styles, which can then be used for auto accompaniment — just
as with the preset styles.

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER

DIGITAL FADE IN OUT


FUNCTION

RECORDING MIN MAX


DIGITAL
STUDIO
C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING

TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

STYLE DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

ACMP AUTO FILLIN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING / rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START / STOP

A B C D
OTS LINK

About Creating Accompaniment Styles


The chart at right shows the basic parts (or “channels”) that make up each section
Section Channel
of an accompaniment style. To create an accompaniment style, record patterns to
the various channels one by one, for each of the sections you want to create. INTRO A - D
MAIN A - D RHYTHM 1, RHYTHM 2,
■ Realtime Recording (page 115) FILL IN A - D
BASS, CHORD 1,
CHORD 2, PAD,
You can record accompaniment styles by simply playing the parts from the BREAK PHRASE 1, PHRASE 2
keyboard in real time. However, you don’t have to record every part yourself ENDING A - D
— you can choose an existing preset accompaniment style that is close to the
style you want, then add or replace parts in that style as needed to create your
For information on the part
own custom style. structure of accompaniment
styles, see page 99.
Realtime Recording Characteristics
• Loop recording
Since auto accompaniment playback repeats the accompaniment patterns of several measures in a “loop,” you can
also record patterns in a loop. For example, if you start recording with a two-measure Main section, the two
measures are repeatedly recorded. Notes that you record will play back from the next loop (repetition), letting you
record new material while hearing the parts you previously recorded.
• Overdub recording
This feature lets you record new material to a channel already containing recorded data, without deleting the
original data. In style recording, the recorded data remains intact, unless you specifically delete it yourself. For
example, if you start recording with a two-measure Main section, the two measures are repeated. As you record
notes to each pass of the loop (repetition), those notes play back from the next loop, letting you overdub new
material while hearing the previous parts.

■ Step Recording (page 116)


This method is like writing music notation on paper, since it allows you to enter each note or individually, and
specify its length. This is ideal for making precise recordings, or for recording parts that are difficult to play.

■ Assembling an Accompaniment Style (page 117) 8 Beat 1 60’s 8 Beat


Rhythm 1 Rhythm 1
This convenient feature lets you create composite styles by combining Rhythm 2 Rhythm 2
various patterns from the internal preset accompaniment styles. For Bass Bass
Chord 1 Chord 1
example, if you want to create your own original 8-beat style, you Chord 2
Rhythm 1
Chord 2
Rhythm 2
could take rhythm patterns from the “8 Beat 1” style, use the bass Pad Pad
Phrase 1 Bass Phrase 1
pattern from “8 Beat 2,” and import the chord patterns from the “60’s 8 Phrase 2 Chord 1 Phrase 2
Beat” style — combining the various elements to create one Chord 2
8 Beat 2
accompaniment style. Pad
Rhythm 1 Phrase 1
Rhythm 2
■ Editing the created Accompaniment Style (page 118) Bass
Phrase 2

With the editing features, you can custom edit the styles you’ve Chord 1
Chord 2
created by real time recording, step recording, and assembling from Pad
other styles. Phrase 1
Phrase 2

CVP-210/208 113
Creating Accompaniment Styles — Style Creator

Style File Format


Source Pattern These are the patterns
The Style File Format (SFF) combines all of recorded to the
Yamaha’s auto accompaniment know-how into 1 Source Root (root note of basic chord) accompaniment styles
2 Source Chord (type of basic chord)
a single unified format. By using the edit (page 121).
functions, you can take full advantage of the Chord changes (in Auto Accompa-
This data is created by
SFF format and freely create your own styles. niment section of the keyboard)
chords played in the
The chart at right indicates the process by Pitch Conversion Auto Accompaniment
which the accompaniment is played back. section of the
3 NTR (Note Transposition Rule)
keyboard (page 66).
(This does not apply to the rhythm channels.) 4 NTT (Note Transposition Table)
The basic or “source” pattern in the chart is the
original style data. This source pattern is These settings are
recorded using accompaniment style Other Settings edited from the
PARAMETER display.
recording (see below). 5 High Key (threshold of the pitch
These parameters
As shown in the chart at right, the actual conversion)
determine how the
6 Note Limit (soundable range)
output of the accompaniment is determined by 7 RTR (Retrigger Rule; how the pitches of
pitch of the source
various parameter settings and chord changes pattern is converted
the chord change)
when you play chords
(played in Auto Accompaniment section of the in the Auto
keyboard) entered to this source pattern. Accompaniment
Output section of the
keyboard (page 121).

Operation

1 Select the desired accompaniment style


for editing. To record a new 3
accompaniment style from scratch, call A

up the BASIC page in the Style Creator


B

display and select “New Style” by


pressing the [C] button.
C

2 DIGITAL
STUDIO
SOUND
CREATOR

DIGITAL
RECORDING

MIXING
CONSOLE

PART

4 Record and edit the


accompaniment style. For
BACK NEXT

details on the operations for Use the [BACK]/[NEXT]


F
buttons to select the
each display, refer to the various pages.
explanations starting on the next G

page. H

5 Call up the Style display by pressing the [I] (SAVE) button


(in Assembly page: [J] button), then save the recorded /
Press the [EXIT] button to
close the STYLE
edited data to the USER or FLOPPY DISK page. END CREATOR display.

114 CVP-210/208
Creating Accompaniment Styles — Style Creator

Realtime Recording — Basic


You can use the Realtime Recording features to create your own accompaniment style — either from scratch or based
on the preset accompaniment data. The operations here apply to step 4 on page 114.

1 Select the desired channel for recording by simultaneously holding down the [F] (REC CH) button and
pressing the appropriate [1▲▼] - [8▲▼] button.
Before recording to one of the non-rhythm channels (BASS - PHR 2), make sure to delete the existing data
of the appropriate channel. You can make other settings (see the box “Other Parameters in the BASIC
Display” on page 116) after closing the REC CHANNEL display by pressing the [EXIT] button. To call up the
REC CHANNEL display again, press the [F] (REC CH) button.

When this button is pressed, “DELETE” will appear over


Calls up the display for changing the channels containing data. To delete data from a specific
tempo or beat (time signature). channel, simultaneously hold down this button and press the
appropriate [1▲] - [8▲] button. To release or cancel the
selection, press the [1▼] -
[8▼] button corresponding to
Selects an empty style, the channel you wish to
allowing you to create a A F
cancel. As long as you
new style from scratch. B G
continue to hold down the [J]
button, you can toggle
C H between deleting and
restoring the selected data.
D I
Releasing the [J] button
E J permanently deletes the
data. Before recording to one
Available only when the channel is set to
of the non-rhythm channels
[RHY1] or [RHY2], this lets you delete
(BASS - PHR 2), make sure
specific percussion sounds during
to delete the existing data of
recording. Simultaneously hold down this
the appropriate channel.
button and press the key corresponding to
the instrument you want to delete. REC.....Channel is enabled for recording.
ON.......Channel is enabled for playback.
OFF .....Channel is muted.

2 First, select the desired voice. Start recording by pressing the STYLE [START/
STOP] button.
If you’ve enabled Sync Start
(by pressing the SYNC.
START button), you can
The selected section of the style starts playing back. Since the rhythm pattern start recording by simply
loops repeatedly, you can record new sounds and notes on each pass while pressing a key on the key-
listening to the pattern. Icons above the keys conveniently indicate the board.
percussion instruments assigned to the keys.

• Any voice can be selected


3 Stop recording by pressing the STYLE [START/STOP] button again. for the RHY1 channel,
with the exception of
Organ Flutes.
• Only Drum Kit/SFX Kit
can be selected for the
RHY 2 channel.
• For the non-rhythm chan-
4 With the REC CHANNEL display shown, close the display by pressing the
[EXIT] button.
nels (BASS - PHR 2), all
voices with the exception
of the Organ Flutes voice/
Drum Kit/SFX Kit can be
selected.

CVP-210/208 115
Creating Accompaniment Styles — Style Creator

Other Parameters in the BASIC Display You can also select the desired
section for recording by press-
• [I] (SAVE) button
ing the appropriate panel but-
Calls up the Style display for saving the accompaniment style data. ton. Pressing one of the
• [3▲▼][4▲▼] (Section) buttons Section buttons calls up the
Determines the section to be recorded. SECTION display, from which
you can change sections by
• [5▲▼][6▲▼] (Pattern Length) buttons using the [6▲▼]/[7▲▼] but-
Determines the length of the selected section’s pattern in measures (1 - 32). The tons. To actually enter the
Fill In/Break section is fixed at a length of one measure. change, press the [8▲] button.
To select the Fill In section,
• [D] (Execute) button press the [AUTO FILL IN] but-
Executes the Pattern Length change. ton.

Recording — Precautions
• The basic chord used for the accompaniment style is called the source chord. All
chords that play and the pitches that sound are derived from the source chord. When
recording the Main and Fill In sections (for a source chord of CM7), keep the C R C C R C
following points in mind: C = chord note
C, R = recommended note
* When recording to the Bass or Phrase channels, try to use only the recommended
notes; this will ensure that you can play various chords with the accompaniment
style and get optimum results. (Other notes may work, providing you use them as short passing tones.)
* When recording to the Chord or Pad channels, use only the notes of the CM7 chord; this will ensure that you
can play various chords with the accompaniment style and get optimum results. (Other notes may work,
providing you use them as short passing tones.)
The source chord is set by default to CM7; however, you can change this to any chord you prefer. Refer to the
section “Making Style File Format Settings – Parameter” on page 121.
• When recording Intro and Ending sections, you can ignore the source chord and use any notes or chord
progressions you like. In this case, if you set the NTR parameter to “ROOT TRANSPOSE” and NTT to
“HARMONIC MINOR” or “MELODIC MINOR” (in the PARAMETER page), the normal pitch conversions that
would result from playing different chords are cancelled (for playback) — meaning that the accompaniment
pitch conversion will only occur for changes in the root note or major/minor shifts.

Step Recording
With this method, you can create a style pattern by entering notes and other data individually, without having to
perform them in real time. The operations here apply to step 4 on page 114.

The actual recording process is the same as in Step Recording of songs (page 101), with the exception of the points
described below. You can also edit each event from the Edit page, and the editing process the same as in editing songs
(page 110).
• In song recording, the end mark position can be changed freely. However, it cannot be changed when creating
accompaniment styles. This is because the length of the accompaniment style is automatically fixed according to the
selected section. For example, when creating an accompaniment style based on a four-measure section, the end mark
position is automatically set to the end of the fourth measure, and cannot be changed from the Step Record screen.
• When editing the data recorded on the Edit page, you can switch between the type of data you want to edit (event
data or control data). Press the [F] (TRACK EVT) button to switch between the Event display (Note, Control Change,
etc.) and the Control display (System Exclusive, etc.).
Make sure to set the record channel from another display (e.g., BASIC display; page 115) beforehand.

116 CVP-210/208
Creating Accompaniment Styles — Style Creator

Assembling an Accompaniment Style —Assembly


This convenient function lets you combine accompaniment elements — such as rhythm, bass, and chord patterns —
from existing styles, and use them to create your own original accompaniment styles. The operations here apply to step
4 on page 114.

1 These let you select the accompaniment style that


will be used for each channel of your original
style. Select the desired channel by pressing the
3 After repeating steps 1 and 2
as desired, press the [J] (SAVE)
[A] – [D], [F] – [I] buttons and press the same button to save the assembled
button to call up the Style screen, from which you style data. From here, you can
can select the accompaniment style. store the settings of all
channels (RHYTHM1,
RHYTHM2, BASS, etc.) to a
single accompaniment style.

A F

B G

C H

D I

E J

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Determines the playback setting for each channel.


2 Selects the style section
and channel that will be You can assemble the accompaniment style while the style section
copied to the and channel that will be copied are playing.
corresponding channels, SOLO ........... Mutes all but the selected channel. RHYTHM
selected with the [A]-[D] channels set to REC in the REC CHANNEL display
and [F]-[I] buttons above. (page 115) are played back simultaneously.
ON ............... Plays back the selected channels. Any channels set
to ON in the REC CHANNEL display (page 115) are
played back simultaneously.
OFF .............. Mutes the selected channel. If the selected channel
is set to ON in the REC CHANNEL display
(page 115), OFF does not appear and is not
available.

If you change the section and channel in steps


#1 and #2, the currently specified section and
channel are also changed. The channels
being recorded are also changed and record-
ing is stopped automatically.

The PLAY TYPE parameter affects only the


playback, and does not change the actual
accompaniment style data.

CVP-210/208 117
Creating Accompaniment Styles — Style Creator

Edit the Created Accompaniment Style


Change the Rhythmic Feel — Groove and Dynamics
These versatile features give you a wide variety of tools for changing the rhythmic feel of your created accompaniment
style. The operations here apply to step 4 on page 114.

■ Groove

Use these to select the


desired edit operation. A F
Calls up the Style display and
B G lets you store the edited
accompaniment style data.
C H

D I

E J

Executes the Groove operation. After


the operation is completed, this button
changes to [UNDO], letting you
Determines the settings for each of the
restore the original data if you’re not
Groove parameters (see the list below).
satisfied with the Groove results. The
Undo function only has one level; only
the previous operation can be undone. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Groove parameters
Original Beat Specifies the beats to which Groove timing is to be applied. In other words, if “8 Beat” is selected, Groove timing is
applied to the 8th notes; if “12 Beat” is selected, Groove timing is applied to 8th-note triplets.

Beat Converter Actually changes the timing of the beats (specified in the ORIGINAL BEAT parameter above) to the selected value. For
example, when ORIGINAL BEAT is set to “8 Beat” and BEAT CONVERTER is set to “12,” all 8th notes in the section are
shifted to 8th-note triplet timing. The “16A” and “16B” Beat Converter which appear when ORIGINAL BEAT is set to “12
Beat” are variations on a basic 16th-note setting.

Swing Produces a “swing” feel by shifting the timing of the back beats, depending on the ORIGINAL BEAT parameter above.
For example, if the specified ORIGINAL BEAT value is “8 Beat”, the Swing parameter will selectively delay the 2nd, 4th,
6th, and 8th beats of each measure to create a swing feel. The settings “A” through “E” produce different degrees of
swing, with “A” being the most subtle and “E” being the most pronounced.

Fine Selects a variety of Groove “templates” to be applied to the selected section. The “PUSH” settings cause certain beats to
be played early, while “HEAVY” settings delay the timing of certain beats. The numbered settings (2, 3, 4, 5) determine
which beats are to be affected. All beats up to the specified beat —but not including the first beat — will be played early
or delayed (for example, the 2nd and 3rd beats, if “3” is selected). In all cases, “A” types produce minimum effect, “B”
types produce medium effect, and “C” types produce maximum effect.

118 CVP-210/208
Creating Accompaniment Styles — Style Creator

■ Dynamics

Use these to select the


desired edit operation.
Calls up the Style display
A F
and lets you store the
B G
edited accompaniment
style data.
C H

D I

E J

Executes the Dynamics operation. After the


operation is completed, this button changes
to [UNDO], letting you restore the original
data if you’re not satisfied with the
Dynamics results. The Undo function only
has one level; only the previous operation 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

can be undone.
Determines the settings for each of the
Select the desired channel to which
Dynamics parameters (see the list
Dynamics is to be applied.
below).

Dynamics parameters
Velocity is determined by
Accent Type Selects the type of accent.
how strongly you play the
Strength Determines how strongly the selected Accent Type (above) will be applied. The keyboard.
higher the value, the stronger the effect. The more strongly you play
the keyboard, the higher the
Expand/Compress Expands or compresses the range of velocity values, around a central velocity velocity value and, hence,
value “64.” Values higher than 100% expand the dynamic range, while values lower the louder the sound.
than 100% compress it.

Boost/Cut Boosts or cuts all velocity values in the selected section/channel. Values above
100% boost the overall velocity, while values below 100% reduce it.

CVP-210/208 119
Creating Accompaniment Styles — Style Creator

Editing the Channel Data


In this display, there are five different channel-related edit functions, including Quantize, for editing the recorded
accompaniment style data. The operations here apply to step 4 on page 114.

See the explanations below.

Preset channel BASS -


PHRASE2 can not be
edited.

■ Quantize
Refer to page 107.

■ Velocity Change
Boosts or cuts the velocity of all notes in the specified channel (selected with the [1▲▼]/[2▲▼] (CHANNEL)
buttons), according to the specified percentage (selected with the [4▲▼]/[5▲▼] (BOOST/CUT) buttons).

■ Bar Copy
This function allows data to be copied from one measure or group of measures to another location within the
specified channel. Use the [4▲▼] (TOP) and [5▲▼] (LAST) buttons to specify the first and last measures in the
region to be copied. Use the [6▲▼] (DEST) button to specify the first measure of the destination location, to which
the data is to be copied.

■ Bar Clear
This function clears all data from the specified range of measures within the selected channel. Use the [4▲▼] (TOP)
and [5▲▼] (LAST) buttons to specify the first and last measures in the region to be cleared.

■ Remove Event
This function lets you remove specific events from the selected channel. Use the [4▲▼] - [6▲▼] (EVENT) buttons
to select the desired event type to be removed.

120 CVP-210/208
Creating Accompaniment Styles — Style Creator

Making Style File Format Settings — Parameter


This display provides a variety of style controls— such as determining how the pitch and sound of the recorded style
change when playing the chords in the left-hand range of the keyboard. For details about the relationship between the
parameters, refer to “Style File Format” on page 114. The operations here are the same as described in step 4 on page 114.

When NTR is set to “Root


Fixed” and NTT is set to
See the explanations below. “Bypass,” the “Source
Root” and “Source Chord”
parameters are changed to
“Play Root” and “Play
Chord,” respectively. In this
case, you can change
chords and hear the result-
ing sound for all channels.

■ Source Root/Chord
These settings determine the original key of the source pattern (i.e., the key used when recording the pattern). The default
setting of CM7 (with a Source Root of “C” and a Source Type of “M7”), is automatically selected whenever the preset data
is deleted prior to recording a new style, regardless of the Source Root and Chord included in the preset data. When you
change Source Root / Chord from the default CM7 to another chord, the chord notes and recommended notes will also
change, depending on the newly selected chord type. For details on chord notes and recommended notes, see page 116.
When the Source Root is C:
CMaj C6 CM7 CM711 C9 CM79 C69

C R C C R C R C C C R C R C C R C C R C C R C C C C C R C C C C R C C C C C C R

Caug Cm Cm6 Cm7 Cm75 Cm9 Cm79

R C R C C C C R C C R C C C C

C R C C R R C C R R C C C R C C R C C R C C C R C

Cm711 CmM7 CmM79 Cdim Cdim7 C7 C7sus4

C C C C C C R C C R C C

C R C C C R R C C C C R C C C R C R R C R C C C C C C

C7 5 C79 C711 C713 C79 C713 C79

C C C C C C C C R C C C R C

C R C C C C C C R C C R C R C C C C C C C C R C C C C

CM7aug C7aug C1+8 C1+5 Csus4 Csus2


C = chord note
C R C C C, R = recommended
C R C R R C C R C C C C C C R C C C C R C R note

■ NTR (Note Transposition Rule) and NTT (Note Transposition Table)


• NTR (Note Transposition Rule)
This determines the system for pitch conversion of the source pattern. Two settings are available.
Root Trans (Root Transpose)
When the root note is transposed, the pitch relationship between notes is maintained. For example, the notes C3,
E3 and G3 in the key of C become F3, A3 and C4 when they are transposed to F. Use this setting for channels that
contain melody lines.

Root Fixed
The note is kept as close as possible to the previous note range. For example, the notes C3, E3 and G3 in the key
of C become C3, F3 and A3 when they are transposed to F. Use this setting for channels that contain chord parts.

CVP-210/208 121
Creating Accompaniment Styles — Style Creator

• NTT (Note Transposition Table)


This sets the note transposition table for the source pattern. Six transposition types are available.
Bypass
No transposition.
Melody
Suitable for melody line transposition. Use this for melody channels such as Phrase 1 and Phrase 2.
Chord
Suitable for chord transposition. Use for the Chord 1 and Chord 2 channels, especially when they contain piano
or guitar-like chordal parts.
Bass
Suitable for bass line transposition. This table is basically similar to the Melody table above, but recognizes on-
bass chords allowed in the FINGERED ON BASS fingering mode. Use this primarily for bass lines.
Melodic Minor
When the played chord changes from a major to a minor chord, this table lowers the third interval in the scale by
a semitone. When the chord changes from a minor to a major chord, the minor third interval is raised by a
semitone. Other notes are not changed.
Harmonic Minor
When the played chord changes from a major to a minor chord, this table lowers the third and sixth intervals in
the scale by a semitone. When the chord changes from a minor to a major chord, the minor third and flatted sixth
intervals are raised by a semitone. Other notes are not changed.

■ High Key/Note Limit


• High Key
This sets the highest key (upper octave limit) Example — When the highest key is F
of the note transposition for the chord root Root changes  
CM CM FM FM
change. Any notes calculated to be higher Notes played C3-E3-G3
 
C 3-F3-G 3 F3-A3-C4
  
F 2-A 2-C 3
than the highest key are transposed down to
the octave just below the highest key. This
setting is effective only when the NTR
parameter (page 121) is set to “Root Trans.”
• Note Limit
This sets the note range (highest and lowest Example — When the lowest note is C3 and the highest is D4
notes) for voices recorded to the style 
Root changes CM CM FM
channels. By judicious setting of this range, 3-C4
Notes played E3-G3-C4 F3-G F3-A3-C4
you can ensure that the voices sound as
realistic as possible — in other words, that no High Limit

notes outside the natural range are sounded Low Limit


(e.g., high bass sounds or low piccolo
sound). The actual notes that sound are
automatically shifted to the set range.

■ RTR (Retrigger Rule)


These settings determine whether notes stop sounding or not and how they change pitch in response to chord
changes.
Stop
The notes stop sounding.
Pitch Shift
The pitch of the note will bend without a new attack to match the type of the new chord.
Pitch Shift to Root
The pitch of the note will bend without a new attack to match the root of the new chord.
Retrigger
The note is retriggered with a new attack at a new pitch corresponding to the next chord.
Retrigger To Root
The note is retriggered with a new attack at the root note of the next chord. However, the octave of the new note
remains the same.

122 CVP-210/208
Adjust the Volume Balance and Changing Voices
— Mixing Console
Set up just like a real mixing console, this display gives you comprehensive control over
the sound. Mixing Console
POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT
This set of controls lets you
adjust the balance of the
START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1

voices and their stereo posi-


STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

MIN MAX
TEMPO TRANSPOSE
DIGITAL
STUDIO
C

D
H

I
LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING tion, as well as the amount
1 2 3 4

of effect that is applied to


TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN

OTS LINK
BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP
MIXING
CONSOLE

PART
BALANCE

CHANNEL
ON OFF
ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY

each voice.
PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

MIXING
CONSOLE

PART

You can call up additional basic mixing controls by using the [BALANCE] button and the [CHANNEL ON/OFF] button
(page 65).

Operation

1 MIXING
CONSOLE

PART
From the MIXING CONSOLE display, press the button
repeatedly until the desired display is called up. Each press of the
You can quickly and easily
set all parts to the same
value for the same parame-
button switches among the displays listed below. ter (except for the VOICE
parameter). Simulta-
PANEL PART neously hold down the [A] -
Includes the keyboard-played parts (Main/ [J] button that corresponds
Layer, Left), accompaniment parts, song, to the parameter you want
to change and use the [1] -
microphone input.
[8] buttons or the [DATA
STYLE PART ENTRY] dial to change the
Accompaniment parts value.
SONG CH 1 - 8
n
Channels 1 - 8 of song playback For details on parameters
SONG CH 9 -16 related to the Sound Cre-
Channels 9 - 16 of song playback ator, see page 92.

2 Select the other Mixing Console pages by using the [BACK]/


[NEXT] buttons and set the desired parameters. END
Close the Mixing
Console display by
For information on the various parameters and settings and how pressing the [EXIT]
to use them, refer to the explanations starting on page 124. button.

■ About the parameters


• VOL/VOICE (Volume/Voice) (page 124)
This contains settings related to the volume and voice of each part/channel. Here you can also enable the Auto
Revoice feature — which automatically plays XG-compatible songs (page 163) with the rich and dynamic voices
that are exclusive to the CVP-210/208. This gives you much more authentic and realistic instrument sounds for your
song playback.
• FILTER (page 125)
These controls affect the tone quality of the voice, letting you add power, punch, or brightness to the sound.
• TUNE (page 125)
These give you various tuning controls.
• EFFECT (page 126)
These control the amount of effect applied to the sound.
• EQ (page 128)
Determines the overall tone quality of the instrument, letting you adjust the sound to match the particular
performance space. Also you can adjust the volume or tone quality for each part.

CVP-210/208 123
Adjust the Volume Balance and Changing Voices — Mixing Console

Setting the Level Balance and Voice — Volume/Voice


The operations for this page apply to step 2 of the procedure on page 123.

1 Use these to select the VOICE,


PANPOT, or VOLUME
parameter rows.
Set this to ON to enable automatic replacement of
the XG voices (in XG song data) with the special
The [RHY1] channel in the
STYLE PART display can be
voices of the CVP-210/208. To use the normal XG assigned to any voice except
voice set, turn this off. for the Organ Flute voice.

Each press of n
this button When playing GM song data,
switches channel 10 (in the SONG
among the A F
CH 9 - 16 page) can only be
various parts/ B G used for a Drum Kit voice.
channels.
C H

DIGITAL
STUDIO
D I
SOUND
CREATOR
E J When changing the rhythm/
DIGITAL
RECORDING percussion voices (drum
MIXING BALANCE
kits, etc.) of the accompani-
CONSOLE
ment style and song from
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF
Allows you to the VOICE parameter, the
PART
select the specific detailed settings related to
voice to be the drum voice are reset,
replaced. and in some cases you may
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 be unable to restore the
original sound. In the case
These let you select the voice of each part, and adjust the panpot and volume. of song playback, you can
VOICE restore the original sound
Calls up the VOICE display, from which you can select the desired voice (page 58). When the by returning to the begin-
Style part is selected, neither Organ Flutes voices nor User voices can be selected. When the ning of the song and playing
Song part is selected, User voices cannot be selected. back from that point. In the
PANPOT case of accompaniment
Determines the stereo position of the selected voice or track. A setting of 0 pans the sound style play, you can restore
hard left, while 64 is at center, and 127 is at hard right. the original sound by select-
VOLUME ing the same style again.
Determines the level of each channel, giving you fine control over the balance of all the parts.

ALL REVOICE
2 Replaces all of the replaceable XG voices with the
rich and authentic voices of the CVP-210/208.

PIANO, BASIC and DRUM


PIANO REVOICE can be called up simulta-
Replaces only the piano neously.
F
voices.
G
DRUM REVOICE
H
Replaces only the drum
revoices.
I Keep in mind that using the
BASIC REVOICE Revoice function may result
J
Replaces only the in unnatural or unexpected
recommended voices that are sound, depending on the
suitable for playing back the particular song data.
song.

ALL NO REVOICE
All the voices are returned
to the original XG voices.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Executes the settings and closes the


Selects the XG voices Auto Revoice Setup display.
to be replaced (voices
usually used when
Selects the voices used to Closes the Auto Revoice
playing back).
replace the XG voices (when Setup screen without
SONG AUTO REVOICE is executing the settings.
set to ON).

124 CVP-210/208
Adjust the Volume Balance and Changing Voices — Mixing Console

Changing the Tone of the Voice — Filter


The operations for this page apply to step 2 of the procedure on page 123.
For details about the Filter,
Switches between the HARMONIC and BRIGHTNESS parameters.
see page 94.

n
When a Natural voice is
A F
selected, Harmonic and
Brightness cannot be
B G changed.

DIGITAL
C H
n
STUDIO
D I Be careful with these con-
SOUND
CREATOR trols. Depending on the
E J
DIGITAL selected voice, extreme set-
RECORDING
tings may result in noise or
MIXING
CONSOLE
BALANCE distortion.
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

Each press of this


button switches among 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
HARMONIC ........ Allows you to adjust the resonance effect
the various parts/ (see “Harmonic Content” on page 94).
channels. BRIGHTNESS .... Determines the brightness of the sound by
adjusting the cutoff frequency (page 94).

Changing Pitch-related Settings — Tune


The operations for this page apply to step 2 of the procedure on page 123.
Switches among the available parameters: PORTAMENTO Portamento is used to cre-
TIME, PITCH BEND RANGE, OCTAVE, and TUNING. ate a smooth transition in
pitch from one note to the
next.

A F

When a Natural voice is


B G
selected, Portamento Time
C H
cannot be changed.

D I

E J

Refer to the explanation below.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

These increase/decrease (transpose) the pitch in semitone units.


MASTER ... Transposes both the pitch of the keyboard and that of the song playback.
SONG........ Transposes the pitch of the song playback.
KBD .......... Transposes the pitch of the keyboard.

PORTAMENTO TIME ............When the part is set to Mono (page 62, 93), this determines the Portamento time. The
higher the value, the longer the time it takes for the pitch to change. Portamento is only
applied when you play legato (playing the next note before releasing the previous one).
PITCH BEND RANGE ...........When the Pitch Bend or Glide effect is assigned to the pedal, this determines the range of
the pitch change in semitones.
OCTAVE................................Determines the range of the pitch change in octaves, over two octaves up or down.
TUNING...............................Determines the pitch of the instrument.

CVP-210/208 125
Adjust the Volume Balance and Changing Voices — Mixing Console

Adjusting the Effects


The operations for this page apply to step 2 of the procedure on page 123.
There are three effect sec-
tions: Reverb, Chorus, and
1 Indicates the type name for each effect block. When a
Natural voice is selected, the effect block names are
indicated above the relevant knobs in the display.
Indicates the type name for
each part. When a Natural
DSP (which contains a vari-
ety of effect types). These
voice is selected, the effect
are available independently
block names are indicated.
for the Natural voices and
Regular voices. For details,
refer to the Effect Block list
A F
(page 127).
B G

C H
Press this to
DIGITAL
STUDIO
D I
edit and store
SOUND
CREATOR
the effect
DIGITAL
E J
(page 126,
RECORDING
127).
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

Each press of this Switches among the


button switches effect sections: REVERB,
among the various 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 CHORUS, and DSP.
parts/channels.
Determines the amount of effect that is applied to each part. For more information
about the characteristics of each effect, see the Effect Block list on page 127.

When the BLOCK parameter is set to REVERB1, CHORUS1, or DSP 3-7 (CVP-210)/
2 DSP 3-5 (CVP-208), press this to call up the display from which you can change the
detailed settings for the effects.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

These determine the effect block and let you assign the effect.
BLOCK ........... Determines the effect block (group of similar or related effects).
PART ............... Determines the part to which the Insertion effect is applied. It is effective only
when BLOCK is set to “DSP1,” PARAMETER is set to “CONNECTION,” and
VALUE is set to “Insertion” — or when BLOCK is set to “DSP 3-7” (CVP-210) or
“DSP 3-5” (CVP-208).
CATEGORY .... The various effect programs (in Type below) are grouped into categories. This
parameter may not be available depending on the selected block.
TYPE ............... Determines the type of effect that is assigned to the selected effect block. The
actual effect types that are available may differ depending on the selected block.

126 CVP-210/208
Adjust the Volume Balance and Changing Voices — Mixing Console

3 Calls up the display


This parameter cannot be
set when BLOCK is set to
A F “REVERB2,” “CHORUS2,”
for storing the effect. or “DSP2” (or “BRIL-
B G
LIANCE.”
C H

D I

E J

Switches between Determines the level of the effect


the upper/lower (return level). This is not available
parameters. For the when BLOCK is set to “DSP1,”
lower parameter, PARAMETER is set to
the depth can be “CONNECTION,” and VALUE is
changed when the set to “Insertion” or when BLOCK
[VARIATION] 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
is set to “DSP 3-7” (CVP-210) /
button is on. “DSP 3-5” (CVP-208).

Determines the value of the selected


Determines the effect block. parameter.
Determines the effect category.
Determines the effect parameter to be adjusted.
Determines the effect type.

4 Calls up the display


Keep in mind that in some
cases noise may result if
for naming the User you adjust the effect param-
F

Effect (page 49). eters while playing the


G
instrument.

Stores the effect settings you


made above to a User Effect
location (SYSTEM) for future
recall. To call up the effect, select
USER from the CATEGORY
parameter and select the desired
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
effect from the TYPE parameter.

Select the destination to which the effect is to be stored.


The number of memory spaces available for the destination
differs for each block (refer to the chart below).

Effect Block
Block Parts Characteristics Number of User Effect
REVERB 1 (for Regular Voices) All parts Reproduces the warm ambience of playing in a 3
REVERB 2 (for Natural Voices) All parts except microphone (MIC) concert hall or jazz club. —
CHORUS 1 (for Regular Voices) All parts Produces a rich “fat” sound as if several parts 3
CHORUS 2 (for Natural Voices) All parts except microphone (MIC) are being played simultaneously. —
DSP 1 (for Regular Voices) Song (Ch. 1 - 16), Style In addition to reverb and chorus effects, this 3
section features a variety of special effects,
DSP 2 (for Natural Voices) All parts except microphone (MIC) —
including distortion. When “MIC” is selected
(CVP-208 only), you can apply various effects
DSP 3-6 (DSP6; CVP-210 only) Main, Layer, Left, Song (Ch. 1-16), to your own voice, via the connected 10
(for Regular Voices) MIC (CVP-208 only) microphone.
This lets you apply various effects to your own
DSP 7 (CVP-210 only) MIC 10
voice, via the connected microphone.

CVP-210/208 127
Adjust the Volume Balance and Changing Voices — Mixing Console

Adjusting the Sound to Match the Performance


Environment — EQ
Usually an equalizer is used to correct the sound output from amps or speakers to match the special character of the
room. The sound is divided into several frequency bands, allowing you to correct the sound by raising or lowering the
level for each band. The equalizer allows you to adjust the tone or timbre of the sound to match the performance space,
or to compensate for certain acoustic characteristics in your room. For example, you can cut some of the low range
frequencies when playing on stages or in large studio spaces where the sound is too “boomy,” or boost the high
frequencies in rooms and close spaces where the sound is relatively “dead” and free of echoes. The CVP-210/208
possesses a high grade five-band digital equalizer function. With this function, a final effect—tone control—can be
added to the output of your instrument.
The explanations here apply to step 2 of the procedure on page 123.

Selects a Master EQ type. Select this to call up the


MASTER EQ display. Use the
[1▲▼] - [8▲▼] buttons to adjust
A F
the EQ High parameters (amount
Use the [1▲▼] - [8▲▼] B G of gain of the high frequency) for
buttons to adjust the EQ each part.
Low parameters (amount C H

of gain of the low DIGITAL


STUDIO
frequency) for each part.
D I
Use the [1▲▼] - [8▲▼] buttons
SOUND
CREATOR
E J
to adjust the EQ High parameters
DIGITAL
RECORDING
(amount of gain of the low
frequency) for each part.
MIXING
CONSOLE
Each press of this button
PART
switches among the
various parts/channels.

This lets you store your edited


PRESET or USER curve to
A F
USER 1 or USER 2.
Select a MASTER EQ type.
B G

C H

D I

E J

Q
GAIN
Adjusts the overall gain of all
EQ bands simultaneously.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

FREQ

Whenever an EQ band is edited, the corresponding EQ value The PRESET and USER curves can be
is highlighted and the number of the edited band appears edited as required via the corresponding
above the Q and FREQ controls. The Q and FREQ controls buttons. Each of the five bands can be
can then be used to adjust the Q (bandwidth) and the FREQ boosted or cut by up to 12 dB.
(center frequency) of the selected band. The higher the “Q”,
the narrower the bandwidth. The available FREQ range is
different for each band.

128 CVP-210/208
Adjust the Volume Balance and Changing Voices — Mixing Console

Effect Structure
The CVP-210/208 features the following digital effect systems, which can be applied independently for the Natural
voices (page 92) and the Regular voices (page 92). The effect type, depth, and various parameters can be set with the
panel controls.
About the Effect Connections — System and Insertion
All the effect blocks are connected or routed in one of two ways: System or Insertion. System applies the selected effect
to all parts, while Insertion applies the selected effect to one specific part. Reverb, Chorus and DSP 2 are System effects,
and DSP 3 - 7 (CVP-210)/DSP 3 - 5 (CVP-208) are Insertion effects. The DSP 1 effect, on the other hand, can be
configured for either System or Insertion routing.

The illustration below shows how the various effect blocks are set up and traces the signal flow for the send/return
controls set on the CVP-210/208.

For Regular Voices (CVP-210)

Unused DSP blocks are automatically DRY LINE


assigned to the active parts.
REVERB1
Dry

MAIN VOICE DSP3 Rev Send

Cho Send

Dry

LAYER VOICE DSP4 Rev Send

Cho Send

Dry CHORUS1 Master EQ OUT


LEFT VOICE DSP5 Rev Send

Cho Send

Dry
SONG
(each channel) DSP6 Rev Send

Cho Send

MIC. Effect
Dry

MIC 3 Band Noise Vocal Rev Send


Compressor DSP7
EQ Gate Harmony
Cho Send

Dry
STYLE
DSP1 Rev Send
(each channel) When DSP is set as a System effect,
Cho Send
When DSP is set as an Insertion effect it is put here in the signal flow.
(here PART is set to one of the DSP Send
STYLE channels), it is put here DSP1
in the signal flow.

CVP-210/208 129
Adjust the Volume Balance and Changing Voices — Mixing Console

For Regular Voices (CVP-208)


DRY LINE
Unused DSP blocks are automatically
assigned to the active parts.
REVERB 1
Dry

MAIN VOICE DSP3 Rev Send

Cho Send

DSP Send

Dry

LAYER VOICE DSP4 Rev Send

Cho Send

Dry CHORUS 1 Master EQ OUT


LEFT VOICE DSP5 Rev Send

Cho Send

Dry
MIC Vocal
MIC Effect Harmony Rev Send

Cho Send

DSP Send

Dry
SONG
Rev Send
(each channel)
Cho Send

DSP Send

Dry
STYLE DSP1 Rev Send
(each channel) When DSP is set as a System effect,
When DSP is set Cho Send it is put here in the signal flow.
as an Insertion effect DSP Send
(here PART is set to one DSP1
of the STYLE channels)
it is put here in the signal flow.

DRY LINE
For Natural Voices
REVERB 2
Dry

MAIN VOICE Rev Send

Cho Send

DSP Send

Dry

LAYER VOICE Rev Send

Cho Send

DSP Send

CHORUS 2 BRILLIANCE OUT


Dry

LEFT VOICE Rev Send

Cho Send

DSP Send

Dry

MIC Rev Send

Cho Send

DSP Send

Dry
STYLE/SONG Rev Send
(each channel)
Cho Send

DSP Send
DSP2

130 CVP-210/208
Using a Microphone — MIC.
This extraordinarily powerful feature uses advanced voice-processing technology to automatically produce vocal
harmony based on a single lead vocal. Four distinct harmony modes as well as an extensive selection of preset harmony
types are provided. In addition to straightforward harmony, the CVP-210/208 also lets you change the apparent gender
of the harmony and/or lead vocal sound. For example, if you are a male singer, you can have the CVP-210/208
automatically generate a two-part female backup. A comprehensive set of parameters gives you exceptionally precise
and flexible control over the vocal harmony sound.

For details about connecting


MIC.
VOCAL HARMONY
SIGNAL OVER
TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING
a microphone, see
page 155.

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START ⁄ STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ⁄ ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON ⁄ OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START ⁄ STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN ⁄ OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING
DIGITAL
MIN MAX STUDIO
TEMPO TRANSPOSE D I
1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING ⁄ rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START ⁄ STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON ⁄ OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

Use the SIGNAL and OVER indicators to determine the appropriate setting (page 155).

MIC. SIGNAL OVER


VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING
This calls up the MICROPHONE
SETTING display (page 133) and
lets you adjust the level of the
If you connect a microphone to the CVP-210/ microphone and vocal harmony
208, you can sing along with the song or auto effect.
accompaniment and have vocal harmony This calls up the VOCAL HARMONY TYPE display (see
parts added automatically. below) and lets you set the desired harmony type.

Determines the on/off setting of the effect applied to the


This convenient function lets you temporarily cancel the microphone, set in the MIXING CONSOLE display (page 126).
vocal harmony or other microphone effects when using a
connected microphone. This is especially useful when
you talk between songs during a performance.

Selecting a Vocal Harmony Type

1 Press the [VH


TYPE SELECT] 2 Select a Vocal
Harmony type.

button. A F

B G

C H

D I

E J

This lets you adjust


the amount of
harmony effect that is
applied.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

CVP-210/208 131
Using a Microphone — MIC.

3
A F

B G

C H

D I Save the changed data


(page 39, 48).
E J

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Select a Vocal Harmony type. Return to the VOCAL HARMONY TYPE


display.
Select a Vocal Harmony parameter (see below).
Adjust the parameter value.

The saved settings can be


Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous named (page 45) or deleted
END display. (page 47) in the USER
page.

Vocal Harmony Parameter List

Chordal Type/Vocoder Type Determines how the harmony notes are applied.
Harmony Gender Type Can be set to “Off” or “Auto”. When “Auto”, the gender of the harmony sound is changed automatically.
Lead Gender Type Determines whether and how the gender of the lead vocal sound (i.e., the direct microphone sound) will be
changed. When “Off” no gender change occurs. When “Unison”, “Male” or “Female” is selected the
corresponding gender change is applied to the lead vocal. (In this case the number of harmony notes which
can be produced in addition to the lead vocal is reduced to one.)
Lead Gender Depth Adjusts the degree of lead vocal gender change produced when one of the Lead Gender Types (above) is
selected.
Lead Pitch Correction When “Correct” is selected the pitch of the lead vocal is shifted in precise semitone steps. This parameter is
only effective when one of the Lead Gender Types is selected.
Auto Upper Gender Threshold Gender change will occur when the harmony pitch reaches or exceeds the specified number of semitones
above the lead vocal pitch.
Auto Lower Gender Threshold Gender change will occur when the harmony pitch reaches or exceeds the specified number of semitones
below the lead vocal pitch.
Upper Gender Depth Adjusts the degree of gender change applied to harmony notes higher than the Auto Upper Gender
Threshold.
Lower Gender Depth Adjusts the degree of gender change applied to harmony notes lower than the Auto Lower Gender
Threshold.
Vibrato Depth Sets the depth of vibrato applied to the harmony sound. Also affects the lead vocal sound if a Lead Gender
Type is selected.
Vibrato Rate Sets the speed of the vibrato effect.
Vibrato Delay Specifies the length of the delay before the vibrato effect begins when a note is produced.
Harmony 1/2/3 Volume Sets the volume of the first, second, or third harmony note, respectively. Harmony notes 1 - 3 are assigned in
order of ascending pitch (1 is the lowest pitch, 3 is the highest).
Harmony 1/2/3 Pan Specifies the stereo (pan) position of the first, second, or third harmony note, respectively. Harmony notes 1 - 3
are assigned in order of ascending pitch (1 is the lowest pitch, 3 is the highest). When “Random” is selected the
stereo position of the sound will change randomly whenever the keyboard is played.
Harmony 1/2/3 Detune Detunes the first, second, or third harmony note respectively by the specified number of cents. Harmony
notes 1 - 3 are assigned in order of ascending pitch (1 is the lowest pitch, 3 is the highest).
Pitch to Note When “ON” the lead vocal sound “plays” the CVP-210/208 tone generator system. (However, dynamic
changes in the vocal sound do not affect the volume of the tone generator.)
Pitch to Note Part Determines which of the CVP-210/208 parts will be controlled by the lead vocal when the Pitch to Note
parameter is “ON”.

132 CVP-210/208
Using a Microphone — MIC.

Making Settings for the Vocal Harmony and Microphone


— MICROPHONE SETTING
Operation

1 Press the [MIC.


SETTING] 2 Select the MICROPHONE SETTING page by using the [BACK]/[NEXT]
button and set the parameters.
button. For information on the various parameters and settings and how to use
them, refer to the explanations below.
BACK NEXT

END
A F

B G

Press the [EXIT] C H

button to return to the D I

previous display. E J

Adjusting the Vocal Harmony Settings and Microphone Effects —


OVERALL SETTING
The explanations here apply to step 2 above.

Select the 3BAND EQ.


A F

B G
Select the NOISE GATE/COMPRESSOR.
C H

D I

E J Select the VOCAL HARMONY CONTROL/MIC.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Use these to change the value for each function or setting. For details, see below.

■ 3BAND EQ (3-BAND EQUALIZER)


Usually an equalizer is used to correct the sound output from amps or speakers to match the special character of the
room. The sound is divided into several frequency bands, allowing you to correct the sound by raising or lowering
the level for each band. The CVP-210/208 features a high grade three-band digital equalizer function for the
microphone sound.
Hz .............. Adjusts the center frequency of the corresponding band.
dB ............... Boosts or cuts the level of the corresponding band by up to 12 dB.

■ NOISE GATE
This effect mutes the input signal when the input from the microphone falls below a specified level. This effectively
cuts off extraneous noise, allowing the desired signal (vocal, etc.) to pass.
SW.............. “SW” is the abbreviation of Switch. This turns Noise Gate on or off.
TH. ............. “TH.” is the abbreviation of Threshold. This adjusts the input level at which the gate begins to open.

CVP-210/208 133
Using a Microphone — MIC.

■ COMPRESSOR
This effect holds down the output when the input signal from the microphone exceeds a specified level. This is
useful when recording a signal with widely varying dynamics. It effectively “compresses” the signal, making soft
parts louder and loud parts softer.
SW.............. “SW” is the abbreviation of Switch. This turns Compressor on or off.
TH. ............. “TH.” is the abbreviation of Threshold. This adjusts the input level at which compression begins to be
applied.
RATIO ........ This adjusts the compression ratio.
OUT ........... Adjusts the final output level.

■ VOCAL HARMONY CONTROL


The following parameters determine how the harmony is controlled.
VOCODER CONTROL
The Vocal Harmony effect is controlled by note data — the notes you play on the keyboard and/or the notes of the
song data. This parameter lets you determine which notes are used to control the harmony.
• SONG CHANNEL
MUTE/PLAY:
When set to “MUTE,” the channel selected below is muted (turned off) during keyboard performance or song
playback.
OFF:
Song data control over harmony is turned off.
1-16:
When playing back a song from disk or external MIDI sequencer, the note data recorded to the assigned song
channel controls the harmony.
• KEYBOARD
OFF: Keyboard control over harmony is turned off.
UPPER: Notes played to the right of the split point control the harmony.
LOWER: Notes played to the left of the split point control the harmony.
BALANCE
This lets you set the balance between the lead vocal (your own voice) and Vocal Harmony. Raising this value
increases the volume of the Vocal Harmony and decreases that of the lead vocal. When this is set to L<H63 (L: Lead
Vocal, H: Vocal Harmony), only the Vocal Harmony is output; when it is set to L63>H, only the lead vocal is output.
MODE
All of the Vocal Harmony types fall into one of three modes which produce harmony in different ways. The harmony
effect is dependent on the selected Vocal Harmony Mode and Track, and this parameter determines how the
harmony is applied to your voice. The three modes are described below.
VOCODER:
The harmony notes are determined by the notes you play on the keyboard (Main, Layer and Left) and/ or song
data which includes Vocal Harmony tracks.
CHORDAL:
During accompaniment playback, chords played in the auto accompaniment section of the keyboard control the
harmony. During song playback, chords contained in song data control the harmony. (Not available if the song
does not contain any chord data.)
AUTO:
When the auto accompaniment or Left part is set to ON and if chord data exists in the song, the mode is
automatically set to CHORDAL. In all other cases, the mode is set to VOCODER.
CHORD
The following parameters specify the song data which will be used for chord detection.
OFF: Chords are not detected.
XF: Chords of XF format are detected.
1-16: Chords are detected from note data in the specified song channel.

■ MIC (MICROPHONE)
The following parameters determine how the microphone sound is controlled.
MUTE .............. When set to OFF, the microphone sound is turned off.
VOLUME ......... Adjusts the volume of the microphone sound.

134 CVP-210/208
Using a Microphone — MIC.

Setting the Microphone Volume and Related Effects — TALK


SETTING
Determines the settings when the [TALK] button is on.
The explanations here apply to step 2 on page 133.

VOLUME/PAN/REVERB DEPTH/CHORUS DEPTH/TOTAL VOLUME ATTENUATOR

A F

B G

C H

D I

E J

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

This determines the volume of This determines the amount of attenuation to


the microphone sound. be applied to the overall sound (excepting the
microphone input) — allowing you to effectively
This sets the stereo pan position adjust the balance between your voice and the
of the microphone sound. overall instrument sound.

These set the depth of the reverb and chorus effects


applied to the microphone sound.

DSP/TYPE/DEPTH

A F

B G

C H

D I

E J

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

This sets the depth of the DSP effect


applied to the microphone sound.

This turns the DSP effect applied to the This selects the type of DSP effect to be applied
microphone sound ON or OFF. to the microphone sound.

CVP-210/208 135
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function
The Function mode gives you access to various advanced functions related to the instrument as a whole. These
sophisticated functions let you customize the Clavinova to your own musical needs and preferences.

POWER METRONOME MIC. SIGNAL OVER VOICE EFFECT


START STOP VOCAL HARMONY TALK EFFECT VH TYPE SELECT MIC. SETTING REVERB DSP VARIATION HARMONY ECHO MONO LEFT HOLD
BACK NEXT

MENU
SONG
ON OFF DEMO VOICE
EXTRA TRACKS TRACK 2 TRACK 1
STYLE L R PIANO & HARPSI. E. PIANO ORGAN & ACCORDION PERCUSSION GUITAR BASS ORGAN FLUTES
A F VOICE PART
MASTER VOLUME ON OFF
TAP TEMPO HELP
BRASS WOODWIND STRINGS CHOIR & PAD SYNTH. XG USER
REC TOP START STOP REW FF REPEAT GUIDE B G LAYER
FADE IN OUT
FUNCTION

C H LEFT

MIN MAX
TEMPO TRANSPOSE
DIGITAL
STUDIO
MENU D I
ENTER MUSIC FINDER ONE TOCTH SETTING

1 2 3 4
TAP TEMPO SOUND
CREATOR
E J
RESET RESET DIGITAL
STYLE RECORDING
PIANO
DATA
ACMP AUTO FILL IN BREAK INTRO MAIN ENDING rit. SYNC.STOP SYNC.START START STOP ENTRY FREEZE 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MEMORY
MIXING BALANCE
CONSOLE

OTS LINK
PART
CHANNEL
ON OFF

PART

DIRECT ACCESS 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 EXIT

FUNCTION

Operation

1 2
MENU
Select the desired function.
DEMO

HELP

FUNCTION

A F

B G

C H

D I

3 Set the parameters of the selected


function.
E J

The operations for each function are


covered in the following explanations.

To return to the previous


END display, press the [EXIT]
button.

Adjusting the Pitch and Tuning — Master Tune and Scale Tune
■ Master Tune (page 138)
This allows you to make fine adjustments to the overall pitch of the instrument — letting you accurately match the
tuning with that of other instruments.

■ Scale Tune (page 138)


This determines the particular tuning system (or temperament) for the instrument. This is especially useful for playing
period pieces, to match the tuning system used during specific musical eras.

Setting Song-related Parameters — Song Settings (page 140)


These allow you to set parameters related to song playback as well as the practice function types.

Setting Auto Accompaniment-related Parameters — Style Setting, Split Point, and Chord
Fingering
■ Style Setting / Split Point (page 141)
These determine the auto accompaniment-related settings, and let you set the split point.

■ Chord Fingering (page 142)


This determines the method for playing/indicating chords when using the auto accompaniment features. You can
even check how to play the chord, since the individual notes are indicated in the display.

136 CVP-210/208
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Making Settings for the Pedals and Making MIDI Settings


Keyboard — Controller ■ System (page 148)
■ Pedal (page 142) These determine various system messages settings
These settings determine how the connected pedals (such as Clock, Start/Stop, System Exclusive), as well
(including foot controllers and footswitches) are used. as Local Control on/off.
They can be assigned to a variety of functions, letting
■ Transmit (page 149)
you control operations with your feet — such as
This determines how playback data is sent to
turning the accompaniment style on/off, or triggering
connected MIDI devices — i.e., which parts are
Fill In patterns.
assigned to which MIDI Transmit channels. This also
■ Keyboard / Panel (page 144) lets you specify the type of data to be transmitted over
These settings determine the touch sensitivity of the each channel.
keyboard (how touch affects volume), and let you
■ Receive (page 150)
independently transpose the keyboard, song data,
This determines how the parts of the CVP-210/208
and the entire instrument.
respond to data from connected MIDI devices — i.e.,
which parts are assigned to which MIDI Receive
channels. This also lets you specify the type of data to
Setting the Registration Sequence, Freeze, be received over each channel.
and Voice Set
■ Root (page 150)
■ Registration Sequence (page 145)
This determines the channel(s) recognized for the root
This determines the order in which the Registration
notes, for use with the auto accompaniment.
Memory presets (1 - 8) are called up — by using the
[BACK][NEXT] buttons or the pedal. ■ Chord Detect (page 150)
This determines the channel(s) recognized for the
■ Freeze (page 145)
chords, for use with the auto accompaniment.
This lets you specify the settings you want to be
maintained or left unchanged, even when changing
Registration Memory presets.
Other Settings — Utility
■ Config 1 (page 151)
■ Voice Set (page 146)
This page contains settings for Fade In/Out,
This lets you determine whether certain voice-related
Metronome, Parameter Lock, and the Tap sound.
settings (such as Effects, EQ, Harmony, etc.) are
automatically called up or not when you select a ■ Config 2 (page 152)
voice. From this page, you can adjust the display, make
speaker settings, and change the voice number
indication.
Setting Harmony and Echo (page 146)
■ Disk (page 153)
These let you set the type of Harmony or Echo effect From this page, you can format disks, and copy from
applied to the keyboard-played voices, as well as the disk to disk.
amount of effect.
■ Owner (page 154)
From this page, you can set the language of the
Showing the Clavinova Display on a TV — instrument, and input your own name — which is
Video Out (page 147) shown automatically every time the power is turned
on. Also, you can select a background picture for the
These settings determine the contents of the Video Out MAIN display.
signal when outputting the CVP-210/208’s display
contents to a TV monitor (connected to the VIDEO OUT ■ System Reset (page 154)
terminal). This function restores the CVP-210/208 to its original
factory settings. You can also specify which types of
settings are to be restored, as well as store your own
original settings for future recall.

CVP-210/208 137
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Fine Tuning the Pitch/Selecting a Scale — Master Tune/Scale Tune


The explanations here apply to step #3 of the procedure on page 136.

Tuning the Overall Pitch — Master Tune


Hz (Hertz)
This unit of measurement
refers to the frequency of a
sound, and represents the
number of times a sound
wave vibrates in a second.

n
The Tune function does not
affect the Drum Kit or SFX
Kit voices.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Determines the overall pitch of the CVP-210/


208, from 414.8 - 466.8 Hz. Press the 4 or 5
[▲▼] buttons simultaneously to instantly reset
the value to the factory setting of 440.0 Hz.

Selecting a Scale — Scale Tune

Cent
Select the desired scale template. A unit of pitch equal to 1/100
of a semitone (100 cents = 1
semitone).

n
A
You can register your origi-
B
nal scale tunings to a REG-
ISTRATION MEMORY
C
button. To do this, check-
D
mark “SCALE” in the REG-
ISTRATION MEMORY
E display (page 88).

Selects which parts should be affected


by the scale setting.
Select the part to be set by pressing 6 or
7 [▲▼] and set the function ON or OFF
by pressing 8 [▲▼].
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Parts that are set to OFF remain in Equal
Temperament.

Determines the fine tuning of the selected note in 1-


Determines the base note for each scale.
cent steps. Press the 4 or 5 [▲▼] buttons
When the base note is changed, the pitch
simultaneously to instantly reset the value to the
of the keyboard is transposed, yet
factory setting.
maintains the original pitch relationship
between the notes.
Determines the note to be tuned and the amount of tuning.
The tuning range is from “-64” through “0” to “+63.” Each increment
equals one cent (one “cent” is one hundredth of a semitone).

138 CVP-210/208
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Scale

■ Equal Temperament
The pitch range of each octave is divided equally into twelve parts, with each half-step evenly spaced in pitch. This
is the most commonly used tuning in music today.

■ Pure Major/Pure Minor


These tunings preserve the pure mathematical intervals of each scale, especially for triad chords (root, third, fifth).
You can hear this best in actual vocal harmonies — such as choirs and acapella singing.

■ Pythagorean
This scale was devised by the famous Greek philosopher and is created from a series of perfect fifths, which are
collapsed into a single octave. The 3rd in this tuning are slightly unstable, but the 4th and 5th are beautiful and
suitable for some leads.

■ Mean-Tone
This scale was created as an improvement on the Pythagorean scale, by making the major third interval more “in
tune.” It was especially popular from the 16th century to the 18th century. Handel, among others, used this scale.

■ Werckmeister/Kirnberger
This composite scale combines the Werckmeister and Kirnberger systems, which were themselves improvements on
the mean-tone and Pythagorean scales. The main feature of this scale is that each key has its own unique character.
The scale was used extensively during the time of Bach and Beethoven, and even now it is often used when
performing period music on the harpsichord.

■ Arabic
Use these tunings when playing Arabic music.

Pitch settings for each scale (in cents; example scale of C)


The values shown in this chart are actually rounded off to the nearest whole number for use on the instrument.
    
C C D E E F F G A A B B
Equal Temperament 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0
Pure Major 0.0 -29.7 3.9 15.6 -14.1 -2.3 -9.4 2.3 -27.3 -15.6 18.0 -11.7
Pure Minor 0.0 33.6 3.9 15.6 -14.1 -2.3 31.3 2.3 14.1 -15.6 18.0 -11.7
Pythagorean 0.0 14.1 3.9 -6.3 7.8 -2.3 11.7 2.3 15.6 6.3 -3.9 10.2
Mean-Tone 0.0 -24.2 -7.0 10.2 -14.1 3.1 -20.3 -3.1 -27.3 -10.2 7.0 -17.2
Werckmeister 0.0 -10.2 -7.8 -6.3 -10.2 -2.3 -11.7 -3.9 -7.8 -11.7 -3.9 -7.8
Kirnberger 0.0 -10.2 -7.0 -6.3 -14.1 -2.3 -10.2 -3.1 -7.8 -10.2 -3.9 -11.7
Arabic1 0.0 0 -50.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 -50.0 0.0 0.0
Arabic2 0.0 0 0.0 0.0 -50.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 0.0 -50.0

CVP-210/208 139
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Setting Song-related Parameters — Song Settings


The explanations here apply to step #3 of the procedure on page 136.
Quick Start
On some commercially avail-
Allows you to play back all songs able song data, certain set-
from the same folder continuously. tings related to the song
(such as voice selection, vol-
Turns Quick Start on/off (see note). ume, etc.) are recorded to
the first measure, before the
actual note data. When
Quick Start is set to “ON,”
the CVP-210/208 reads all
initial non-note data of the
A F

Determines the Guide song at the highest possible


method. B G speed, then automatically
slows down to the appropri-
Turns guide lamps ON or C H
ate tempo at the first note.
OFF. This allows you to start play-
D I

back as quickly as possible,


E J
with a minimum pause for
reading of data.
Determines the timing for the guide
lamps. n
Channel
JUST ........ The guide lamps light Refers to the MIDI channel
precisely at the moment (page 161). The channels
you should play. are assigned as follows:
NEXT ........ The guide lamps light just 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Song
before the moment you 1 - 16
should play. If you miss the Accompaniment Style
proper timing, the guide 9 - 16
Determines whether the Phrase
lamps flash.
Mark Repeat function for the song
is on or off. When this is on, you n
can repeatedly play back a The guide lamps light in
specified phrase (selection of response to song channel
measures) of the song. The assigned to Tracks 1 and 2,
Determines the MIDI channel assigned method for specifying a phrase as well as chord data (when
to the [TRACK2] button. mark is the same as that in the contained in the song). Nor-
SONG POSITION display mally, you can leave the
(page 80). AUTO SET CH function set
Determines the MIDI channel assigned to ON, and the song channel
to the [TRACK1] button. will automatically be set. If
Determines the language of the the results aren’t satisfac-
displayed lyrics. tory, you’ll need to match the
When this is set to “AUTO,” the Channel Setting “TRK1 CH”
Determines the harmony channel for language defaults to that of the
Vocoder (page 134). and “TRK2 CH” parameters
song data. When not set to to the appropriate right- and
“AUTO,” the language defaults to left-hand parts.
Japanese, when the internal
setting (page 154) is n
“JAPANESE”; for all other Phrase Mark
languages, this is set to This data specifies a certain
“INTERNATIONAL.” location in the song data.
When set to “ON,” this
automatically sets the proper
Track 1 and Track 2 channels for
use with the practice functions.
Normally, this should be set to
“ON.”

140 CVP-210/208
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Setting Auto Accompaniment-related Parameters —


Style Setting, Split Point, and Chord Fingering
The explanations here apply to step #3 of the procedure on page 136.

Setting Auto Accompaniment-related Parameters — Style Setting


and Split Point
These select the part to which the split point
setting is applied: accompaniment, left-hand About Section Set
range, or both. Press the desired key for the split When any of the Main A-D
F
point while holding down one of these buttons. sections is not included in
G The pressed key is included in the range for the the accompaniment style
Auto Accompaniment section of the keyboard data, the nearest section is
H
(ACMP) or the left-hand range (LEFT). automatically selected. For
I
A+L (ACMP + LEFT) example, when Main D is not
Allows you to simultaneously set the split contained in the selected
J
point for both the left-hand range and the accompaniment style, Main
Auto Accompaniment section of the C will be called up.
keyboard.
L (LEFT)
Allows you to set the split point for the left-hand range of the keyboard.
A (ACMP)
Allows you to set the split point for the Auto Accompaniment section of the
keyboard.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Determines the split points for the auto accompaniment (ACMP) and the left-
hand range (LEFT). The same value can be set for both or for each
independently, using buttons [F], [G], and [H] (see above). You can use these
buttons by themselves to set the split point value.
Determines the default section that is automatically called up when selecting
different accompaniment styles (when accompaniment is stopped).

Turns touch response for the accompaniment on/off. When this is set to “ON,”
the accompaniment volume changes in response to your playing strength (in
the Auto Accompaniment section of the keyboard).

The CVP-210/208 lets you automatically enable Sync Stop (page 69) simply by quickly
pressing/releasing keys in the Auto Accompaniment section of the keyboard. This
parameter lets you set the length of the key-hold time. Split point can be set in the
MAIN display.
This applies to the OTS Link function, in which One Touch Settings are automatically called up
with changes in the section. This determines the timing in which the One Touch Settings change
with the section. (The [OTS LINK] button must be on.) Stop Accompaniment
Real Time When auto accompaniment
One Touch Setting is immediately called up when you press a section button. is turned on and Synchro
Next Bar Start is off, you can play
One Touch Setting is called up at the next measure, after you press a section button. chords in the left-hand
(accompaniment) section of
You can determine whether the chord played in the chord section will sound or not in the Stop the keyboard with the style
Accompaniment condition. stopped, and still hear the
When this is set to “OFF,” you can use the Harmony effect (page 62) without having to playback a style. accompaniment chords.

About Split Point Split point (A) Split point (L)

Split point is the position on keyboard that separates the Auto


Accompaniment section (ACMP) and left-hand section (LEFT) from the
right-hand section (MAIN). The LEFT split point cannot be set lower than
the ACMP split point, and the ACMP split point cannot be set higher than Auto Left-hand Right-hand
section
section
the LEFT split point. Accompaniment
section Split point (A) + (L)

Auto Accompaniment section Right-hand


+ Left-hand section section

CVP-210/208 141
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Setting the Fingering Method — Chord Fingering


This determines how the notes you play on the keyboard indicate or play the chords of the accompaniment. To learn
how to play certain chords, use the convenient Chord Tutor function (see note below).

The chord indication in the


display applies to the Fin-
gered method, regardless if
Indicates the note that
another method is actually
belongs to a chord. Some
selected.
notes can be omitted. The
chord name is indicated
next to “CHORD NAME.”

...Required Chord Tutor


...Can be omitted The Chord Tutor feature is
...Either note can be essentially an electronic
omitted “chord book” that shows you
...Can be omitted when appropriate fingerings for
the note indicated by chords; it is useful when you
is omitted want to play certain chords.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Simply specify the desired
chord via the [6▲▼] - [8▲▼]
Determines the fingering This lets you change the buttons, and the fingerings
type (page 66). chord type. for the Fingered method are
indicated in the display.

Indicates the note that belongs to a This lets you change the root
chord in the music. note from the chord.

Making Settings for the Pedals and Keyboard — Controller


The explanations here apply to step #3 of the procedure on page 136.

Making Settings for the Pedals

A F

Determines the particular


pedal to which a function is B G

to be assigned. C H

D I
Pedal on/off operation may
E J
differ depending on the
particular pedal you’ve
connected to the [AUX
PEDAL] jack. For example,
pressing down on one pedal
may turn the selected
function on, while pressing
a different make/brand of
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
pedal may turn the function
off. If necessary, use this
setting to reverse the
Determines the function to be If necessary, you can turn operation.
assigned to the selected pedal. Any the corresponding part ON/
one of the available functions can be OFF or set the control depth
assigned to each pedal. (see the next page).
For information on the assignable
functions, see “Pedal-controllable
Functions” on page 143.

142 CVP-210/208
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Pedal-controllable Functions
VOLUME* Allows you to use a foot controller (AUX pedal only) to control the volume.
SUSTAIN When the pedal is pressed notes played have a long sustain. Releasing the pedal immediately stops (damps) any sustained notes.
SOSTENUTO If you press and hold the pedal here, only the first note will be sustained (the note that you played and held when pressing the
pedal). This makes it possible to sustain a chord, for example, while other notes are played staccato.
SOFT Pressing the pedal subtly reduces the volume and slightly changes the timbre of notes played. It only applies to certain voices
— PIANO, for example.
GLIDE When the pedal is pressed the pitch changes, and then back to normal pitch when the pedal is released.
PORTAMENTO The portamento effect (a smooth slide between notes) can be produced while the pedal is pressed. Portamento is produced
when notes are played legato style (i.e., a note is played while the preceding note is still held). The portamento time can be set
via the Mixing Console display (page 125). It does not work for Natural voices.
PITCHBEND* Bend notes up or down while pedal is pressed. This can only be set to the AUX pedal and the CVP-210/208’s damper pedal.
MODULATION* Applies a vibrato effect to notes played on the keyboard. The depth of the effect increases while pedal is pressed. This does not
work for the Natural voices.
DSP VARIATION Same as the [VARIATION] button. This does not work for the Natural voices.
VIBROTOR ON/OFF Turns the “VibRotor” effect type (page 126) on and off. This only works for the Natural voices.
HARMONY/ECHO Same as the [HARMONY/ECHO] button.
VOCAL HARMONY Same as the [VOCAL HARMONY] button.
TALK Same as the [TALK] button.
SCORE PAGE+ While the song is stopped, you can turn to the previous score page (one page only).
SCORE PAGE- While the song is stopped, you can turn to the next score page (one page only).
SONG START/STOP Same as the SONG [START/STOP] button.
STYLE START/STOP Same as the STYLE [START/STOP] button.
TAP TEMPO Same as the [TAP TEMPO] button.
SYNCHRO START Same as the [SYNC. START] button.
SYNCHRO STOP Same as the [SYNC. STOP] button.
INTRO Same as the [INTRO] button.
MAIN A Same as the MAIN [A] button.
MAIN B Same as the MAIN [B] button.
MAIN C Same as the MAIN [C] button.
MAIN D Same as the MAIN [D] button.
FILL DOWN A fill-in plays, automatically followed by the Main section of the button on the immediate left.
FILL SELF Fill-in starts playing.
FILL BREAK Break starts playing.
FILL UP A fill-in plays, automatically followed by the Main section of the button on the immediate right.
ENDING Same as the [ENDING/rit.] button.
FADE IN/OUT Same as the [FADE IN/OUT] button.
FING/ON BASS The pedal alternately switches between the Fingered and On Bass modes (page 66).
BASS HOLD While the pedal is pressed, the Accompaniment Style bass note will be held even if the chord is changed. If the fingering is set
to “FULL KEYBOARD,” the function does not work.
PERCUSSION The pedal plays a percussion instrument selected by the [4▲▼] - [8▲▼] buttons. You can use the keyboard to select the
desired percussion instrument.
LAYER ON/OFF Same as the [LAYER] button.
LEFT ON/OFF Same as the [LEFT] button.
OTS+ Calls up the next One Touch Setting.
OTS- Calls up the previous One Touch Setting.
* For best results, use the optional Yamaha FC7 Foot Controller.

The parameters below correspond to buttons [2▲▼] - [8▲▼], and their availability depends on the selected control Type. For example, if
SUSTAIN is selected as the Type, the parameters “HALF PEDAL POINT”, “MAIN”, “LAYER” and “LEFT” automatically appear in the display.
SONG, STYLE, MIC, LEFT, These specify the part(s) that will be affected by the pedal.
LAYER, MAIN
HALF PEDAL POINT* You can specify how far down you should press on the right pedal until the damper effect (page 62) starts working. This
can be set for certain kinds of pedals, such as the AUX pedal (YAMAHA FC7) or the CVP-210/208’s damper pedal.
DEPTH Determines the depth of the left pedal effect, when SOFT is selected. This only works for the Natural voices.
UP/DOWN When GLIDE or PITCH BEND is selected, this determines whether the pitch change goes up (is raised) or down (is lowered).
RANGE When GLIDE or PITCH BEND is selected, this determines the range of the pitch change, in semitones.
ON SPEED When GLIDE is selected, this determines the speed of the pitch change, when the pedal is pressed.
OFF SPEED When GLIDE is selected, this determines the speed of the pitch change, when the pedal is released.
KIT When PERCUSSION is assigned to the pedal, all available drum kits are shown here, letting you select the particular
drum kit used for the pedal.
PERCUSSION When PERCUSSION is assigned to the pedal, all sounds of the selected drum kit (in KIT above) are shown here. This
determines the particular instrument sound assigned to the pedal.
* For best results, use the optional Yamaha FC7 Foot Controller.

CVP-210/208 143
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Changing the Touch Sensitivity and Transpose — Keyboard/Panel


Keyboard Touch
The Touch feature lets you control the volume of the voices by your playing strength. These settings allow you to
customize the keyboard’s touch response (sensitivity) to your personal playing preferences.
HARD 2 Requires strong playing to produce
high volume. Best for players with a
A heavy touch.
B
HARD 1 Requires moderately strong playing for
higher volume.
C

NORMAL Standard touch response.


D
SOFT 1 Produces high volume with moderate
Determines the E playing strength.
Touch sensitivity
SOFT 2 Produces relatively high volume even
setting (refer to the
with light playing strength. Best for
table at right).
players with a light touch.

The TOUCH setting affects all voices globally. Keep


Determines the in mind that you can set each voice to a different
fixed volume level 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 touch sensitivity (TOUCH SENSE). For example, to
when Touch is set play a pipe organ voice most authentically, you can
to “OFF.” set this so that the voice is not affected by touch
Determines whether touch is on or not for the corresponding parts. (page 93).

Transpose Assign
This determines which aspect of the instrument is affected by the [TRANSPOSE] button.

Transpose
Allows you to shift the pitch of the keyboard-played voices,
accompaniment style playback, and song data in semitone
units.

1 Press one of the [TRANSPOSE] buttons.


TRANSPOSE

RESET

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
2 A TRANSPOSE pop-up window, selected via
TRANSPOSE ASSIGN, appears.

KEYBOARD
For this setting, Transpose affects the pitch of the
keyboard-played voices (Main, Layer, and Left) and
the accompaniment styles.

SONG
3 Adjust the value by using the [TRANSPOSE] buttons.

For this setting, Transpose affects only the pitch of Close the TRANSPOSE windows by pressing the
the songs.
END [EXIT] button.
MASTER
For this setting, Transpose affects the pitch of the • Selectively Transposing Keyboard/Song
entire instrument (keyboard voices, These settings can be used to match both the song and your
accompaniment styles, and songs).
keyboard performance to a certain key. For example, let’s
say you wish to play and sing along with a certain recorded
song. The song data is in F, but you feel most comfortable
singing in D, and you are accustomed to playing the
keyboard part in C. To match up the keys, keep the Master
Transpose setting at “0,” set the Keyboard Transpose to “2,”
and set Song Transpose to “-3.” This brings the keyboard part
The transpose function up in pitch and the song data down to your comfortable
does not affect the Drum
Kit or SFX Kit voices. singing key.

144 CVP-210/208
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Setting the Registration Sequence, Freeze, and Voice Set


The explanations here apply to step #3 of the procedure on page 136.

Specifying the Order for Calling Up Registration Memory Presets —


Registration Sequence
You can save your custom panel settings to the Registration Memory presets, and call them up by pressing the
appropriate REGISTRATION MEMORY buttons [1] - [8]. The convenient Registration Sequence function lets you call up
the presets in any order you specify, by simply using the [BACK]/[NEXT] buttons or the pedal as you play.

Determines which pedal is used to advance Indicates the file name of the selected
(increment) through the sequence. Registration Memory bank. When you are using the
pedal to call up specified
presets, you can easily reset
the Registration Sequence
Determines which and go back to the first entry
pedal is used to A F by holding down the pedal
reverse (decrement) B G
for a few seconds (the red
through the sequence. box indicator at the top right
C H of the MAIN display goes
out). Press and release the
D I
foot pedal to re-select the
E J first entry in the sequence.

Determines how Registration


n
Turns the Registration
Setting Registration
Sequence behaves when Sequence function
Sequence Enable to “ON”
reaching the end of the on/off. When this is
overrides any other Pedal
sequence. set to “ON,” the
settings (for pedals assigned
Stop programmed
to “Regist (+) Pedal” and
Pressing the [NEXT] button or Registration
“Regist (-) Pedal” here).
the “advance” pedal has no 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Sequence is shown at
These include the pedal set-
effect. The sequence is the top right of the
tings on page 142, and in
“stopped.” Main display, and you
Voice Set on page 146.
Top can step through the
The sequence starts again at sequence in this n
the beginning. display by using the When both “Regist (+)
Next Bank [BACK]/[NEXT] Pedal” and “Regist (-) Pedal”
The sequence automatically buttons or the pedals. are set to “OFF,” the pedals
moves to the beginning of the
cannot be used to step
next Registration Memory bank
Deletes all Registration through the Registration
in the same folder.
Memory numbers in the Sequence; only the [BACK]/
sequence. [NEXT] buttons can be used
in the MAIN display.
Indicates the Registration Memory preset Deletes the number at the
numbers, in the order of the current cursor position. n
Registration Sequence. When both “Regist (+)
Pedal” and “Regist (-) Pedal”
Inserts the number of the currently are set to the same pedal,
These move the cursor position in the sequence. selected Registration Memory preset “Regist (+) Pedal” takes
immediately before the cursor position. priority.
Replaces the number at the cursor position with the
currently selected Registration Memory number.

Registration Sequence data is included as part


of the Registration Memory bank file. To save
your newly programmed Registration Sequence,
store the current Registration Memory bank file
(page 39, 48). Any Registration Sequence data
END Execute the settings by pressing the [EXIT] button. is lost when changing Registration Memory
banks, unless you’ve stored it with the Registra-
tion Memory bank file.

Maintaining Panel Settings — Freeze


This lets you specify the settings you want to be maintained or left unchanged, even when changing Registration
Memory presets. For details, see page 90.

CVP-210/208 145
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Changing the Automatically Selected Voice Settings — Voice Set


When changing voices (selecting a voice file), the settings best matching the voice — the same as those set in the Sound
Creator — are always and automatically called up. From this page, you can set the on/off status for each part. For
example, each of the preset voices has its own LEFT PEDAL setting; however, even changing voices will not change the
LEFT PEDAL setting, if it is set to “OFF” in this page.

Normally, these should all be


A

Use these to select the set to “ON.”


desired part. B

D
Harmony/echo and Left
E
pedal assignment cannot be
set for the Layer and Left
parts.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

These determine whether the corresponding


voice-related settings (Voice selection, Effects,
EQ, Harmony/echo, and left pedal assignment)
are automatically called up or not when you
select a voice. These settings can be turned on
or off independently for each part.

Setting Harmony and Echo


The explanations here apply to step #3 of the procedure on page 136.

Determines the lowest velocity value at


which the harmony note will sound. This
allows you to selectively apply the harmony
by your playing strength, letting you create
harmony accents in the melody. The
Determines the Harmony type. harmony effect is applied when you play
For details, see page 147. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
the key strongly (above the set value).

When this is set to “ON,” the Harmony


Determines the level of the Harmony effect. effect is applied only to the note that
belongs to a chord played in the Auto
Accompaniment section of the keyboard.
This parameter is not available when Multi
Assign, Echo, Tremolo, or Trill is selected in
Type above.
Determines the speed of the Echo, Tremolo, and Trill
effects. This parameter is only available when Echo, This lets you assign the Harmony
Tremolo, or Trill is selected in Type above. effect to various parts. For details,
see page 147.

146 CVP-210/208
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

About the Harmony Types

When a normal Harmony type (“Standard Duet” through “Strum”) is selected


Split point

Harmony notes (based on the chord


Chords played to the left of the and the selected type) are automatically
split point control the harmony. added to the melody played to the right
of the split point.

When “Multi Assign” is selected


Multi Assign automatically assigns notes played simultaneously on the right-hand section of the keyboard to
separate parts (voices). For example, if you play two consecutive notes, the first is played by the Main voice and the
second by the Layer voice.

When “Echo” is selected


An echo effect is applied to the note played on the keyboard, in time with the currently set tempo.

When “Tremolo” is selected


A tremolo effect is applied to the note played on the keyboard, in time with the currently set tempo.

When “Trill” is selected


Two notes held on the keyboard are played alternately, in time with the currently set tempo.

About the Harmony Assignments


Multi
This automatically assigns the 1st, 2nd, 3rd, and 4th added harmony notes to different parts (voices). For example, if the
Main and Layer parts are turned on and the “Standard Duet” type is selected, the note you play on the keyboard will be
played by the Main voice, and the added harmony note will be played by the Layer voice.
Main
Harmony is applied only to the Main part.
Layer
Harmony is applied only to the Layer part. When the Layer part is turned off, Harmony is not applied.

Showing the Clavinova Display on a TV — Video Out


The explanations here apply to step #3 of the procedure on page 136.
• Occasionally some flashing parallel
Television
lines may appear in the television or
video monitor. This does not necessarily
indicate that the monitor is malfunction-
ing. You may be able to remedy the situ-
VIDEO IN ation by changing the Character Color
or Background Color parameters. For
optimum results, also try adjusting the
color settings on the monitor itself.
• Avoid looking at the television or video
monitor for prolonged periods of time
Set this to since doing so could damage your eye-
correspond to the sight. Take frequent breaks and focus
standard used by your eyes on distant objects to avoid
your particular eyestrain.
television/video VIDEO OUT
• Keep in mind that even after adjusting
equipment: NTSC all settings as recommended here, the
or PAL. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 monitor you are using may not show the
Clavinova’s display contents as
expected (e.g., the display contents may
not fit on the screen, the characters may
Determines the contents of the Video Out signal, or which data is sent to the video monitor. not be completely clear, or the colors
Lyrics........Only the lyrics of the song are output via VIDEO OUT, regardless of the display may be incorrect).
that is called up on the instrument itself. This lets you select other displays and
still have the lyrics shown on the monitor.
LCD ...........The currently selected display is output via VIDEO OUT.

CVP-210/208 147
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Setting the MIDI Parameters


In this section, you can make MIDI-related settings for the instrument. These settings can be stored all together from the
USER display, for future recall.
For general information and details about MIDI, see “What is MIDI?” (page 159).
The explanations here apply to step #3 of the procedure on page 136.

Preset MIDI Templates (Factory Set)


1 Select the desired template.
All Parts Transmit all parts including Main, Layer
and Left.
Master KBD The Clavinova functions as a master
keyboard for controlling external tone
generators or other devices.
A F KBD & Style Transmit Upper and Lower keyboard play
instead of the individual parts (Main/
B G Layer/Left).
C H Song All Transmit channels are set to
correspond to the Song channels 1-16.
D I Use this to play the Clavinova song data
with an external tone generator, or to
E J record your entire performance to an
external sequencer.
Clock Ext. MIDI IN terminal receives MIDI clock and
Clavinova synchronizes with a external
MIDI device.
MIDI Accord 1 An ideal setup for controlling the
keyboard voice and accompaniment
style with a MIDI accordion.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MIDI Accord 2 Chord and bass buttons on a MIDI
accordion control the accompaniment
style, as well as play the chord and bass
parts.
3 Call up the User
display and press this 2 Call up the Edit display, then
select and set the desired
MIDI Pedal 1 The MIDI pedal connected to MIDI IN
terminal controls the bass note of the
button to save the functions/parameters. accompaniment.

newly edited MIDI For details about each of the MIDI Pedal 2 The MIDI pedal connected to MIDI IN
terminal plays the bass part.
settings. MIDI edit displays, see the
MIDI OFF MIDI signals are neither sent nor
Up to ten setups can following pages. received.
be saved.

The saved settings can be named (page 45)

END Press the [EXIT] button to return to the previous display.


or deleted (page 47) in the User page.

Making Overall System Settings (Local Control, Clock, etc.) — System


Call up the display as described in step 2 above.

For editing the Local Control parameters.


For editing the Clock, Transmit Clock,
Receive Transpose, and Start/Stop
For editing the Message Switch
parameters.
parameters.

Local Control
Turns the Local Control for each part on or off. When Local Control is set to “ON,” the keyboard of the CVP-210/208
controls its own (local) internal tone generator, allowing the internal voices to be played directly from the keyboard. If
you set Local to “OFF,” the keyboard and controllers are internally disconnected from the CVP-210/208’s tone
generator section so that no sound is output when you play the keyboard or use the controllers. For example, this allows
you to use an external MIDI sequencer to play the CVP-210/208’s internal voices, and use the CVP-210/208 keyboard
to record notes to the external sequencer and/or play an external tone generator.

148 CVP-210/208
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Clock, Transmit Clock, Receive Transpose, Start/Stop


■ Clock
Determines whether the CVP-210/208 is controlled by its own internal clock or a MIDI clock signal received from
an external device. “INTERNAL” is the normal Clock setting when the CVP-210/208 is being used alone. If you are
using the CVP-210/208 with an external sequencer, MIDI computer, or other MIDI device, and you want the CVP-
210/208 to be synchronized to the external device, set this function to “EXTERNAL.” In the latter case, the external
device must be connected to the CVP-210/208 MIDI IN terminal, and must be transmitting an appropriate MIDI
clock signal.

■ Transmit Clock
Turns MIDI clock transmission on or off. When this is set to “OFF,” no MIDI clock or START/STOP data is
transmitted.

■ Receive Transpose
When this parameter is set to “OFF,” note data received by the CVP-210/208 is not transposed, and when it is set to
“ON,” the received note data is transposed according to the current CVP-210/208 keyboard transpose (page 144) setting.

■ Start/Stop
Determines whether incoming FA (start) and FC (stop) messages affect song or FA, FC
style playback. MIDI messages for starting/stop-
ping the song or style. The “FA”
message corresponds to start,
and “FC” corresponds to stop.
Message Switch
SYS/EX. Tx (TRANSMIT)..................... Turns MIDI transmission of MIDI system exclusive message data ON or OFF.
SYS/EX. Rx (RECEIVE) ........................ Turns MIDI reception of MIDI exclusive data generated by external equipment
ON or OFF.
CHORD SYS/EX. Tx (TRANSMIT) ...... Turns MIDI transmission of MIDI chord exclusive data (chord detect — root and
type) ON or OFF.
CHORD SYS/EX. Rx (RECEIVE).......... Turns MIDI reception of MIDI chord exclusive data generated by external
equipment ON or OFF.

Transmitting MIDI Data — Transmit


This determines which parts will
send MIDI data and over which
MIDI channel the data will be sent. A

Determines the D
The dots corresponding
channel for changing to each channel (1-16)
E
transmit settings. flash briefly whenever
any data is transmitted
on the channel(s).

Determines the Part for the Turns transmission of the


selected channel. specified data type on or
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
off. See below for details
on the data types.

Data Types in the MIDI TRANSMIT/RECEIVE Display


Note Messages which are generated when the keyboard is played. Each message includes a specific note number
which corresponds to the key which is pressed, plus a velocity value based on how hard the key is played.
Control Change (CC) Control change data includes pedal and any other controller data.
Program Change (PC) Program change data corresponds to voice or “patch” numbers.
Pitch Bend (PB) See page 143.
After Touch (AT)* With this function, the Clavinova senses how much pressure you apply to the keys while playing, and uses that
pressure to affect the sound in various ways, depending on the selected voice. This allows you to play with greater
expressiveness and add effects with your playing technique.
* Available in RECEIVE display only (page 150).

CVP-210/208 149
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Receiving MIDI Data — Receive


This determines which parts will
receive MIDI data and over which The MIDI IN/OUT terminals
MIDI channel the data will be A and Port 1 of the USB termi-
received. B
nal correspond to channels 1
- 16. Port 2 of the USB termi-
C nal corresponds to channels
Determines the channel for
17 - 32.
changing receive settings. D

E
The dots corresponding to each
channel (1 - 32) flash briefly
whenever any data is received
on the channel(s).

Determines the Part for the Turns reception of the


selected channel. See below for specified data type on or off.
details about the receive parts. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
See page 149 for details on
the data types.

MIDI Receive Parts


OFF No MIDI data is received.
SONG Normally, the part receiving the MIDI data corresponds to the part/voice used in playing back the song data. Channels 1 - 16
correspond to song channels 1 - 16, respectively.
MAIN The MAIN part is controlled by the MIDI data received on the corresponding channel.
LAYER The LAYER part is controlled by the MIDI data received on the corresponding channel.
LEFT The LEFT part is controlled by the MIDI data received on the corresponding channel.
KEYBOARD MIDI note data received by the Clavinova plays the corresponding notes in the same way as if they are played on the keyboard.
ACMP RHYTHM1-2 The received notes are used as the accompaniment RHYTHM 1 and RHYTHM 2 notes.
ACMP BASS The received notes are used as the accompaniment BASS notes.
ACMP CHORD1-2 The received notes are used as the accompaniment CHORD 1 and CHORD 2 notes.
ACMP PAD The received notes are used as the accompaniment PAD notes.
ACMP PHRASE1-2 The received notes are used as the accompaniment PHRASE 1 and PHRASE 2 notes.
EXTRA PART1-5 There are five parts specially reserved for receiving and playing MIDI data. Normally, these parts are not used by the instrument
itself. When these five channels are enabled, you can use the instrument as a 32-channel multi-timbral tone generator.

Setting Root Note Channels — Root


The note ON/OFF messages received at the channel(s) set to “ON” are recognized as the root notes in the
accompaniment section. The root notes will be detected regardless of the accompaniment ON/OFF and split point
settings.

The MIDI IN/OUT terminals


A and Port 1 of the USB termi-
Selects the channels in groups of nal correspond to channels 1
eight: 1 - 8, 9 - 16, 17 - 24, and 25 B
- 16. Port 2 of the USB termi-
- 32, respectively. C nal corresponds to channels
17 - 32.
D

When several channels are


simultaneously set to “ON,”
the root note is detected
from merged MIDI data
received over the channels.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8

Sets the desired channel to ON or OFF. Sets all channels to OFF.

Setting Chord Channels — Chord Detect


The note ON/OFF messages received at the channel(s) set to “ON” are recognized as the chord notes in the
accompaniment section. The chords to be detected depend on the fingering type. The root notes will be detected
regardless of the accompaniment ON/OFF and split point settings. The operation procedure is basically the same as that
of the ROOT display above.
150 CVP-210/208
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Other Settings — Utility


The explanations here apply to step #3 of the procedure on page 136.

Making Settings for Fade In/Out, Metronome, Parameter Lock, and


Tap — CONFIG 1
Fade In Time, Fade Out Time, Fade Out Hold Time
These determine how long it takes for the accompaniment style and song to fade in or fade out.

Determines the time it takes for the


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
volume to fade in, or go from minimum to Determines the time the volume is held
maximum (range of 0 - 20.0 seconds). at 0 following the fade out (range of 0 -
Determines the time it takes for the volume to 5.0 seconds).
fade out, or go from maximum to minimum
(range of 0 - 20.0 seconds).

Metronome
These let you make settings for the metronome-related parameters.

1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Determines the level of the Determines the time
metronome sound. signature of the metronome
sound.
Determines which sound is used for the metronome.
When you start the song or
Bell Off ........................ Conventional metronome sound, with no bell.
accompaniment style, the
Bell On......................... Conventional metronome sound, with bell.
values matching to them are
English Voice .............. Count in English (One, Two, Three, Four)
automatically set.
German Voice.............. Count in German (Eins, Zwei, Drei, Vier)
Japanese Voice ........... Count in Japanese (Ichi, Ni, San, Shi)
French Voice ............... Count in French (Un, Deux, Trois, Quatre)
Spanish Voice ............. Count in Spanish (Uno, Dos, Tres, Cuatro)

CVP-210/208 151
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Parameter Lock
This function is used to “lock” the specified parameters so that they can only be changed directly via the panel controls
— in other words, instead of via Registration Memory, One Touch Setting, Music Finder, or song and sequence data.

Selects the desired Determines whether the selected


parameter for locking/ parameter is locked (checkmarked)
unlocking. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 or unlocked (empty).

Tap Count
This lets you change settings of the tap sound, used for the Tap Start function (page 55).

Determines the particular sound


used for the Tap Start function.
Any drum or percussion sound Determines the level of the tap
in the Standard Kit (page 59) 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
sound.
can be selected.

Making Settings for the Display, Speaker System, and Voice Number
Indication — CONFIG 2

HEADPHONE SW (SWITCH)
Speaker sounds normally, but is cut off
when headphones are inserted to the
PHONES jack.
ON
Speaker sound is always on.
OFF
Speaker sound is off.

Determines the contrast of the Determines whether or not the voice bank
display. and number are shown in the PRESET
page of the VOICE display (page 58). This is
Determines the brightness of 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 useful when you want to check the proper
the backlit display. bank select MSB/LSB values and program
number to specify when selecting the voice
from an external MIDI device.

152 CVP-210/208
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Copying and Formatting Disks — Disk


• Copying cannot be done
between a 2DD disk and
This function copies all 2HD disk. When copying,
the data from one disk make sure both disk are
F
to another, letting you the same type.
G
back up all your • Depending on the amount
important data before of data contained in the
H editing. For instructions, original source disk, you
see “Copying from Disk may have to swap the two
Turns the Song I
to Disk” below. disks several times until all
Auto Open
J of the data is properly
function on or
copied.
off. When this is This function formats a • Make sure to read the
set to “ON,” the floppy disk (see below). section “Using the Floppy
Clavinova
Disk Drive (FDD) and
automatically
Floppy Disks” on page 6.
calls up the first
disk song when
a disk is
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
inserted.

Copying from Disk to Disk


As shown below, first copy the data of the original (source) disk to the CVP-210/208, Internal memory
then copy the data to the backup (destination) disk.
Copy Copy

1 Press the [F] button. A message


appears, prompting you to insert 2 Insert the disk containing the
original data into the drive and
the source disk. press “OK.” Source Destination
disk disk
A “Now copying” message
appears, and the CVP-210/208
Commercially available
begins copying data to internal music data is subject to
memory. To abort the operation,
3 At the “Please insert a destination
disk and press the OK button ” press “CANCEL.”
protection by copyright
laws. Copying commer-
cially available data is
prompt, eject the source disk and strictly prohibited,
replace it with a blank, formatted except for your own per-
disk, then press “OK.” To abort the
operation, press “CANCEL.”
4 When the operation is finished
(or when prompted), eject the
sonal use. Some music
software is purposely
destination disk. copy-protected and
cannot be copied.

Formatting a Disk
When using an unformatted disk for the first
time, make sure to properly format it on the The Format operation initial-
CVP-210/208. This includes blank disks as izes a disk with a specific file
well as disks already initialized in a different system, allowing the corre-
sponding device (in this
format. Formatting erases all data on the disk. case, the CVP-210/208) to
access it properly.
Since there are several
types of formats and disks
available, you should know
which ones to use with the
Insert the disk with shutter facing away from CVP-210/208. 2DD disks
are formatted to a capacity
you and the label side up. To start the Format of 720 KB, and 2HD disks
operation, press the [H] (DISK FORMAT) are formatted to a capacity
button, in the DISK page above. of 1.44 MB.

CAUTION
Disk Lamp
Formatting a disk com-
When the power is turned on, the disk lamp
pletely erases all data on
(at the bottom left of the drive) lights to
the disk. Make sure that
indicate the drive can be used.
the disk you’re formatting
does not contain impor-
tant data!

CVP-210/208 153
Making Global and Other Important Settings — Function

Entering Your Name and Language Preference — Owner


When selecting background data from a
floppy disk:
F
• Only bitmap files (.BMP) can be used
Press this button to for the background of the MAIN dis-
G enter an Owner play. Make sure to use images no
name(page 17; for larger than 640 x 480 pixels. Smaller
H

Determines the instructions on images are automatically copied and


language used I naming see tiled in the display.
for the display page 49). This name • The selected background will not be
messages.
J
is automatically displayed when the power is turned
Once you shown when you on again unless the same disk con-
change this turn the power on. taining the data has been inserted
setting, all into the drive.
messages will Calls up the MAIN PICTURE • The background may take some time
be shown in the display, from which you can to appear. If you want to reduce this
selected select the background of the time, save the background to the
language. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 MAIN display. USER page of the MAIN PICTURE
display.

n
Selecting a different language here may
cause the following problems.
• Some characters of the file names
you entered may be garbled.
• Files may not be accessible.
Restoring the original language solves
the above problems.
Reading the files on the computer with a
different language system may cause
similar problems to those above.

Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings of the CVP-210/208 —


System Reset
This operation lets you restore the CVP-210/208 to its original factory settings. These settings include System Setup,
MIDI Setup, User Effect, Music Finder, and Files & Folders.

Restores the System Setup parameters to the


original factory settings. You can also restore The functions and settings
only the System Setup settings by below do not apply to the Fac-
simultaneously holding down the highest key tory Reset operation. However,
on the keyboard (C7) and turning on the power. you can restore these to their
original settings by calling up
the preset System Setup files,
using the Open/Save System
A F
Files function.
Restores the MIDI Language
templates to the original B G
Owner Name
factory settings. LDC Contrast
C H

LCD Brightness
Restores the User Effects D I Video Out settings (NTSC/PAL)
(page 127) to the original Screen Content
E J
factory settings.
Restores the Music Finder
data to the original factory
settings. All Music Finder records can be
stored together as a single file.
Deletes all files and folders When calling up a stored file, a
stored in the User page. message appears prompting
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
you to replace or append the
records as desired.
Replace:
Executes the Factory Reset operation These call up the corresponding Open/ All Music Finder records cur-
for all items checkmarked above. Save displays. These let you store the rently in the instrument are
corresponding data as files to disk, for deleted and replaced with the
future recall. Pressing each of these records of the selected file.
buttons calls up the corresponding Append:
Open/Save display, from which you can The records called up are
select the corresponding PRESET added to the vacant record
page. From this PRESET page, you numbers.
can save the relevant data.

154 CVP-210/208
Using Your Clavinova with Other Devices
CAUTION 2 Connecting the Microphone
Before connecting the Clavinova to other electronic components,
turn off the power to all the components. Before turning the power or Guitar (MIC./LINE IN jack).
on or off to all components, set all volume levels to minimum (0).
Otherwise, electrical shock or damage to the components may By connecting a microphone to the Clavinova, you can
occur. enjoy singing along with your own performance or song
playback. (A dynamic microphone is recommended.) The
Clavinova outputs your vocals or guitar sounds through
the built-in speakers.

INPUT
VOLUME
MIN MAX
MIC.
LINE IN MIC. LINE PHONES

1 Connect your microphone to the MIC./LINE IN jack


(standard 1/4" phone jack).

Use an unidirectional microphone for best results.

2 1
2 Set the [MIC. LINE] switch (located next to the MIC./
LINE IN jack) to the MIC. position.

MIC. LINE MIC. LINE

1 Using the Headphones


(PHONES jacks). When connecting a microphone When connecting a guitar

To use headphones, connect them to one of the PHONES


jacks (standard 1/4" phone jacks) located on the under-
You should set the [MIC. LINE] switch to the LINE position when
side of the keyboard. You can also determine whether or
connecting an audio source with line-level output to the MIC./LINE
not the internal stereo speaker system is shut off when a IN jack.
pair of headphones is plugged into the PHONES jack
(page 152). Two people can enjoy listening to the Clavi-
nova together by connecting two pairs of headphones to
the two jacks.
3 Use the [INPUT VOLUME]
knob (located next to the
MIC./LINE IN jack) to set the
microphone volume.
The volume should be set high
enough that the SIGNAL lamp
on the front panel lights steadily when you sing, but
not so high that the OVER lamp lights (page 131).

P.157 P.157 P.157


6 8 7

AUX PEDAL USB MIDI


THRU OUT IN

(LEVEL FIXED)
L/L+R R L/L+R R L R

VIDEO OUT AUX IN AUX OUT

5 4 3
P.156 P.156 P.156

CVP-210/208 155
Using Your Clavinova with Other Devices

345 Connecting Audio & 4 Outputting the sound of an external


device through the built-in speakers of
Video Devices the Clavinova (AUX IN jacks)
You can connect the Clavinova to a wide range of audio
equipment by using the AUX IN and AUX OUT jacks,
CAUTION
which are located at the bottom left of the instrument.
When the Clavinova’s AUX IN jacks are connected to an external
Connect as shown in the illustrations below using device, first turn on the power of the external device, then that of
standard audio cables. the Clavinova.

Clavinova
Use audio cables and adaptor plugs with no resistance.
L L+R R

Tone generator

AUX IN

CAUTION LINE OUT


When the Clavinova AUX OUT jacks are connected to an external Phone plug
(standard)
audio system, first turn on the power to the Clavinova, then to the Audio cable
external audio system. Reverse this order when you turn the power
off.

3 Playing the sounds of the Clavinova • The Clavinova’s [MASTER VOLUME] setting affects the input
through an external audio system, and signal from the AUX IN jacks.
• If you connect the Clavinova to a monaural device, use only the
recording the sounds to an external AUX IN L/L+R jack.
recorder (AUX OUT jacks)

CAUTION
Never connect the Clavinova AUX OUT jacks to its AUX IN jacks,
5 Showing the display of the Clavinova on
either directly or via external audio equipment. Such connections a connected TV monitor (VIDEO OUT)
could result in a feedback loop that will make normal performance You can connect the Clavinova to a television or video
impossible, and may even damage the Clavinova.
monitor to display the lyrics in your song data or LCD
on a larger screen.
The particular contents of the display can also be set
Clavinova (page 147).
(LEVEL FIXED)
Cassette tape recorder
L+R R L R stereo system

AUX OUT • For information on setting the video standard (NTSC or PAL),
refer to page 147. The default setting is “PAL.”
RCA pin plug AUX IN • Use an audio-video cable with good high-frequency characteris-
Phone plug tics and RCA-type pin jacks to connect the Clavinova to a televi-
RCA pin
(standard) Audio cable plug sion or video monitor.

To powered speaker
When these are connected
When these are connected (with RCA pin plug; LEVEL
(with standard phone FIXED), the sound is output to RCA pin
plugs), you can use the the external device at a fixed RCA pin plug
[MASTER VOLUME] level, regardless of the plug VIDEO IN
control to adjust the volume [MASTER VOLUME] control L L+R R

of the sound output to the setting.


external device.
AUX PEDAL VIDEO OUT AUX IN

Television

• If you connect the Clavinova to a monaural device, use only the


AUX OUT L/L+R jack.

156 CVP-210/208
Using Your Clavinova with Other Devices

6 Using the Pedal (footswitch) 8 Connecting a computer (USB


or Foot Controller (AUX terminal, MIDI terminal)
PEDAL jack) Connecting your CVP-210/208 to a computer allows you
to transfer data back and forth between the two and take
By connecting an optional Foot Controller (such as the
advantage of the powerful and versatile music software
FC7) to the AUX PEDAL jack, you can control any one of
available. You can connect the devices in one of two
a variety of important functions with your foot — such as
ways:
dynamically adjusting the volume as you play (page 142).
■ Using the USB terminal
By connecting a Foot Switch (the FC4 or FC5) to this jack,
■ Using the MIDI terminals
you can replicate the function of some panel buttons,
doing things like starting and stopping accompaniment. The MIDI terminals cannot be used when the USB
terminal is in use.
CAUTION
An appropriate MIDI application for your computer
Make sure to connect or disconnect the pedal only when the power
is turned off. platform is required.
For details about the necessary MIDI settings for computer
and sequence software you are using, refer to the relevant
7 Connecting external MIDI owner’s manuals.

devices (MIDI terminals) “The Clavinova-Computer Connection,” is a


supplementary guidebook that describes, for
Use the built-in MIDI terminals and standard MIDI cables beginners, what you can do with your Clavinova and
to connect external MIDI devices. For more information a personal computer and how to set up a Clavinova-
about MIDI connections, see “What You Can Do With Computer system (the manual is not written for any
MIDI” on page 161. specific models). The document is available as a PDF
The MIDI terminals cannot be used when the USB file (in English) at the following Internet address:
terminal is connected to a computer and active. Clavinova Web site (English only):
MIDI IN........... Receives MIDI messages from an http://www.yamahaclavinova.com/
external MIDI device Yamaha Manual Library
MIDI OUT ....... Sends out MIDI messages generated by http://www2.yamaha.co.jp/manual/english/
the Clavinova
MIDI THRU ..... Simply relays the MIDI messages
received at MIDI IN
For a general overview of MIDI and how you can
effectively use it, refer to the following sections:
• What’s MIDI? (page 159)
• What You Can Do With MIDI (page 161)
• MIDI functions (page 148)

• Never use MIDI cables longer than 15 meters.

CVP-210/208 157
Using Your Clavinova with Other Devices

Using the USB terminal Using the MIDI terminals


Connect the USB terminal of a computer to the USB When using a MIDI interface device installed in the
terminal of the CVP-210/208 using a USB cable. Make personal computer, connect the MIDI terminals of the
sure to use a standard USB cable with the USB logo. personal computer and the CVP-210/208 with standard
MIDI cables.
Clavinova
USB cable NEC MultiSync
• When the computer has a MIDI interface installed,
PC-9821 AS
connect the MIDI OUT terminal of the personal
NEC

computer to the MIDI IN terminal.

About the USB driver


You must install the specified USB driver (YAMAHA Clavinova MIDI IN MIDI OUT

USB MIDI Driver) to your computer before you can


NEC MultiSync

MIDI OUT MIDI IN


PC-9821 AS

transfer data between the computer and the CVP-210/ NEC

208.
You can download a copy of the YAMAHA USB MIDI • When using a MIDI interface with a Macintosh series
Driver free of charge from the XG Library on the computer, connect the RS-422 terminal of the
Yamaha Web site (http://www.yamaha-xg.com). computer (modem or printer terminal) to the MIDI
interface, then connect the MIDI OUT terminal on the
MIDI interface to the MIDI IN terminal of the CVP-
CAUTION 210/208, as shown in the diagram below.
If you are using a USB cable to connect the Clavinova to your com-
puter, you must connect the USB cable before turning on the power
Clavinova MIDI IN RS422
of the instrument.
Also, do not turn the power of the Clavinova on/off while any appli-
MIDI OUT
cation software that uses USB or MIDI is running. MINI DIN
8-pin
If you turn the power of the Clavinova on or off or connect/discon-
nect the USB cable in the following states, problems will occur in
the computer system, possibly causing it to “freeze” (hang up), or
causing the Clavinova to stop functioning. • When using a Macintosh series computer, set the
• While installing the driver. MIDI interface clock setting in the application
• While starting or shutting down the operating system.
• While the computer is in an energy-save or sleep mode.
software to match the setting of the MIDI interface
• When a MIDI application program is starting. you are using. For details, refer to the owner’s
manual for the particular software you are using.
Make sure NOT to perform any of the following operations. Other-
wise, the computer may lock up or the Clavinova functions may be
disabled.
• Turning the power on/off, or connecting/disconnecting the cable
too often.
• Shifting to energy-save or sleep mode while MIDI data is being
transferred, or returning from sleep mode.
• Disconnecting/connecting the cable while the Clavinova is on.
• Turning the power of the Clavinova on/off, starting up your com-
puter, or installing the driver while a large amount of data is
being transferred.

• The Clavinova will begin transmission a short time after the USB
connection is made.
• When using a USB cable to connect Clavinova to your computer,
make the connection directly without passing through a USB
hub.
• Depending on the state of your computer, the operating state of
Clavinova may become unstable. Do not use your computer in a
way that causes it to enter an unstable state.

158 CVP-210/208
Using Your Clavinova with Other Devices

What’s MIDI? Recording and playing back the performance of a digital


instrument (MIDI data)
Let’s consider an acoustic piano and a classical guitar as
representative acoustic instruments. With the piano, you Recording Playback
strike a key, and a hammer inside hits some strings and
plays a note. With the guitar, you directly pluck a string
and the note sounds. Tone generator

But how does a digital instrument go about playing a Sequencer

note? FD
Controller (keyboard, etc.)
Acoustic guitar note Digital instrument note
production production

FD
Internal amp Internal amp
Tone generator
L R
(Electric circuit)

Playing
the keyboard
In the case of digital instruments, the audio signals are sent
Based on playing information through output jacks (such as AUX OUT) on the instrument.
from the keyboard, a
sampled note stored in the
Pluck a string and the body
tone generator is played
resonates the sound.
through the speakers.

As shown in the illustration above, in an electronic


instrument, the sampled note (previously recorded note)
stored in the tone generator section (electronic circuit) is
played based on information received from the keyboard,
and output through the speakers.

Now let’s examine what happens when we play back a


recording. When you playback a music CD (for example,
a solo piano recording), you’re hearing the actual sound
(vibrations in air) of the acoustic instrument. This is called
audio data, to distinguish it from MIDI data.

Recording and playing back the performance of an acoustic


instrument (audio data)

Recording Playback

In the above example, the actual acoustic sounds of the


pianist’s performance are captured in the recording as
audio data, and this is recorded to CD. When you play
back that CD on your audio system, you can hear the
actual piano performance. The piano itself is not
necessary, since the recording contains the actual sounds
of the piano, and your speakers reproduce them.

CVP-210/208 159
Using Your Clavinova with Other Devices

The “controller” and “tone generator” in the illustration ■ Example Keyboard Data
above are equivalent to the piano in our acoustic
example. Here, the player’s performance on the keyboard Voice number (with what voice) 01 (grand piano)
is captured as MIDI song data (see illustration below). In Note number (with which key) 60 (C3)
order to record the audio performance on an acoustic Note on (when was it pressed) Timing expressed numerically
piano, special recording equipment is needed. However, and (quarter note)
since the Clavinova features a built-in sequencer that lets note off (when was it released)
you record performance data, this recording equipment is Velocity (about how strong) 120 (strong)
unnecessary. Instead, your digital instrument — the
Clavinova — allows you to both record and play back the Panel operations on the CVP-210/208, such as playing the
data. keyboard and selecting voices, are processed and stored
as MIDI data. The auto accompaniment styles and songs
also consist of MIDI data.
Tone generator

MIDI is an acronym that stands for Musical Instrument


Sequencer Digital Interface, which allows electronic musical
instruments to communicate with each other, by sending
and receiving compatible Note, Control Change, Program
Keyboard performance
(MIDI data) Change and various other types of MIDI data, or
messages.
However, we also need a sound source to produce the The CVP-210/208 can control a MIDI device by
audio, which eventually comes from your speakers. The transmitting note related data and various types of
tone generator of the Clavinova fills this function. The controller data.The CVP-210/208 can be controlled by
recorded performance is reproduced by the sequencer, incoming MIDI messages which automatically determine
playing back the song data, using a tone generator the tone generator mode, select MIDI channels, voices
capable of accurately producing various instrument and effects, change parameter values and of course play
sounds — including that of a piano. Looked at in another the voices specified for the various parts.
way, the relation of the sequencer and the tone generator
is similar to that of the pianist and the piano — one plays
the other. Since digital instruments handle playback data
MIDI data has the following advantages over audio data:
and the actual sounds independently, we can hear our • The amount of data is much less, letting you easily store MIDI
piano performance played by another instrument, such as songs to floppy disk.
guitar or violin. • The data can be effectively and easily edited, even to the point of
changing voices and transforming the data.

Even though it is a single musical instrument, the Clavinova can be MIDI messages can be divided into two groups: Channel
thought of as containing several electronic components: a control- messages and System messages.
ler, a tone generator, and a sequencer.

Finally, we’ll take a look at the actual data that gets ■ Channel Messages
recorded and that serves as the basis for playing the The CVP-210/208 is an electronic instrument that can
sounds. For example, let’s say you play a “C” quarter note handle 16 channels (or 32 channels, when using the USB
using the grand piano sound on the CVP-210/208 terminal). This is usually expressed as “it can play 16
keyboard. Unlike an acoustic instrument that puts out a instruments at the same time.” Channel messages transmit
resonated note, the electronic instrument puts out information such as Note ON/OFF, Program Change, for
information from the keyboard such as “with what voice,” each of the 16 channels.
“with which key,” “about how strong,” “when was it Message Name CVP-210/208 Operation/Panel Setting
pressed” and “when was it released.” Then each piece of
Note ON/OFF Messages which are generated when the
information is changed into a number value and sent to keyboard is played. Each message includes
the tone generator. Using these numbers as a basis, the a specific note number which corresponds
tone generator plays the stored sampled note. to the key which is pressed, plus a velocity
value based on how hard the key is played.
Program Change Voice selecting (control change bank select
MSB/LSB setting)
Control Change Volume, panpot (Mixing Console), etc.

The performance data of all songs and styles is handled as MIDI


data.

160 CVP-210/208
Using Your Clavinova with Other Devices

As you can see, it is essential to determine which data


MIDI channels is to be sent over which MIDI channel when
MIDI performance data is assigned to one of sixteen transmitting MIDI data (page 149). The Clavinova also
MIDI channels. Using these channels, 1 - 16, the allows you to determine how the received data is
performance data for sixteen different instrument parts played back. (page 150).
can be simultaneously sent over one MIDI cable.
Think of the MIDI channels as TV channels. Each TV
station transmits its broadcasts over a specific ■ System Messages
channel.Your home TV set receives many different This is data that is used in common by the entire MIDI
programs simultaneously from several TV stations and system. System messages include messages like Exclusive
you select the appropriate channel to watch the desired Messages that transmit data unique to each instrument
program. manufacturer and Realtime Messages that control the
MIDI device.

Message Name CVP-210/208 Operation/Panel Setting


Weather Report
System Exclusive Effect type settings (Mixing Console),
News 2 Message etc.
1
News Realtime Messages Clock setting, Start/stop operation
2
The messages transmitted/received by the CVP-210/208
MIDI operates on the same basic principle. The are shown in the MIDI Data Format and MIDI
transmitting instrument sends MIDI data on a specific Implementation Chart in the separate Data List.
MIDI channel (MIDI Transmit Channel) via a single
MIDI cable to the receiving instrument. If the receiving
instrument’s MIDI channel (MIDI Receive Channel)
matches the Transmit Channel, the receiving instrument
will sound according to the data sent by the
What You Can Do With MIDI
transmitting instrument. The following MIDI settings can be made on the
Clavinova:
• MIDI templates (preset MIDI setups for various
applications) (page 148)
MIDI
cable • Transmit (page 149)
MIDI transmit channel 2 MIDI receive channel 2 • Receive (page 150)
• Local Control (page 148)
• Clock (page 149)
The Clavinova’s keyboard and internal tone generator are also
connected by MIDI (page 148). ■ Record performance data (1-16 channels) using the
CVP-210/208 Auto Accompaniment features on a
For example, several tracks (channels) can be external sequencer (such as a personal computer).
transmitted simultaneously, including the style data (as After recording, edit the data with the sequencer, then
shown below). play it again on the CVP-210/208 (playback).
Example: Recording the auto accompaniment of the Clavinova to
an external sequencer MIDI receive
Clavinova MIDI IN MIDI OUT
NEC MultiSync

MIDI OUT MIDI IN PC-9821 AS

NEC

MIDI transmit Personal cumputer,


MIDI cable or QY series etc.
serial cable
Clavinova track (channnel) External sequencer
MAIN Channel 1 Track 1 When you want to use the Clavinova as an XG-
LAYER Channel 2 Track 2 compatible multi-timbral tone generator, set the receive
LEFT Channel 3 Track 3
STYLE instrument Channel 4 Track 4
part for MIDI channels 1 to 16 to “SONG” in MIDI
STYLE instrument Channel 5 Track 5 Receive (page 150).
STYLE instrument Channel 6 Track 6
STYLE instrument Channel 7 Track 7 ■ Play and control the Clavinova from a separate
STYLE instrument Channel 8 Track 8
STYLE instrument Channel 9 Track 9
keyboard
STYLE instrument Channel 10 Track 10
STYLE instrument Channel 11 Track 11 MIDI receive
Clavinova
MIDI IN MIDI OUT

CVP-210/208 161
Using Your Clavinova with Other Devices

MIDI Data Compatibility Sequence Format


The system which records song data is called “sequence
This section covers basic information on data
format.”
compatibility: whether or not other MIDI devices can
Playback is only possible when the sequence format of
playback the data recorded by CVP-210/208, and
the disk matches that of the MIDI device. The CVP-210/
whether or not the CVP-210/208 can playback
208 is compatible with the following formats.
commercially available song data or song data created for
other instruments or on a computer. Depending on the ■ SMF (Standard MIDI File)
MIDI device or data characteristics, you may be able to This is the most common sequence format.
play back the data without any problem, or you may have Standard MIDI Files are generally available as one of two
to perform some special operations before the data can be types: Format 0 or Format 1. Many MIDI devices are
played back. If you run into problems playing back data, compatible with Format 0, and most commercially
please refer to the information below. available software is recorded as Format 0.
• The CVP-210/208 is compatible with both Format 0
Disk format and Format 1.
Floppy disks are the main storage medium for data used • Song data recorded on the CVP-210/208 is
with various devices, including computers. Different automatically recorded as SMF Format 0.
devices have different systems of storing data, therefore it
• Song data loaded to the CVP-210/208 is automatically
is necessary to first configure the floppy disk to the system
saved as SMF Format 0 regardless of the original
of the device being used.This operation is called
format.
“formatting.”
• There are two types of floppy disks: MF2DD (double ■ ESEQ
sided, double density) and MF2HD (double sided, This sequence format is compatible with many of
high density), and each type has different formatting Yamaha’s MIDI devices, including the Clavinova series
systems. instruments.This is a common format used with various
Yamaha software.
• CVP-210/208 can record and playback with both
types of floppy disks.
■ XF
• When formatted by the CVP-210/208, a 2DD disk The Yamaha XF format enhances the SMF (Standard MIDI
stores up to 720 KB (kilobytes) and a 2HD disk stores File) format with greater functionality and open-ended
up to1.44 MB (megabytes). (The figures “720 KB” and expandability for the future.
“1.44MB” indicate the data memory capacity. They are
also used to indicate the format type of disk.) • The CVP-210/208 is capable of displaying lyrics when
an XF file containing lyric data is played.
• Playback is only possible when the MIDI device to be
used is compatible with the format of the disk. ■ Style File
The Style File Format – SFF – is Yamaha’s original style file
format which uses a unique conversion system to provide
high-quality automatic accompaniment based on a wide
range of chord types.

162 CVP-210/208
Using Your Clavinova with Other Devices

Voice Allocation Format


With MIDI, voices are assigned to specific numbers,
called “program numbers.” The numbering standard
(order of voice allocation) is referred to as the “voice
allocation format.”
Voices may not play back as expected unless the voice
allocation format of the song data matches that of the
compatible MIDI device used for playback.
The CVP-210/208 is compatible with the following
formats.

Even if the devices and data used satisfy all the conditions above,
the data may still not be completely compatible, depending on the
specifications of the devices and particular data recording
methods.

■ GM System Level 1
This is one of the most common voice allocation formats.

• Many MIDI devices are compatible with GM System


Level1, as is most commercially available software.

■ XG
XG is a major enhancement of the GM System Level 1
format, and was developed by Yamaha specifically to
provide more voices and variations, as well as greater
expressive control over voices and effects, and to ensure
compatibility of data well into the future.

• Song data recorded on the CVP-210/208 using voices


in the [XG] category is XG-compatible.

■ DOC
This voice allocation format is compatible with many of
Yamaha’s MIDI devices, including the Clavinova series
instruments. This is also a common format used with
various Yamaha software.

CVP-210/208 163
CVP-210/208: Keyboard Stand Assembly
CAUTION
■ Be careful not to confuse parts, and be sure to install all parts
in the correct direction. Please assemble in accordance with
3 Remove the speaker box cover from the speaker box.
The speaker cover is attached to the
the sequence given below. unit with two tabs and velcro tape
■ Assembly should be carried out by at least two persons. at several points. To remove the
■ Be sure to use the correct screw size, as indicated below. Use speaker cover, pull them straight
of incorrect screws can cause damage. down.
■ Be sure to tighten up all Be careful not to touch the speakers
Have a Phillips-head (+) when handling the speaker box.
screws upon completing screwdriver ready. Damage may result.
assembly of each unit.
■ To disassemble, reverse CAUTION
the assembly sequence Put your hands at the positions indicated and pull as shown.
given below. The speakers are located to either side of these places - avoid
touching the speakers as this may damage them.

1 Remove all parts from the box. Confirm that all


parts shown in the illustration are provided.
4 Attach the front legs.

Main unit

Front leg (right) Front leg (left)

1 Fix the front right leg to 2 Fix the front right leg to
the bottom surface of the the speaker box using
Front leg (left) Rear leg Front leg (right)
unit using two screws. three screws.

Bundled pedal
Pedal box cord inside
3 Fix the front left leg in the same way.
AC power cord
5x18 mm fixing screws x16 If the screw holes do not align, loosen the other screws and adjust
the position of the front leg.

5 Attach the rear leg.

2 With the key cover closed and the keyboard side


on the bottom, lean the unit against the wall.
2 Fix the rear legs to the speaker box using two screws.

CAUTION
• Be careful not to pinch your fingers. 1 Fix the rear legs to
• The top part of the music score stand is not fixed. When the bottom surface
you lean the unit against the wall, support the music score of the unit using
stand with your hand so that the stand will not fall. two screws.

Spread a large soft cloth, such as a


blanket, on the floor. Place the unit on If the screw holes do not align, loosen the other screws and adjust
the cloth with the keyboard side on the the position of the rear legs.
bottom and lean the unit against the wall
so that the unit will not fall or slip. Place
a soft cloth against the wall to protect
the instrument and wall from scratches.
6 Raising the unit to the standing position.
Use the front legs as support to raise the unit.
Be sure to
position the CAUTION
keyboard side on Please do not touch the speaker net. CAUTION
the bottom. Doing so may damage the speaker inside. • Be careful not to pinch your fingers.
• When you raise the unit, do not hold the key cover.

CAUTION
Do not place the main unit with the rear
side facing down.

CAUTION
Do not lay the main unit upside-
down on the floor.

164 CVP-210/208
CVP-210/208: Keyboard Stand Assembly

7 Installing the pedal box.


10 Set the voltage selector and connect the power cord.
1 Remove the plastic cover 2 Untie and straighten out the
from the rear legs. bundled cord attached to the
bottom of the pedal box.

240

(the bottom of the right side

110

220
127 as seen from the front)

Voltage Selector
Before connecting the AC power cord, check the setting of the
voltage selector which is provided in some areas. To set the selector
for 110V, 127V, 220V or 240V main voltages, use a "minus"
screwdriver to rotate the selector dial so that the correct voltage for
your region appears next to the pointer on the panel. The voltage
selector is set at 240V when the unit is initially shipped.
After the proper voltage has been selected, connect the AC power
cord to the AC INLET and an AC wall outlet. A plug adaptor may be
also provided in some areas to match the pin configuration of the AC
3 Pass the pedal cord wall outlets in your area.
between the pedal box
and the rear leg. WARNING
An improper voltage setting can cause serious damage to the
Clavinova or result in improper operation.
4 Make sure that the pedal box lays flat, with no gap
between itself and the floor, then affix the pedal box
using two screws. ■ After completing the assembly, please
check the following.
8 Connect the pedal cord.
• Are there any parts left over?
→ Review the assembly procedure and correct any
1 Insert the pedal errors.
cord plug into the
• Is the Clavinova clear of doors and other movable
pedal connector.
Insert the plug fixtures?
with the arrow- → Move the Clavinova to an appropriate location.
printed side fac- • Does the Clavinova make a rattling noise when
ing front (toward you shake it?
the keyboard side).
If the plug will not go in easily,
→ Tighten all screws.
do not force it. Double-check the • Are the pedal and power cords inserted securely
orientation of the plug, then try into the sockets?
again. → Check the connection.
• If the main unit creaks or is otherwise unsteady
when you play on the keyboard, refer to the
2 Align the pedal cord into the assembly diagrams and retighten all screws.
groove on the rear leg, and
install the plastic cover onto
the groove. Be careful not to When moving the instrument after assembly, always
insert the cover's attachment
strip between the groove wall hold the bottom of the main unit.
and the leg.
CAUTION
Do not hold the key cover or top portion. Improper handling
can result in damage to the instrument or personal injury.

9 Installing the speaker cover to the speaker box. Top portion

Install the speaker cover on


the speaker box so that the
dented side comes to the
upper-right corner.
Align two plugs on the
speaker cover with the holes
on the speaker box, and
Key cover
push in where the velcro
tape strips are attached.

CAUTION
The speaker cover is made of a very soft material. Pushing If you move the instrument after assembly, affix the screws on
in a place where no tab or velcro tape is located may dam- the pedal box again so that the pedal box will lay flat, with no gap
age the speakers. between itself and the floor. (See step 7-4.)

CVP-210/208 165
Troubleshooting
Problem Possible Cause and Solution
• The Clavinova does not turn on; there is no Make sure that the Clavinova has been plugged in properly. Securely insert the
power. female plug into the AC socket on the Clavinova, and the male plug into a proper
AC outlet (page 17).
• A click or pop is heard when the power is This is normal when electrical current is applied to the instrument.
turned on or off.
• Noise is heard from the Clavinova’s speakers. Using a mobile phone in close proximity to the Clavinova may produce
interference. To prevent this, turn off the mobile phone, or use it further away from
the Clavinova.
• The display is too bright or too dark to read. The brightness of the display may be affected by the surrounding temperature;
try adjusting the contrast (page 152).
• The keyboard volume is low compared to that The overall keyboard volume or the independent volume level of the keyboard
of the Auto Accompaniment or song playback. part may be set too low. Raise the MAIN/LAYER/LEFT volume voices or lower
the STYLE/SONG volume in the BALANCE display (page 65).
• The volume of the Auto Accompaniment or The volume level of one or more accompaniment parts or song channels is set
song playback is low compared to that of the too low. Raise the part or channel level(s) in the appropriate MIXER display
keyboard. (page 124).
• The overall volume is low, or no sound is • The Master Volume is set too low; set it to an appropriate level with the
heard. [MASTER VOLUME] dial.
• The volume of the individual parts may be set too low. Raise the volume of
MAIN, LAYER, LEFT, STYLE, and SONG in the BALANCE display (page 65).
• Make sure the desired channel is set to ON (page 65, 80).
• Headphones are connected, disabling the speaker output. (This happens
when the speaker setting is set to “HEADPHONE SW”; page 152.) Unplug the
headphones.
• Make sure the speaker setting is set to ON (page 152).
• Make sure the Local Control function is set to ON (page 148).
• The damper, sostenuto and soft functions do Each pedal has been assigned to a different function. Make sure that each pedal
not work for the relevant pedals. is properly assigned to SUSTAIN, SOSTENUTO, and SOFT (page 142).
• The damper pedal has no effect, or the sound The pedal cable/plug may not be properly connected. Make sure to securely
continuously sustains even when the damper insert the pedal plug into the proper jack (page 164 - 165).
pedal is not pressed.
• Not all simultaneously-played notes sound. You may be exceeding the maximum polyphony of the Clavinova. When this
happens, the earliest played notes will stop sounding, letting the latest played
notes sound. See page 168 for information on the maximum polyphony.
• Some of the Regular voices (page 92) appear This is normal. The Regular voices below are built into the Natural tone
instead as Natural voices when making generation source (page 92):
settings in the Sound Creator, Mixing Console Sweet! Harmonica, Sweet! Mandolin (CVP-210), Trumpet (CVP-210), Live!
and Pedal control (in Function). French Horn (CVP-210), Sweet! Oboe, Live! Sax Section (CVP-210), Sweet!
Violin
• Accompaniment style or Song playback does • MIDI Clock may be set to “EXTERNAL.” Make sure this is set to “INTERNAL”
not start. (page 149).
• Make sure to press the appropriate [START/STOP] button. To play an
accompaniment style, press the STYLE [START/STOP] button (page 65); to
playback a song, press the SONG [START/STOP] button (page 78).
• “New Song” (a blank song) has been selected. Make sure to select an
appropriate song in the SONG display (page 78).
• The song has been stopped at the end of the song data. Return to the
beginning of the song by pressing the [TOP] button (page 80).
• Only the rhythm channel plays. Make sure the Auto Accompaniment function is turned on; press the [ACMP]
button.
• The accompaniment style does not start, You may be trying to start accompaniment by playing a key in the right hand
even when Synchro Start is in standby range of the keyboard. Make sure to play a key in the left-hand (accompaniment)
condition and a key is pressed. range of the keyboard.
• The desired chord is not recognized or output • You may not be playing the correct keys to indicate the chord. Refer to “Chord
by the auto accompaniment. Types Recognized in the Fingered Mode” (page 67).
• You may be playing the keys according to a different fingering mode, and not
the one currently selected. Check the accompaniment mode, and play the
keys according to the selected mode (page 66).

166 CVP-210/208
Troubleshooting

Problem Possible Cause and Solution


• Auto accompaniment chords are recognized This is normal if the fingering mode is set to “Full Keyboard” or “AI Full Keyboard.”
regardless of the split point or where chords If either of these is selected, chords are recognized over the entire range of the
are played on the keyboard. keyboard, irrespective of the split point setting. If desired, select a different
fingering mode (page 66).
• Certain notes sound at the wrong pitch. The Scale parameter has probably been set to something other than “Equal,”
changing the tuning system of the keyboard. Make sure “Equal” is selected as
the Scale in the Scale Tune page (page 138).
• Some channels do not properly play back Make sure that playback of the relevant channel(s) is turned on (page 80).
when playing back song data.
• If you experience distorted or out-of-tune The solution to this problem is to ensure that as little extraneous sound as
sound from the Vocal Harmony feature, your possible is picked up by your vocal microphone:
vocal microphone may be picking up • Sing as closely to the microphone as possible.
extraneous sounds (other than your voice) — • Use a directional microphone.
the Auto Accompaniment sound from the • Turn down the MASTER VOLUME or volume for each part.
Clavinova, for example. In particular, bass • Separate the microphone from the instrument's speakers as much as
sounds can cause mistracking of the Vocal possible.
Harmony feature. • Cut the Low band via the 3 Band EQ function in the MICROPHONE SETTING
display (page 133).
• Increase the microphone input level (“TH.”) in the Compressor function from
the MICROPHONE SETTING display (page 133).
• Appropriate harmony notes are not produced Make sure you are using the appropriate method to specify the harmony notes
by the Vocal Harmony feature. for the current Vocal Harmony mode. See page 134.
• The Harmony function does not operate. Harmony cannot be used with the Full Keyboard or AI Full Keyboard fingering
modes. Select an appropriate fingering mode (page 66).
• The microphone input signal and Vocal This is normal; recording the audio input of the microphone is not possible.
Harmony sound cannot be recorded.
• MIDI data is not transmitted or received via Remove the USB cable from the Clavinova’s USB terminal.
the MIDI terminals, even when MIDI cables
are connected properly.
• When a voice is changed, the previously Each voice has its own suitable preset values which are automatically recalled
selected effect is changed. when the corresponding Voice Set parameters are turned on (page 146).
• There is a slight difference in sound quality This is normal and is a result of the Clavinova’s sampling system.
between notes played on the keyboard.
• Some voices have a looping sound.
• Some noise or vibrato is noticeable at higher
pitches, depending upon the voice.
• Some voices will jump an octave in pitch This is normal. Some voices have a pitch limit which, when reached, causes this
when played in the upper or lower registers. type of pitch shift.
• Even though a Registration Memory setting This is normal; even with the Preset voice shown, the actual sounding voice is
containing a User voice is selected, the Open/ the selected User voice.
Save display shows a Preset voice. When a User voice is registered to the User drive or floppy disk, the actual
registered is: 1) the source Preset voice, and 2) the parameter settings as set in
the Sound Creator. When you recall a Registration Memory setting containing a
User voice, the Clavinova selects the Preset voice (on which the User voice is
based), then applies the relevant parameter settings to it — so that your original
User voice is sounded.
• Disk save operations take a long time. This is normal. Keep in mind that it takes approximately 1 minute to save 1
megabyte of data to a floppy disk.
• The voice produces excessive noise. Certain voices may produce noise, depending on the Harmonic Content and/or
Brightness settings in the FILTER page of the Mixing Console display
(page 125).
• The sound is distorted or noisy. • The volume may be turned up too high. Make sure all relevant volume settings
are appropriate.
• This may be caused by the effects. Try canceling all unnecessary effects,
especially distortion-type effects (page 126).
• Some filter resonance settings in the Custom Voice Creator display (page 94)
can result in distorted sound. Adjust these settings if necessary.
• Is the gain of the Low band set too high in the Master Equalizer display
(Mixing Console — page 128) ?
• A strange “flanging” or “doubling” sound Both the Main and Layer parts are set to “ON,” and both parts are set to play the
occurs. Also, the sound is slightly different same voice. Set the Layer part to “OFF” (page 60) or change the voice for each
each time the keys are played. part (page 58).

CVP-210/208 167
Specifications
: available

Model Name CVP-210 CVP-208


Sound Source AWM Dynamic Stereo Sampling
Display 640 ✕ 480 dots backlit graphic LCD
Keyboard 88 keys (A-1 - C7)
Voice Polyphony (max) 256 192
Voice Selection 397 voices + 480 XG voices 378 voices + 480 XG voices
+ 26 Drum Kits + 26 Drum Kits
Regular Voice 311 310
Sweet Voice 14 13
Cool Voice 6
Live Voice 19 17
Natural Voice 37 22
Organ Flutes 10 (9 Footages) 10 (8 Footages)
Sound creator
Effects Reverb 2
Chorus 2
Effect Blocks DSP 7 5
Brilliance 1
Microphone 1
REVERB1 29 Preset+3 User
REVERB2 5
CHORUS1 25 Preset+3 User
CHORUS2 3
DSP1 164 Preset+3 User
DSP2 12
Effect Types
DSP3,4,5,6
164 Preset +10 User 88 Preset +10 User
(DSP6; CVP-210 only)
DSP7 (CVP-210 only) 88 Preset +10 User —
Brilliance 5
Master EQ 5 Preset + 2 User
Part EQ 27 Parts
Vocal Harmony 59 Preset +10 User 49 Preset +10 User
Accompaniment Number of Accompaniment Styles 261 247
Style
Number of Session Styles 31
Number of Pianist Styles 36
Number of Piano Combo Styles 17
Fingering Single Finger, Fingered, Fingered On Bass, Multi Finger, AI Fingered,
Full Keyboard, AI Full Keyboard
Style Creator
OTS (One Touch Setting) 4/Accompaniment Style
OTS link
Music Finder Approximately 2500 records
Edit

168 CVP-210/208
Specifications

Model Name CVP-210 CVP-208


Song Format SMF (Format 0,1), ESEQ
Preset Songs
Guide Follow Lights, Any Key, Karao-Key, Vocal CueTIME
Guide Lamp 88 Red
Lyrics
Score
Recording Quick Recording, Multi Recording, Step Recording, Song Editing
Record Channels 16
Memory Floppy Disk (2HD, 2DD)
Device
Flash Memory (internal) 3302KB
Flash Availability Song (SMF), Style (SFF), Registration, Voice, etc.
Tempo Tempo Range 5 - 500
Tap Tempo
Metronome
Sound Bell on/off, Human Voices (5 languages)
Registration Buttons 8
Memory
Regist Sequence
Freeze
Others Demo Function, Voice, Style
Language 6 languages (English, Japanese, German, French, Spanish, Italian)
Help
Direct Access
Piano setting button (including Piano Lock)
Master Volume
Fade In/Out
Transpose Keyboard/Song/Master
Tuning
Tuning Curve Flat/Stretch (Natural Piano Voice only)
Scale Equal Temperament, Pure Major/Pure Minor, Pythagorean, Mean-Tone,
Werckmeister/Kirnberger, Arabic 1/2
Touch Response 5 level
Jacks/Connectors PHONES ✕ 2, MIDI (THRU, OUT, IN), USB, AUX PEDAL,
AUX IN (L/L+R, R), AUX OUT (LEVEL FIXED) (L/R),
AUX OUT (L/L+R, R)
MIC (INPUT VOLUME, MIC./ LINE IN),VIDEO OUT
Pedals Number of Pedals 3
Pedal Functions VOLUME, SUSTAIN, SOSTENUTO, SOFT, GLIDE, PORTAMENTO,
PITCHBEND, MODULATION, DSP VARIATION, VIBROTOR ON/OFF,
SONG START/STOP, STYLE START/STOP, etc.
Amplifiers/ Amplifiers 60 W ✕ 2
Speakers
Speakers (16 cm + 5 cm + 3 cm) ✕ 2
Dimensions [W ✕ D ✕ H] 1426.0 ✕ 633.5 ✕ 932 mm 1429.9 ✕ 634.3 ✕ 927.4 mm
(with the Music Rest) [56-1/8" ✕ 24-15/16" ✕ 36-11/16"] [56-5/16" ✕ 24-15/16" ✕ 36-1/2"]
(1426.0 ✕ 633.5 ✕ 1097.4 mm) (1429.9 ✕ 634.3 ✕ 1092.6 mm)
[56-1/8" ✕ 24-15/16" ✕ 43-3/16"] [56-5/16" ✕ 24-15/16" ✕ 43-1/8"]
Weight 83.5 Kg (184 lbs., 13 oz) 78.5 Kg (173 lbs., 10 oz)

* Specifications and descriptions in this owner’s manual are for information purposes only. Yamaha Corp. reserves the right to
change or modify products or specifications at any time without prior notice. Since specifications, equipment or options may not
be the same in every locale, please check with your Yamaha dealer.

CVP-210/208 169
Index
Numerics Changing Pitch-related Settings...........................................125
Changing the Automatically Selected Voice Settings ...........146
1 - 16 ................................................................................. 110
Changing the Icon.................................................................50
[1▲▼] - [8▲▼] buttons ........................................... 18, 39–49
Changing the Tone of the Voice..........................................125
3BAND EQ (3-BAND EQUALIZER) .................................... 133
Changing the Touch Sensitivity and Transpose....................144
Channel ..................................................65, 80, 107, 120, 140
A Channel Messages ..............................................................160
[A] - [J] buttons............................................................... 18, 44 Channel Muting ....................................................................65
Accessories ............................................................................ 6 [CHANNEL ON / OFF] button ..................................18, 65, 80
Accompaniment Guide ........................................................ 82 Channel Transpose .............................................................109
Accompaniment style parts................................................... 99 CHD ...................................................................................111
[ACMP] button ............................................................... 18, 64 Chord ...................................................................................99
Adjust the Volume Balance and Changing Voices .............. 123 Chord Detect ......................................................................150
Adjusting the Effects ........................................................... 126 Chord Events.......................................................................111
Adjusting the Sound to Match the Performance Chord Fingering ............................................................66, 142
Environment ................................................................... 128 Chord Tutor ........................................................................142
Adjusting the Tempo ............................................................ 54 Chord Types Recognized in the Fingered Mode ....................67
Adjusting the Vocal Harmony Settings and Chorus ................................................................................129
Microphone Effects ......................................................... 133 Clock ..................................................................................149
Adjusting the Volume Balance ............................................. 65 COLOR NOTE ......................................................................86
Adjusting the Volume Balance / Muting Specific Channels ... 80 COMMON ...........................................................................93
Adjusting values ................................................................... 50 Compatible Song Types ........................................................77
AI ......................................................................................... 66 COMPRESSOR....................................................................134
AI FINGERED ....................................................................... 66 CONFIG 1 ..........................................................................151
AI FULL KEYBOARD ............................................................ 66 CONFIG 2 ..........................................................................152
Any Key ............................................................................... 82 Connect the power cord .......................................................17
Append ................................................................................ 75 Connecting Audio & Video Devices....................................156
Applying Voice Effects.......................................................... 61 Connecting external MIDI devices ......................................157
Appropriate Panel Setting for the Selected Style.................... 71 Connecting the Microphone or Guitar ................................155
Arabic ................................................................................ 139 Connecting to a Computer ..................................................157
Arranging the Style Pattern ................................................... 68 Controller ...........................................................................142
Assembling an Accompaniment Style ................................. 117 Converting into Kanji (Japanese language) ............................49
Assembling the CVP-208 .................................................... 164 Cool! ....................................................................................59
Assembling the CVP-210 .................................................... 164 COPY ...................................................................................47
ATTACK ............................................................................... 94 Copying and Formatting Disks ............................................153
AUTO .................................................................................. 20 Copying Files/Folders............................................................47
Auto Revoice...................................................................... 124 Copying from Disk to Disk..................................................153
[AUTO FILLIN] button.................................................... 18, 70 Creating Accompaniment Styles..........................................113
Automatically Changing One Touch Settings with the Current Memory ...................................................................41
Sections ............................................................................ 72 Customizing the Event List — Filter.....................................112
AUX IN [L / L+R] [R] jacks............................................ 19, 156 CUT......................................................................................46
AUX OUT (LEVEL FIXED) [L] [R] jacks.......................... 19, 156
AUX OUT [L / L+R] [R] jacks........................................ 19, 156 D
[AUX PEDAL] jack........................................................ 19, 157
Damper pedal.................................................................19, 62
[DATA ENTRY] dial ........................................................18, 50
B Data Types in the MIDI TRANSMIT/RECEIVE Display .........149
[BACK] button .......................................................... 18, 44, 50 DECAY .................................................................................94
BACK GROUND .................................................................. 87 DELETE .................................................................................47
[BALANCE] button ......................................................... 18, 65 Delete.................................................................................108
Bar Clear ............................................................................ 120 DELETE RECORD..................................................................75
Bar Copy ............................................................................ 120 Deleting Files/Folders............................................................47
Bar/Beat/Clock.................................................................... 102 [DEMO] button.........................................................14, 18, 56
Basic Operations — Organizing Your Data .......................... 39 DEPTH..................................................................................94
Bass...................................................................................... 99 Detailed Settings for Notation ...............................................85
BEAT .............................................................................. 74, 75 [DIGITAL RECORDING] button........................14, 18, 97, 113
[BREAK] button .............................................................. 18, 68 [DIRECT ACCESS] button................................................18, 51
BRIGHTNESS ....................................................................... 94 Direct Access Chart ..............................................................52
Disk ....................................................................................153
C Disk format .........................................................................162
Disk Orchestra Collection.....................................................19
Calling Up Ideal Setups for Your Music ................................ 73
Displaying Music Notation ...................................................84
Cent ................................................................................... 138
Displaying the Lyrics.............................................................87
Change the Rhythmic Feel.................................................. 118

170 CVP-210/208
Index

Displaying Upper Level pages .............................................. 48 FULL KEYBOARD .................................................................66


DOC .................................................................................. 163 [FUNCTION] button .....................................................18, 136
Drum ................................................................................... 59
[DSP] button .......................................................... 18, 61, 129 G
Dynamics ........................................................................... 119
Gate Time...........................................................................102
GENRE............................................................................74, 76
E GENRE NAME ......................................................................76
ECHO .......................................................................... 62, 146 GM System Level 1 .......................................................19, 163
EDIT ................................................................................... 116 Groove ...............................................................................118
Edit the Created Accompaniment Style ............................... 118 Groove parameters .............................................................118
Editing a Recorded Song..................................................... 107 [GUIDE] button ........................................................14, 18, 82
Editing Channel-related Parameters .................................... 107
Editing Chord Events .......................................................... 111 H
Editing Note Events ............................................................ 110
Handling the Floppy Disk Drive (FDD) and Floppy Disk.........6
Editing Records .................................................................... 75
Harmonic Content ................................................................94
Editing System Events ......................................................... 111
HARMONY ............................................................62, 95, 146
Editing the Channel Data.................................................... 120
Harmony Assignments ........................................................147
Editing Voices ...................................................................... 91
Harmony Types ..................................................................147
[EFFECT] button ........................................................... 18, 131
[HARMONY / ECHO] button ..........................................18, 62
Effect Block ........................................................................ 127
Headphone Hanger ..............................................................17
Effect Structure ................................................................... 129
Headphones .................................................................17, 155
EFFECT/EQ ........................................................................... 95
Help messages can be displayed in any one of the following
Effects................................................................................. 126
languages ..........................................................................53
EG ........................................................................................ 94
[HELP] button .................................................................18, 53
Embellish and enhance your melodies — with the automatic
High Key.............................................................................122
Harmony and Echo effects ................................................ 30
Hz ......................................................................................138
END Mark .......................................................................... 105
ENDING .............................................................................. 70
[ENDING / rit.] button .............................................. 18, 31, 69
I
[ENTER] button .............................................................. 18, 50 ICON SELECT .......................................................................50
Entering Characters............................................................... 49 [INPUT VOLUME] knob ...............................................19, 155
Entering Chords and Sections (Chord Step) ......................... 104 Inputting and Editing Lyrics.................................................112
Entering miscellaneous characters (marks) ............................ 49 Instant Selection of Displays .................................................51
Entering numbers ................................................................. 49 INTRO ..................................................................................70
Entering special character marks [INTRO] button.........................................................18, 31, 68
(umlaut, accent, Japanese “ ” and “ ”) ......................... 49
Entering Your Name and Language Preference ................... 154 K
EQ...................................................................................... 128 Karao-Key .............................................................................82
Equal Temperament............................................................ 139 Key cover..............................................................................16
ESEQ .................................................................................. 162 KEY SIGNATURE ..................................................................85
Example Keyboard Data ..................................................... 160 Keyboard guide lamps ....................................................19, 82
[EXIT] button .................................................................. 18, 44 Keyboard Percussion.............................................................59
Exit from Small Pop-up Windows ......................................... 44 Keyboard Touch .................................................................144
[EXTRA TRACKS (STYLE)] button .................................... 18, 81 Keyboard/Panel...................................................................144
KEYWORD .....................................................................74, 75
F Kirnberger...........................................................................139
Fade In Time, Fade Out Time, Fade Out Hold Time ........... 151
[FADE IN / OUT] button................................................. 18, 69 L
FAVORITE ............................................................................ 75 Layer.....................................................................................60
[FF] button ..................................................................... 18, 80 Layering Two Different Voices ..............................................60
File ....................................................................................... 41 LCD ......................................................................................15
File/Folder-related Operations .............................................. 45 Left .......................................................................................61
Files/folders in a floppy disk ................................................. 46 LEFT CH. ..............................................................................85
Fill........................................................................................ 70 [LEFT HOLD] button.......................................................18, 62
Filter..................................................................... 94, 112, 125 Left pedal........................................................................19, 62
FINGERED ........................................................................... 66 Live! .....................................................................................59
FINGERED ON BASS............................................................ 66 Live!Drums ...........................................................................59
First Key On ....................................................................... 106 Local Control ......................................................................148
FLOPPY DISK drive .................................................. 41, 42, 43 Loop recording ...................................................................113
Floppy disk drive .............................................................. 6, 19 Lyrics ............................................................................87, 112
Follow Lights ........................................................................ 82 LYRICS BACKGROUND PICTURE........................................87
Foot Controller ............................................................. 62, 157
FOOTAGE (Organ Flutes) ..................................................... 96
M
Footswitch.................................................................... 62, 157
Formatting a Disk ............................................................... 153 MAIN A/B/C/D......................................................................68
[FREEZE] button...................................................... 19, 90, 145 MAIN [A] button.............................................................18, 68
MAIN [B] button .............................................................18, 68

CVP-210/208 171
Index

MAIN [C] button ............................................................ 18, 68 O


MAIN [D] button ............................................................ 18, 68
OCTAVE .............................................................................125
MAIN PICTURE .................................................................. 154
One Touch Setting ................................................................32
Maintaining Panel Settings ................................................. 145
ONE TOUCH SETTING [1] - [4] buttons...................19, 71, 72
Maintenance .......................................................................... 8
One-touch Piano Play...........................................................59
Making Global and Other Important Settings...................... 136
[ON / OFF] button (POWER)...........................................18, 17
Making Overall System Settings (Local Control, Clock, etc.)148
Open/Save displays...............................................................40
Making Settings for Fade In/Out, Metronome, Parameter Lock,
Organ Flutes! ........................................................................59
and Tap .......................................................................... 151
Organizing Files by Creating a New Folder...........................48
Making Settings for the Display, Speaker System, and Voice
Other Parameters in the Basic Display ................................116
Number Indication.......................................................... 152
Other Playback-related Operations .......................................80
Making Settings for the Pedals ............................................ 142
Other Settings .....................................................................151
Making Settings for the Pedals and Keyboard ..................... 142
[OTS LINK] button ..........................................................18, 72
Making Settings for the Vocal Harmony and Microphone... 133
Outputting the sound of an external device through the built-in
Making Style File Format Settings ....................................... 121
speakers of the Clavinova ................................................156
Master Tune ....................................................................... 138
OVERALL SETTING ............................................................133
Mastering Your Favorite Songs.............................................. 38
Overdub recording .............................................................113
[MASTER VOLUME] dial ................................................ 18, 17
Owner ................................................................................154
Mean-Tone......................................................................... 139
[MEMORY] button.......................................................... 19, 88
Message Switch .................................................................. 149 P
Messages ................................................................................ 8 Pad .......................................................................................99
Metronome ........................................................................ 151 Parameter ...........................................................................121
METRONOME [START / STOP] button ........................... 18, 54 Parameter Lock ...................................................................152
MIC. ................................................................................... 131 PASTE .............................................................................46, 47
[MIC. LINE] switch ....................................................... 19, 155 Pedal ..................................................................................142
[MIC. LINE IN] jack ...................................................... 19, 155 Pedal (Center) .......................................................................62
Microphone ....................................................................... 131 Pedal (Left)............................................................................62
MICROPHONE SETTING ................................................... 133 Pedal (Right) .........................................................................62
[MIC. SETTING] button ................................................ 18, 131 Pedal-controllable Functions...............................................143
MIDI .................................................................................. 148 [PHONES] jacks............................................................19, 155
MIDI [THRU] [OUT] [IN] terminals.............................. 19, 157 Phrase...................................................................................99
MIDI channels.................................................................... 161 Phrase Mark..................................................................80, 140
MIDI Data Compatibility .................................................... 162 [PIANO] button ........................................................15, 19, 59
MIDI IN.............................................................................. 157 PIANO (SOUND CREATOR).................................................93
MIDI OUT.......................................................................... 157 Piano Lock function ..............................................................59
MIDI Receive Parts ............................................................. 150 PITCH BEND RANGE .........................................................125
MIDI SETUP ....................................................................... 154 Pitch settings for each scale ................................................139
MIDI terminals ................................................................... 157 Playback of Songs .................................................................21
MIDI THRU........................................................................ 157 Playing a style.................................................................28, 63
Mix .................................................................................... 108 Playing a Style’s Rhythm Channels only................................65
[MIXING CONSOLE] button......................................... 18, 123 Playing Along with the Clavinova .........................................36
[MONO] button ............................................................. 18, 62 Playing and Practicing with the Songs...................................36
Moving Files/Folders ............................................................ 46 Playing Back Songs on Disk ..................................................80
MULTI FINGER .................................................................... 66 Playing Different Voices with the Left and Right Hands.........27
Multi Recording ................................................................... 99 Playing Fill-in patterns automatically when changing
[MUSIC FINDER] button .................................... 15, 19, 33, 73 accompaniment sections ...................................................70
Music Finder Record Edit ..................................................... 75 Playing Several Sounds Simultaneously.................................60
Music Finder Search ............................................................. 74 Playing Styles........................................................................28
Music Rest............................................................................ 16 Playing the Demos..........................................................20, 56
Muting Specific Parts ............................................................ 81 Playing the Internal Songs .....................................................78
Playing the sounds of the Clavinova through an external
N audio system, and recording the sounds to an external
recorder...........................................................................156
NAME .................................................................................. 45
Playing Two Voices Simultaneously......................................26
Naming Files/Folders ............................................................ 45
Playing Voices ......................................................................25
Natural Voices ..................................................................... 92
PORTAMENTO TIME..........................................................125
Natural!................................................................................ 59
Practice Functions.................................................................82
NEW (FOLDER) .................................................................... 48
Practicing Music with the Guide Functions ...........................83
NEW RECORD ..................................................................... 75
PRESET drive...................................................................41, 42
[NEXT] button .......................................................... 18, 44, 50
Preset MIDI Templates ........................................................148
NOISE GATE ...................................................................... 133
Punch In/Out ......................................................................106
Normal............................................................................... 106
Pure Major..........................................................................139
Note Events ........................................................................ 110
Pure Minor..........................................................................139
Note Limit .......................................................................... 122
Pythagorean........................................................................139
NOTE NAME........................................................................ 86
NTR (Note Transposition Rule) ........................................... 121
NTT (Note Transposition Table).......................................... 122

172 CVP-210/208
Index

Q Selecting the Freeze Settings .................................................90


Sequence Format ................................................................162
QUANTIZE .......................................................................... 85
Sequencer...........................................................................160
Quantize .................................................................... 107, 120
Set Up.................................................................................109
Quantize Size..................................................................... 107
Setting Auto Accompaniment-related Parameters................141
Quick Recording .................................................................. 98
Setting Chord Channels.......................................................150
Quick Start ......................................................................... 140
Setting Harmony and Echo..................................................146
Setting Root Note Channels ................................................150
R Setting Separate Voices for the Left and Right Sections of the
Realtime Recording ............................................................ 115 Keyboard...........................................................................61
Realtime Recording Characteristics..................................... 113 Setting Song-related Parameters ..........................................140
[REC] button................................................................... 18, 97 Setting the Fingering Method ..............................................142
Rec Mode........................................................................... 106 Setting the Level Balance and Voice ...................................124
Recalling a Registration Memory Setup................................. 90 Setting the Microphone Volume and Related Effects ...........135
Recalling the Registered Settings........................................... 90 Setting the MIDI Parameters................................................148
Receive .............................................................................. 150 Setting the Registration Sequence, Freeze, and Voice Set ....145
Receive Transpose.............................................................. 149 Setting the volume ................................................................17
Receiving MIDI Data .......................................................... 150 SFX .......................................................................................59
Record ................................................................................. 73 Sheet Music Braces ...............................................................16
Recording............................................................................. 37 Showing the Clavinova Display on a TV .....................147, 156
Recording Chord Changes for the Auto Accompaniment .... 104 Simultaneously Playing a Song and an
Recording Individual Notes ................................................ 101 Accompaniment Style........................................................79
Recording Melodies ........................................................... 103 SINGLE FINGER....................................................................66
Recording Your Performances and Creating Songs................ 97 SMF (Standard MIDI File) ....................................................162
Registering Panel Setups ....................................................... 88 Song ...............................................................................14, 77
Registering the Panel Controls in One Touch Setting ............ 72 SONG AUTO REVOICE......................................................124
REGISTRATION BANK ......................................................... 89 Song Book ......................................................................22, 77
REGISTRATION EDIT display ............................................... 89 Song Creator .........................................................................97
REGISTRATION MEMORY [1] – [8] buttons ................... 19, 88 Song Playback ..........................................................21, 77, 78
Registration Sequence ........................................................ 145 Song Recording.....................................................................97
Regular Voices ..................................................................... 92 Song Settings.......................................................................140
RELEASE ............................................................................... 94 SONG [START / STOP] button ........................................18, 78
Remove Event .................................................................... 120 Sostenuto pedal ..............................................................19, 62
Repeat Playback of a Specific Range .................................... 81 SOUND (SOUND CREATOR)...............................................93
[REPEAT] button ............................................................. 18, 81 SOUND CREATOR Parameters (Natural/Regular Voices) ......92
Replace ................................................................................ 75 [SOUND CREATOR] button ...........................................18, 91
Resonance............................................................................ 94 Source Root/Chord..............................................................121
Restoring the Factory-programmed Settings Specifying the Order for Calling Up Registration Memory
of the CVP-210/208 ........................................................ 154 Presets .............................................................................145
[REVERB] button............................................................. 18, 61 SPEED...................................................................................94
Reverb................................................................................ 129 Split Point ...........................................................................141
[REW] button ................................................................. 18, 80 Step Record ........................................................................101
Rhythm ................................................................................ 99 Step Record (Chord)............................................................104
RIGHT CH. .......................................................................... 85 Step Record (Note)..............................................................103
Root ................................................................................... 150 Step Recording....................................................................116
RTR (Retrigger Rule) ........................................................... 122 Stopping the Style Playback While Releasing Keys................69
Style................................................................................14, 63
S Style Creator .......................................................................113
Style File .......................................................................19, 162
SAVE .................................................................................... 48
Style File Format .................................................................114
Save ............................................................................... 40, 48
Style Sections........................................................................30
Saving Files .......................................................................... 48
Style Setting ........................................................................141
Saving Your Registration Memory Setups.............................. 89
STYLE [START / STOP] button.........................................18, 64
Scale .................................................................................. 139
Sustain ..................................................................................94
Scale Tune ......................................................................... 138
Sweet!...................................................................................59
Score .................................................................................... 84
[SYNC.START] button .....................................................18, 64
Searching the Ideal Setups .................................................... 74
[SYNC.STOP] button.......................................................18, 69
Searching the Music Finder Records ..................................... 34
SYS/EX. (System Exclusive) ..................................................111
Section button indications
System ................................................................................148
— [BREAK], [INTRO], [MAIN], [ENDING] buttons ........... 68
System Events .....................................................................111
Sections................................................................................ 30
System Messages.................................................................161
Select the Recording Options: Starting, Stopping,
System Reset .......................................................................154
Punching In/Out ............................................................. 106
SYSTEM SETUP...................................................................154
Selecting a Scale ................................................................ 138
Selecting a Voice.................................................................. 58
Selecting Files and Folders ................................................... 44 T
Selecting Intro and Ending Types .......................................... 70 [TALK] button ...............................................................18, 131
Selecting items ..................................................................... 50 TALK SETTING ...................................................................135

CVP-210/208 173
Index

Tap Count .......................................................................... 152


[TAP TEMPO] button...................................................... 18, 55
TEMPO [E] [F] buttons ............................................ 18, 54
TEMPO FROM ..................................................................... 74
Tempo Indications — MAIN Display .................................... 55
TEMPO TO .......................................................................... 74
[TOP] button .................................................................. 18, 80
[TRACK 1 (R)] button...................................................... 18, 81
[TRACK 2 (L)] button ...................................................... 18, 81
Transmit ............................................................................. 149
Transmit Clock ................................................................... 149
Transmitting MIDI Data ...................................................... 149
TRANSPOSE [E] [F] buttons................................... 18, 144
Transpose Assign ................................................................ 144
Tune................................................................................... 125
TUNING ............................................................................ 125
Tuning the Overall Pitch .................................................... 138

U
UP........................................................................................ 48
USB...................................................................................... 19
[USB] terminal........................................................ 15, 19, 157
USER drive ............................................................... 41, 42, 43
USER EFFECT ............................................................. 127, 154
Using Your Clavinova with Other Devices ......................... 155
Utility ................................................................................. 151

V
[VARIATION] button ...................................................... 18, 61
Velocity...................................................................... 102, 119
Velocity Change ................................................................. 120
[VH TYPE SELECT] button ............................................ 18, 131
VIBRATO ............................................................................. 94
[VIDEO OUT] jack ............................................... 19, 147, 156
Vocal CueTIME .................................................................... 82
[VOCAL HARMONY] button........................................ 18, 131
VOCAL HARMONY CONTROL......................................... 134
Vocal Harmony Type ......................................................... 131
Voice Allocation Format..................................................... 163
VOICE buttons ......................................................... 15, 19, 58
Voice Characteristics ............................................................ 59
Voice Effects......................................................................... 61
VOICE PART ON / OFF [LAYER] button ......................... 18, 60
VOICE PART ON / OFF [LEFT] button ............................ 18, 60
Voice Set ............................................................................ 146
VOL/ATTACK (Organ Flutes) ................................................ 96
Volume/Voice .................................................................... 124

W
Werckmeister ..................................................................... 139
What You Can Do With MIDI ............................................ 161
What’s MIDI? ..................................................................... 159

X
XF ................................................................................ 19, 162
XG ............................................................................... 19, 163

174 CVP-210/208
MEMO

MEMO

CVP-210/208 175
MEMO

MEMO

176 CVP-210/208
IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS
INFORMATION RELATING TO PERSONAL INJURY, ELECTRICAL SHOCK,
AND FIRE HAZARD POSSIBILITIES HAS BEEN INCLUDED IN THIS LIST.
WARNING- When using any electrical or electronic product, 8. This product was NOT designed for use in wet/damp loca-
basic precautions should always be followed. These precautions tions and should not be used near water or exposed to rain.
include, but are not limited to, the following: Examples of wet/damp locations are; near a swimming pool,
spa, tub, sink, or wet basement.
1. Read all Safety Instructions, Installation Instructions, Spe-
cial Message Section items, and any Assembly Instructions 9. This product should be used only with the components
found in this manual BEFORE making any connections, includ- supplied or; a cart, rack, or stand that is recommended by the
ing connection to the main supply. manufacturer. If a cart, rack, or stand is used, please observe all
safety markings and instructions that accompany the accessory
2. Main Power Supply Verification: Yamaha products are product.
manufactured specifically for the supply voltage in the area
where they are to be sold. If you should move, or if any doubt 10. The power supply cord (plug) should be disconnected
exists about the supply voltage in your area, please contact your from the outlet when electronic products are to be left unused for
dealer for supply voltage verification and (if applicable) instruc- extended periods of time. Cords should also be disconnected
tions. The required supply voltage is printed on the name plate. when there is a high probability of lightning and/or electrical
For name plate location, please refer to the graphic found in the storm activity.
Special Message Section of this manual.
11. Care should be taken that objects do not fall and liquids are
3. This product may be equipped with a polarized plug (one not spilled into the enclosure through any openings that may exist.
blade wider than the other). If you are unable to insert the plug
into the outlet, turn the plug over and try again. If the problem 12. Electrical/electronic products should be serviced by a
persists, contact an electrician to have the obsolete outlet qualified service person when:
replaced. Do NOT defeat the safety purpose of the plug. a. The power supply cord has been damaged; or
b. Objects have fallen, been inserted, or liquids have been
4. Some electronic products utilize external power supplies spilled into the enclosure through openings; or
or adapters. Do NOT connect this type of product to any power c. The product has been exposed to rain: or
supply or adapter other than one described in the owners manual, d. The product dose not operate, exhibits a marked change
on the name plate, or specifically recommended by Yamaha. in performance; or
e. The product has been dropped, or the enclosure of the
5. WARNING: Do not place this product or any other product has been damaged.
objects on the power cord or place it in a position where anyone
could walk on, trip over, or roll anything over power or connect- 13. Do not attempt to service this product beyond that
ing cords of any kind. The use of an extension cord is not recom- described in the user-maintenance instructions. All other servic-
mended! If you must use an extension cord, the minimum wire ing should be referred to qualified service personnel.
size for a 25’ cord (or less) is 18 AWG. NOTE: The smaller the
AWG number, the larger the current handling capacity. For 14. This product, either alone or in combination with an
longer extension cords, consult a local electrician. amplifier and headphones or speaker/s, may be capable of pro-
ducing sound levels that could cause permanent hearing loss.
6. Ventilation: Electronic products, unless specifically DO NOT operate for a long period of time at a high volume level
designed for enclosed installations, should be placed in locations or at a level that is uncomfortable. If you experience any hearing
that do not interfere with proper ventilation. If instructions for loss or ringing in the ears, you should consult an audiologist.
enclosed installations are not provided, it must be assumed that IMPORTANT: The louder the sound, the shorter the time period
unobstructed ventilation is required. before damage occurs.

7. Temperature considerations: Electronic products should 15. Some Yamaha products may have benches and/or accessory
be installed in locations that do not significantly contribute to mounting fixtures that are either supplied as a part of the product
their operating temperature. Placement of this product close to or as optional accessories. Some of these items are designed to be
heat sources such as; radiators, heat registers and other devices dealer assembled or installed. Please make sure that benches are
that produce heat should be avoided. stable and any optional fixtures (where applicable) are well
secured BEFORE using. Benches supplied by Yamaha are
designed for seating only. No other uses are recommended.

PLEASE KEEP THIS MANUAL


92-469-2
FCC INFORMATION (U.S.A.)
1. IMPORTANT NOTICE: DO NOT MODIFY THIS UNIT! other electronic devices. Compliance with FCC regula-
This product, when installed as indicated in the instruc- tions does not guarantee that interference will not occur
tions contained in this manual, meets FCC require- in all installations. If this product is found to be the
ments. Modifications not expressly approved by source of interference, which can be determined by
Yamaha may void your authority, granted by the FCC, to turning the unit “OFF” and “ON”, please try to eliminate
use the product. the problem by using one of the following measures:
2. IMPORTANT: When connecting this product to acces- Relocate either this product or the device that is being
sories and/or another product use only high quality affected by the interference.
shielded cables. Cable/s supplied with this product Utilize power outlets that are on different branch (circuit
MUST be used. Follow all installation instructions. Fail- breaker or fuse) circuits or install AC line filter/s.
ure to follow instructions could void your FCC authori- In the case of radio or TV interference, relocate/reorient
zation to use this product in the USA. the antenna. If the antenna lead-in is 300 ohm ribbon
3. NOTE: This product has been tested and found to com- lead, change the lead-in to co-axial type cable.
ply with the requirements listed in FCC Regulations, If these corrective measures do not produce satisfac-
Part 15 for Class “B” digital devices. Compliance with tory results, please contact the local retailer authorized
these requirements provides a reasonable level of to distribute this type of product. If you can not locate
assurance that your use of this product in a residential the appropriate retailer, please contact Yamaha Corpo-
environment will not result in harmful interference with ration of America, Electronic Service Division, 6600
other electronic devices. This equipment generates/ Orangethorpe Ave, Buena Park, CA90620
uses radio frequencies and, if not installed and used The above statements apply ONLY to those products
according to the instructions found in the users manual, distributed by Yamaha Corporation of America or its
may cause interference harmful to the operation of subsidiaries.
* This applies only to products distributed by YAMAHA CORPORATION OF AMERICA. (class B)

IMPORTANT NOTICE FOR THE UNITED KINGDOM


Connecting the Plug and Cord
IMPORTANT. The wires in this mains lead are coloured in
accordance with the following code:
BLUE : NEUTRAL
BROWN : LIVE
As the colours of the wires in the mains lead of this appa-
ratus may not correspond with the coloured makings iden-
tifying the terminals in your plug proceed as follows:
The wire which is coloured BLUE must be connected to
the terminal which is marked with the letter N or coloured
BLACK.
The wire which is coloured BROWN must be connected to
the terminal which is marked with the letter L or coloured
RED.
Making sure that neither core is connected to the earth ter-
minal of the three pin plug.
(2 wires)
• This applies only to products distributed by Yamaha-Kemble Music
(U.K.) Ltd.

CAUTION: TO PREVENT ELECTRIC SHOCK, MATCH


WIDE BLADE OF PLUG TO WIDE SLOT, FULLY INSERT.

ATTENTION: POUR ÉVITER LES CHOCS ÉLEC-


TRIQUES, INTRODUIRE LA LAME LA PLUS LARGE DE
LA FICHE DANS LA BORNE CORRESPONDANTE DE LA
PRISE ET POUSSER JUSQU’AU FOND.
(polarity)
• This applies only to products distributed by Yamaha Canada Music
Ltd.
• Ceci ne s’applique qu’aux produits distribués par Yamaha Canada
Musique Ltée.
For details of products, please contact your nearest Yamaha or the Die Einzelheiten zu Produkten sind bei Ihrer unten aufgeführten
authorized distributor listed below. Niederlassung und bei Yamaha Vertragshändlern in den jeweiligen
Bestimmungsländern erhältlich.
Pour plus de détails sur les produits, veuillez-vous adresser à Yamaha ou
au distributeur le plus proche de vous figurant dans la liste suivante. Para detalles sobre productos, contacte su tienda Yamaha más cercana
o el distribuidor autorizado que se lista debajo.

NORTH AMERICA FRANCE ASIA


Yamaha Musique France, S.A.
CANADA Division Professionnelle
HONG KONG
Yamaha Canada Music Ltd. BP 70-77312 Marne-la-Vallée Cedex 2, France Tom Lee Music Co., Ltd.
135 Milner Avenue, Scarborough, Ontario, Tel: 01-64-61-4000 11/F., Silvercord Tower 1, 30 Canton Road,
M1S 3R1, Canada Tsimshatsui, Kowloon, Hong Kong
Tel: 416-298-1311 ITALY Tel: 2737-7688
Yamaha Musica Italia S.P.A.
U.S.A. Combo Division
INDONESIA
Yamaha Corporation of America Viale Italia 88, 20020 Lainate (Milano), Italy PT. Yamaha Music Indonesia (Distributor)
6600 Orangethorpe Ave., Buena Park, Calif. 90620, Tel: 02-935-771 PT. Nusantik
U.S.A. Gedung Yamaha Music Center, Jalan Jend. Gatot
Tel: 714-522-9011 SPAIN/PORTUGAL Subroto Kav. 4, Jakarta 12930, Indonesia
Yamaha-Hazen Música, S.A. Tel: 21-520-2577
Ctra. de la Coruna km. 17, 200, 28230
CENTRAL & SOUTH AMERICA Las Rozas (Madrid), Spain
KOREA
Tel: 91-201-0700 Yamaha Music Korea Ltd.
MEXICO Tong-Yang Securities Bldg. 16F 23-8 Yoido-dong,
Yamaha de Mexico S.A. De C.V., GREECE Youngdungpo-ku, Seoul, Korea
Departamento de ventas Philippos Nakas S.A. The Music House Tel: 02-3770-0661
Javier Rojo Gomez No.1149, Col. Gpe Del 147 Skiathou Street, 112-55 Athens, Greece
Moral, Deleg. Iztapalapa, 09300 Mexico, D.F. Tel: 01-228 2160
MALAYSIA
Tel: 686-00-33 Yamaha Music Malaysia, Sdn., Bhd.
SWEDEN Lot 8, Jalan Perbandaran, 47301 Kelana Jaya,
BRAZIL Yamaha Scandinavia AB Petaling Jaya, Selangor, Malaysia
Yamaha Musical do Brasil LTDA. J. A. Wettergrens Gata 1 Tel: 3-703-0900
Av. Rebouças 2636, São Paulo, Brasil Box 30053
Tel: 011-853-1377 S-400 43 Göteborg, Sweden
PHILIPPINES
Tel: 031 89 34 00 Yupangco Music Corporation
ARGENTINA 339 Gil J. Puyat Avenue, P.O. Box 885 MCPO,
Yamaha de Panamá S.A. Sucursal de Argentina DENMARK Makati, Metro Manila, Philippines
Viamonte 1145 Piso2-B 1053, YS Copenhagen Liaison Office Tel: 819-7551
Buenos Aires, Argentina Generatorvej 8B
Tel: 1-4371-7021 DK-2730 Herlev, Denmark
SINGAPORE
Tel: 44 92 49 00 Yamaha Music Asia Pte., Ltd.
PANAMA AND OTHER LATIN 11 Ubi Road #06-00, Meiban Industrial Building,
AMERICAN COUNTRIES/ FINLAND Singapore
CARIBBEAN COUNTRIES F-Musiikki Oy Tel: 65-747-4374
Yamaha de Panamá S.A. Kluuvikatu 6, P.O. Box 260,
SF-00101 Helsinki, Finland
TAIWAN
Torre Banco General, Piso 7, Urbanización Marbella,
Tel: 09 618511 Yamaha KHS Music Co., Ltd.
Calle 47 y Aquilino de la Guardia,
3F, #6, Sec.2
Ciudad de Panamá, Panamá NORWAY Nan Jing E. Rd. Taipei.
Tel: +507-269-5311 Norsk filial av Yamaha Scandinavia AB Taiwan 104, R.O.C.
Grini Næringspark 1 Tel: 02-2511-8688
EUROPE N-1345 Østerås, Norway
Tel: 67 16 77 70
THAILAND
THE UNITED KINGDOM Siam Music Yamaha Co., Ltd.
ICELAND 121/60-61 RS Tower 17th Floor,
Yamaha-Kemble Music (U.K.) Ltd.
Sherbourne Drive, Tilbrook, Milton Keynes, Skifan HF Ratchadaphisek RD., Dindaeng,
MK7 8BL, England Skeifan 17 P.O. Box 8120 Bangkok 10320, Thailand
Tel: 01908-366700 IS-128 Reykjavik, Iceland Tel: 02-641-2951
Tel: 525 5000
IRELAND THE PEOPLE’S REPUBLIC OF CHINA
OTHER EUROPEAN COUNTRIES AND OTHER ASIAN COUNTRIES
Danfay Ltd.
61D, Sallynoggin Road, Dun Laoghaire, Co. Dublin Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH Yamaha Corporation,
Tel: 01-2859177 Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group
Tel: +49-4101-3030 Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
GERMANY Tel: +81-53-460-2317
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany AFRICA
Tel: 04101-3030 Yamaha Corporation, OCEANIA
SWITZERLAND/LIECHTENSTEIN Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group AUSTRALIA
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH, Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650 Yamaha Music Australia Pty. Ltd.
Branch Switzerland Tel: +81-53-460-2312 Level 1, 99 Queensbridge Street, Southbank,
Seefeldstrasse 94, 8008 Zürich, Switzerland Victoria 3006, Australia
Tel: 01-383 3990 MIDDLE EAST Tel: 3-9693-5111
AUSTRIA TURKEY/CYPRUS NEW ZEALAND
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH, Music Houses of N.Z. Ltd.
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH
Branch Austria 146/148 Captain Springs Road, Te Papapa,
Siemensstraße 22-34, 25462 Rellingen, Germany
Schleiergasse 20, A-1100 Wien, Austria Auckland, New Zealand
Tel: 04101-3030
Tel: 01-60203900 Tel: 9-634-0099
THE NETHERLANDS OTHER COUNTRIES COUNTRIES AND TRUST
Yamaha Music Gulf FZE TERRITORIES IN PACIFIC OCEAN
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,
LB21-128 Jebel Ali Freezone
Branch Nederland Yamaha Corporation,
P.O.Box 17328, Dubai, U.A.E.
Clarissenhof 5-b, 4133 AB Vianen, The Netherlands Asia-Pacific Music Marketing Group
Tel: +971-4-881-5868
Tel: 0347-358 040 Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
BELGIUM/LUXEMBOURG Tel: +81-53-460-2312
Yamaha Music Central Europe GmbH,
Branch Belgium
Rue de Geneve (Genevastraat) 10, 1140 - Brussels,
Belgium
Tel: 02-726 6032

HEAD OFFICE Yamaha Corporation, Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division
Nakazawa-cho 10-1, Hamamatsu, Japan 430-8650
Tel: +81-53-460-2445
[CL] 26
DIC 99

CVP-210/208
OWNER’S MANUAL
CVP-210/208
OWNER’S
OWNER’S MANUAL
MANUAL

Clavinova Web site (English only)


http://www.yamahaclavinova.com/

Yamaha Manual Library


http://www2.yamaha.co.jp/manual/english/

M.D.G., Pro Audio & Digital Musical Instrument Division, Yamaha Corporation
© 2003 Yamaha Corporation
WA48350 ???AP?????.?-01A0 Printed in Indonesia

You might also like